0
登录后你可以
  • 下载海量资料
  • 学习在线课程
  • 观看技术视频
  • 写文章/发帖/加入社区
创作中心
发布
  • 发文章

  • 发资料

  • 发帖

  • 提问

  • 发视频

创作活动
MC68HC908LJ12CFU

MC68HC908LJ12CFU

  • 厂商:

    ROCHESTER(罗切斯特)

  • 封装:

    QFP64

  • 描述:

    IC MCU 8BIT 12KB FLASH 64QFP

  • 数据手册
  • 价格&库存
MC68HC908LJ12CFU 数据手册
MC68HC908LJ12 Technical Data M68HC08 Microcontrollers MC68HC908LJ12/D Rev. 2, 2/2002 WWW.MOTOROLA.COM/SEMICONDUCTORS MC68HC908LJ12 Technical Data Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Motorola makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. "Typical" parameters which may be provided in Motorola data sheets and/or specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating parameters, including "Typicals" must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Motorola does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Motorola product could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Motorola products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Motorola and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer. Motorola and the Stylized M logo are registered in the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office. digital dna is a trademark of Motorola, Inc. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA © Motorola, Inc., 2002 Technical Data Technical Data 3 Technical Data To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information available, refer to: http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/ The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this document. For your convenience, the page number designators have been linked to the appropriate location. Revision History Date Revision Level February 2002 2 Description First general release. Technical Data 4 Page Number(s) — MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Technical Data MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 List of Sections Section 1. General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Section 2. Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . . 59 Section 4. FLASH Memory (FLASH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG) . . . . . . . . 71 Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Section 7. Oscillator (OSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM) . . . . . . . . . . 101 Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM) . . . . . . . . 131 Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM) . . . . . . . . . . . 185 Section 12. Real Time Clock (RTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 Section 13. Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 Section 14. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) . . 269 Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) . . . . . . 301 Section 16. Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) . . . . . 317 Section 17. Input/Output (I/O) Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 Section 18. External Interrupt (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 Section 19. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI). . . . . . . . 363 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data List of Sections 5 List of Sections Section 20. Computer Operating Properly (COP) . . . . 371 Section 21. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 Section 22. Break Module (BRK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383 Section 23. Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 Section 24. Mechanical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407 Section 25. Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Technical Data 6 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 List of Sections MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Table of Contents Section 1. General Description 1.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 1.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 1.4 MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 1.5 Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 1.6 Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 1.6.1 Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 1.6.2 Analog Power Supply Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 1.6.3 Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.4 External Reset Pin (RST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.5 External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.6 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.7 ADC Voltage High Reference Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.8 ADC Voltage Low Reference Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.9 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0) . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.10 Port B I/O Pins (PTB7–PTB0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.11 Port C I/O Pins (PTC7–PTC0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.12 Port D I/O Pins (PTD7–PTD0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.13 LCD Backplane and Frontplane (BP0–BP2, FP0/BP3, FP1–FP18). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Section 2. Memory Map 2.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 2.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 2.3 Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 7 Table of Contents 2.4 Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 2.5 Input/Output (I/O) Section. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM) 3.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 3.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 3.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Section 4. FLASH Memory (FLASH) 4.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 4.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 4.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 4.4 FLASH Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 4.5 FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 4.6 FLASH Mass Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 4.7 FLASH Program Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 4.8 FLASH Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 4.8.1 FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG) 5.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 5.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 5.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 5.4 Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 5.5 Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 Technical Data 8 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Table of Contents Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU) 6.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 6.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 6.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 6.4 CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 6.4.1 Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 6.4.2 Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 6.4.3 Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 6.4.4 Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 6.4.5 Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 6.5 Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 6.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 6.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 6.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 6.7 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 6.8 Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 6.9 Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Section 7. Oscillator (OSC) 7.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 7.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 7.3 Internal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 7.4 Crystal (X-tal) Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 7.5 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 7.5.1 Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.2 Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.3 Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.4 Internal RC Clock (ICLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 7.5.5 CGM Oscillator Clock (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.6 CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 9 Table of Contents 7.6 Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 7.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 7.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 7.7 Oscillator During Break Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 8.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 8.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 8.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 8.4.1 Oscillator Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 8.4.2 Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 8.4.3 PLL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 8.4.4 Acquisition and Tracking Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 8.4.5 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes. . . . . . . . . . 108 8.4.6 Programming the PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 8.4.9 CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 8.5 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 8.5.1 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.2 PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.3 PLL Analog Ground Pin (VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.4 Oscillator Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . 116 8.5.5 CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.6 CGM VCO Clock Output (CGMVCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 8.5.7 CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 8.5.8 CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 8.6 CGM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117 8.6.1 PLL Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 8.6.3 PLL Multiplier Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 8.6.4 PLL VCO Range Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 8.6.5 PLL Reference Divider Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 Technical Data 10 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Table of Contents 8.7 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8 Special Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 8.8.3 CGM During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 8.9.1 Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 8.9.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 8.9.3 Choosing a Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM) 9.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 9.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 9.3 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 9.3.1 Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 9.3.2 Clock Start-up from POR or LVI Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 9.3.3 Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 9.4 Reset and System Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 9.4.1 External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 9.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 9.4.2.1 Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 9.4.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset. . . . . . . . . . 139 9.4.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 9.4.2.4 Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 9.4.2.5 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 9.4.2.6 Monitor Mode Entry Module Reset (MODRST) . . . . . . . 140 9.5 SIM Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 9.5.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 9.5.2 SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 9.5.3 SIM Counter and Reset States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 9.6 Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 9.6.1 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 9.6.1.1 Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 9.6.1.2 SWI Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 11 Table of Contents 9.6.1.3 9.6.1.4 9.6.1.5 9.6.1.6 9.6.2 9.6.3 9.6.4 Interrupt Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Interrupt Status Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Interrupt Status Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Interrupt Status Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 Status Flag Protection in Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 9.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 9.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 9.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 9.8 SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 9.8.1 SIM Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 9.8.2 SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 9.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON) 10.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 10.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 10.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 10.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 10.4.2 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163 10.4.3 Break Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163 10.4.4 Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 10.4.5 Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 10.5 Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 10.6 ROM-Resident Routines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171 10.6.1 PRGRNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 10.6.2 ERARNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 10.6.3 LDRNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 10.6.4 MON_PRGRNGE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 10.6.5 MON_ERARNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 10.6.6 MON_LDRNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179 10.6.7 EE_WRITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 10.6.8 EE_READ. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Technical Data 12 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Table of Contents Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 11.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 11.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 11.4 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 11.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 11.5.1 TIM Counter Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 11.5.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 11.5.3 Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 11.5.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 11.5.3.2 Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 11.5.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 11.5.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 11.5.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 11.5.4.3 PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 11.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 11.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197 11.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 11.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 11.8 TIM During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 11.9 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 11.10 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 11.10.1 TIM Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 11.10.2 TIM Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 11.10.3 TIM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 11.10.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . .204 11.10.5 TIM Channel Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 Section 12. Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 12.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 13 Table of Contents 12.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 12.4.1 Time Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.2 Calendar Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.3 Alarm Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.4 Timebase Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.5 Chronograph Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215 12.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.6 RTC Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 12.6.1 RTC Control Register 1 (RTCCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 12.6.2 RTC Control Register 2 (RTCCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 12.6.3 RTC Status Register (RTCSR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219 12.6.4 Alarm Minute and Hour Registers (ALMR and ALHR) . . . . 222 12.6.5 Second Register (SECR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 12.6.6 Minute Register (MINR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 12.6.7 Hour Register (HRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 12.6.8 Day Register (DAYR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224 12.6.9 Month Register (MTHR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 12.6.10 Year Register (YRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 12.6.11 Day-Of-Week Register (DOWR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 12.6.12 Chronograph Data Register (CHRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Section 13. Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) 13.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 13.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 13.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 13.4 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 13.5 IRSCI Module Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231 13.6 Infrared Functional Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 13.6.1 Infrared Transmit Encoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 Technical Data 14 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Table of Contents 13.6.2 Infrared Receive Decoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 13.7 SCI Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 13.7.1 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 13.7.2 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 13.7.2.1 Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 13.7.2.2 Character Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 13.7.2.3 Break Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 13.7.2.4 Idle Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 13.7.2.5 Transmitter Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 13.7.3 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 13.7.3.1 Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 13.7.3.2 Character Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 13.7.3.3 Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 13.7.3.4 Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 13.7.3.5 Baud Rate Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 13.7.3.6 Receiver Wakeup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 13.7.3.7 Receiver Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 13.7.3.8 Error Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 13.8 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248 13.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 13.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 13.9 SCI During Break Module Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.10 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.10.1 PTB0/TxD (Transmit Data). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.10.2 PTB1/RxD (Receive Data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.11 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 13.11.1 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 13.11.2 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 13.11.3 SCI Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 13.11.4 SCI Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 13.11.5 SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 13.11.6 SCI Data Register (SCDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 13.11.7 SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 13.11.8 SCI Infrared Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 15 Table of Contents Section 14. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 14.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 14.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 14.4 Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses . . . . . . . 271 14.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 14.5.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 14.5.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 14.6 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 14.6.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 14.6.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 14.6.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 14.6.4 Transmission Initiation Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 14.7 Queuing Transmission Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 14.8 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 14.8.1 Overflow Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 14.9 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 14.10 Resetting the SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 14.11 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289 14.11.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 14.11.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 14.12 SPI During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290 14.13 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 14.13.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 14.13.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 14.13.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292 14.13.4 SS (Slave Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 14.13.5 CGND (Clock Ground) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 14.14 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 14.14.1 SPI Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Technical Data 16 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Table of Contents 14.14.2 SPI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296 14.14.3 SPI Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301 15.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 15.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 15.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 15.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 15.4.2 Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 15.4.3 Conversion Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 15.4.4 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 15.4.5 Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 15.4.6 Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307 15.5 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308 15.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.7.1 ADC Voltage In (VADIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.7.2 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.7.3 ADC Voltage Reference High Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 15.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 15.8.2 ADC Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312 15.8.3 ADC Clock Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 Section 16. Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 16.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317 16.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 16.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 17 Table of Contents 16.4 Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses . . . . . . . 318 16.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 16.5.1 LCD Duty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 16.5.2 LCD Voltages (VLCD, VLCD1, VLCD2, VLCD3) . . . . . . . . . . . 323 16.5.3 LCD Cycle Frame. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 16.5.4 Fast Charge and Low Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324 16.5.5 Contrast Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 16.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325 16.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 16.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 16.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 16.7.1 BP0–BP3 (Backplane Drivers) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .326 16.7.2 FP0–FP26 (Frontplane Drivers) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 16.8 Seven Segment Display Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332 16.9 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 16.9.1 LCD Control Register (LCDCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 16.9.2 LCD Clock Register (LCDCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 16.9.3 LCD Data Registers (LDAT1–LDAT14) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339 Section 17. Input/Output (I/O) Ports 17.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 17.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 17.3 Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 17.3.1 Port A Data Register (PTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 17.3.2 Data Direction Register A (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 17.4 Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347 17.4.1 Port B Data Register (PTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347 17.4.2 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348 17.4.3 Port B LED Control Register (LEDB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350 17.5 Port C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351 17.5.1 Port C Data Register (PTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351 17.5.2 Data Direction Register C (DDRC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352 Technical Data 18 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Table of Contents 17.6 Port D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354 17.6.1 Port D Data Register (PTD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354 17.6.2 Data Direction Register D (DDRD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355 Section 18. External Interrupt (IRQ) 18.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 18.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 18.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 18.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358 18.4.1 IRQ Pin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360 18.5 IRQ Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361 18.6 IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 Section 19. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 19.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 19.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 19.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 19.4 I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 19.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365 19.5.1 Keyboard Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367 19.6 Keyboard Interrupt Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367 19.6.1 Keyboard Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368 19.6.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 19.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369 19.8 Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 19.9 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370 19.10 Keyboard Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 19 Table of Contents Section 20. Computer Operating Properly (COP) 20.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371 20.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371 20.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372 20.4 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.1 ICLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.2 STOP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.3 COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.4 Power-On Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.5 Internal Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 20.4.6 Reset Vector Fetch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 20.4.7 COPD (COP Disable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374 20.4.8 COPRS (COP Rate Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 20.5 COP Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 20.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 20.7 Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 20.8 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375 20.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 20.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 20.9 COP Module During Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376 Section 21. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 21.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 21.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 21.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 21.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378 21.4.1 Interrupt LVI Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 21.4.2 Forced Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 21.4.3 Voltage Hysteresis Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 21.4.4 LVI Trip Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 21.5 LVI Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 Technical Data 20 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Table of Contents 21.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382 21.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382 21.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382 Section 22. Break Module (BRK) 22.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383 22.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383 22.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 22.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 22.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386 22.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 22.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386 22.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 22.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386 22.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 22.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 22.6 Break Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387 22.6.1 Break Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 22.6.2 Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388 22.6.3 SIM Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 22.6.4 SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390 Section 23. Electrical Specifications 23.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391 23.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 23.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392 23.4 Functional Operating Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 23.5 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 23.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 23.7 3.3V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 23.8 5.0V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Table of Contents 21 Table of Contents 23.9 3.3V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 23.10 5.0V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 23.11 3.3V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 23.12 5.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 23.13 3.3V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 23.14 Timer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 23.15 CGM Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 23.16 5.0V SPI Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402 23.17 3.3V SPI Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403 23.18 FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406 Section 24. Mechanical Specifications 24.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407 24.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407 24.3 52-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408 24.4 64-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409 24.5 64-Pin Quad Flat Pack (QFP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410 Section 25. Ordering Information 25.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 25.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 25.3 MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 Technical Data 22 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Table of Contents MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 List of Figures Figure Title 1-1 1-2 1-3 1-4 MC68HC908LJ12 Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 64-Pin QFP and 64-Pin LQFP Pin Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 52-Pin LQFP Pin Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Power Supply Bypassing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 2-1 2-2 Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Control, Status, and Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 4-1 4-2 4-3 4-4 4-5 FLASH I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 FLASH Control Register (FLCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 FLASH Programming Flowchart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67 FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 FLASH Block Protect Start Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 5-1 5-2 5-3 CONFIG Registers Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 6-1 6-2 6-3 6-4 6-5 6-6 CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Accumulator (A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Index Register (H:X) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Stack Pointer (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 Program Counter (PC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Condition Code Register (CCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 7-1 Oscillator Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 8-1 8-2 8-3 CGM Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 CGM I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Page Technical Data List of Figures 23 List of Figures Figure Title 8-4 8-5 8-6 8-7 8-8 8-9 8-10 PLL Control Register (PCTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 PLL Multiplier Select Register High (PMSH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 PLL Multiplier Select Register Low (PMSL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 PLL VCO Range Select Register (PMRS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 PLL Reference Divider Select Register (PMDS) . . . . . . . . . . 124 PLL Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 9-1 9-2 9-3 9-4 9-5 9-6 9-7 9-8 9-9 9-10 9-11 9-12 9-13 9-14 9-15 9-16 9-17 9-18 9-19 9-20 9-21 9-22 SIM Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 SIM I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 CGM Clock Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 External Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Internal Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Sources of Internal Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 POR Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Interrupt Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Interrupt Recovery Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Interrupt Processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Interrupt Recognition Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 Wait Mode Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 Wait Recovery from Interrupt or Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Wait Recovery from Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 Stop Mode Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151 Stop Mode Recovery from Interrupt or Break . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 10-1 10-2 10-3 10-4 10-5 Monitor Mode Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Low-Voltage Monitor Mode Entry Flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Monitor Data Format. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Break Transaction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Read Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Technical Data 24 Page MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 List of Figures MOTOROLA List of Figures Figure Title 10-6 10-7 10-8 10-9 10-10 Write Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Stack Pointer at Monitor Mode Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168 Monitor Mode Entry Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 Data Block Format for ROM-Resident Routines. . . . . . . . . . . 172 EE_WRITE FLASH Memory Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 11-1 11-2 11-3 11-4 11-5 11-6 11-7 11-8 11-9 11-10 11-11 11-12 11-13 11-14 11-15 TIM Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 TIM I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 PWM Period and Pulse Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 TIM Status and Control Register (TSC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 TIM Counter Registers High (TCNTH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 TIM Counter Registers Low (TCNTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 TIM Counter Modulo Register High (TMODH) . . . . . . . . . . . .203 TIM Counter Modulo Register Low (TMODL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 TIM Channel 0 Status and Control Register (TSC0) . . . . . . . 204 TIM Channel 1 Status and Control Register (TSC1) . . . . . . . 204 CHxMAX Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 TIM Channel 0 Register High (TCH0H) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 TIM Channel 0 Register Low (TCH0L) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 TIM Channel 1 Register High (TCH1H) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 TIM Channel 1 Register Low (TCH1L) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208 12-1 12-2 12-3 12-4 12-5 12-6 12-7 12-8 12-9 12-10 12-11 12-12 12-13 12-14 12-15 RTC I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210 RTC Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213 RTC Control Register 1 (RTCCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 RTC Control Register 2 (RTCCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 RTC Status Register (RTCSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Alarm Minute Register (ALMR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Alarm Hour Register (ALHR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 Second Register (SECR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Minute Register (MINR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 Hour Register (HRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Day Register (DAYR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 Month Register (MTHR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 Year Register (YRR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 Day-Of-Week Register (DOWR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Chronograph Data Register (CHRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Page Technical Data List of Figures 25 List of Figures Figure Title 13-1 13-2 13-3 13-4 13-5 13-6 13-7 13-8 13-9 13-10 13-11 13-12 13-13 13-14 13-15 13-16 13-17 13-18 13-19 13-20 IRSCI I/O Registers Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 IRSCI Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Infrared Sub-Module Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Infrared SCI Data Example. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 SCI Module Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 SCI Data Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235 SCI Transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236 SCI Receiver Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Receiver Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241 Slow Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244 Fast Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245 SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254 SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Flag Clearing Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .261 SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 SCI Data Register (SCDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 SCI Infrared Control Register (SCIRCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 14-1 14-2 14-3 14-4 14-5 14-6 14-7 14-8 14-9 14-10 14-11 14-12 14-13 14-14 14-15 SPI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 SPI Module Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272 Full-Duplex Master-Slave Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 Transmission Format (CPHA = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 CPHA/SS Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277 Transmission Format (CPHA = 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Transmission Start Delay (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 SPRF/SPTE CPU Interrupt Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Missed Read of Overflow Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283 Clearing SPRF When OVRF Interrupt Is Not Enabled . . . . . . 284 SPI Interrupt Request Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287 CPHA/SS Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 SPI Control Register (SPCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 SPI Status and Control Register (SPSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296 SPI Data Register (SPDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 Technical Data 26 Page MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 List of Figures MOTOROLA List of Figures Figure Title 15-1 15-2 15-3 15-4 15-5 15-6 15-7 15-8 15-9 ADC I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303 ADC Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304 8-Bit Truncation Mode Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307 ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 ADRH and ADRL in 8-Bit Truncated Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312 ADRH and ADRL in Right Justified Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312 ADRH and ADRL in Left Justified Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313 ADRH and ADRL in Left Justified Sign Data Mode . . . . . . . . 313 ADC Clock Control Register (ADICLK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 16-1 16-2 16-3 16-4 16-5 16-6 16-7 16-8 16-9 16-10 16-11 16-12 16-13 16-14 16-15 16-16 16-17 16-18 LCD I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319 LCD Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 Simplified LCD Schematic (1/3 Duty, 1/3 Bias) . . . . . . . . . . . 322 Fast Charge Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324 1/3 Duty LCD Backplane Driver Waveforms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 Static LCD Backplane Driver Waveform. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 1/4 Duty LCD Backplane Driver Waveforms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327 Static LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 1/3 Duty LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329 1/4 Duty LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330 1/4 Duty LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms (continued) . . . . 331 7-Segment Display Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332 BP0–BP2 and FP0–FP2 Output Waveforms for 7-Segment Display Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333 "f" Segment Voltage Waveform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 "e" Segment Voltage Waveform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334 LCD Control Register (LCDCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 LCD Clock Register (LCDCLK). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 LCD Data Registers 1–14 (LDAT1–LDAT14) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339 17-1 17-2 17-3 17-4 17-5 17-6 17-7 I/O Port Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342 Port A Data Register (PTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344 Data Direction Register A (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 Port A I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346 Port B Data Register (PTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .347 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 Port B I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Page Technical Data List of Figures 27 List of Figures Figure Title 17-8 17-9 17-10 17-11 17-12 17-13 17-14 Port B LED Control Register (LEDB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .350 Port C Data Register (PTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .351 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352 Port C I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352 Port D Data Register (PTD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .354 Data Direction Register D (DDRD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355 Port D I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 18-1 18-2 IRQ Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .359 IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362 19-1 19-2 19-3 19-4 KBI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 Keyboard Interrupt Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365 Keyboard Status and Control Register (KBSCR) . . . . . . . . . . 368 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register (KBIER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 20-1 20-2 20-3 COP Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372 Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374 COP Control Register (COPCTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375 21-1 21-2 LVI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378 LVI Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378 22-1 22-2 22-3 22-4 22-5 22-6 22-7 Break Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385 Break Module I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385 Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR). . . . . . . . . . . . 387 Break Address Register High (BRKH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 Break Address Register Low (BRKL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389 SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390 23-1 23-2 SPI Master Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .404 SPI Slave Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405 24-1 24-2 24-3 52-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (Case No. 848D). . . . . . . 408 64-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (Case No. 840F) . . . . . . . 409 64-Pin Quad Flat Pack (Case No. 840B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410 Technical Data 28 Page MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 List of Figures MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 List of Tables Table Title 2-1 Vector Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 5-1 LVI Trip Point Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 6-1 6-2 Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86 Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 8-1 8-3 8-2 Numeric Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 VPR1 and VPR0 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 PRE 1 and PRE0 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 9-1 9-2 9-3 Signal Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 PIN Bit Set Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 Vector Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146 10-1 10-2 10-3 10-4 10-5 10-6 10-7 10-8 10-9 10-10 10-11 10-12 10-13 10-14 10-15 Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options . . . . . . . . . . 160 Mode Differences (Vectors) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .162 Monitor Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 READ (Read Memory) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 WRITE (Write Memory) Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 IREAD (Indexed Read) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167 RUN (Run User Program) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 Summary of ROM-Resident Routines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 PRGRNGE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 ERARNGE Routine. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 LDRNGE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 MON_PRGRNGE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 MON_ERARNGE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Page Technical Data List of Tables 29 List of Tables Table Title Page 10-16 ICP_LDRNGE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 10-17 EE_WRITE Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 10-18 EE_READ Routine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183 11-1 11-2 11-3 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Prescaler Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 Mode, Edge, and Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 12-1 CGMXCLK Frequency for RTC Input Reference . . . . . . . . . . 219 13-1 13-2 13-3 13-4 13-5 13-6 13-7 13-8 13-9 13-10 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Start Bit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Data Bit Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Stop Bit Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 SCI Pin Functions (Standard and Infrared). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250 Character Format Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253 SCI Baud Rate Prescaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 SCI Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 SCI Baud Rate Selection Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266 Infrared Narrow Pulse Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 14-1 14-2 14-3 14-4 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 SPI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 SPI Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 SPI Master Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298 15-1 15-2 15-3 MUX Channel Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311 ADC Clock Divide Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 ADC Mode Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315 16-1 16-3 16-2 16-4 16-5 16-6 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 LCD Bias Voltage Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336 Resistor Ladder Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336 Fast Charge Duty Cycle Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 LCD Duty Cycle Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338 LCD Waveform Base Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338 Technical Data 30 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 List of Tables MOTOROLA List of Tables Table Title 17-1 17-2 17-3 17-4 17-5 Port Control Register Bits Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343 Port A Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346 Port B Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350 Port C Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353 Port D Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356 18-1 IRQ I/O Port Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359 19-1 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 21-1 21-2 LVI Status Register (LVISR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 LVIOUT Bit Indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 23-1 23-2 23-3 23-4 23-5 23-6 23-7 23-8 23-9 23-10 23-11 23-12 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392 Operating Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 3.3V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 5.0V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 3.3V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 5.0V Oscillator Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 3.3V Oscillator Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 ADC 5.0V Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 ADC 3.3V Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 FLASH Memory Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406 25-1 MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Page Technical Data List of Tables 31 List of Tables Technical Data 32 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 List of Tables MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 1. General Description 1.1 Contents 1.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 1.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 1.4 MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 1.5 Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 1.6 Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 1.6.1 Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 1.6.2 Analog Power Supply Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 1.6.3 Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.4 External Reset Pin (RST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.5 External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.6 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.7 ADC Voltage High Reference Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.8 ADC Voltage Low Reference Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 1.6.9 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0) . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.10 Port B I/O Pins (PTB7–PTB0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.11 Port C I/O Pins (PTC7–PTC0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.12 Port D I/O Pins (PTD7–PTD0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 1.6.13 LCD Backplane and Frontplane (BP0–BP2, FP0/BP3, FP1–FP18). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data General Description 33 General Description 1.2 Introduction The MC68HC908LJ12 is a member of the low-cost, high-performance M68HC08 Family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). The M68HC08 Family is based on the customer-specified integrated circuit (CSIC) design strategy. All MCUs in the family use the enhanced M68HC08 central processor unit (CPU08) and are available with a variety of modules, memory sizes and types, and package types. 1.3 Features Features of the MC68HC908LJ12 include the following: • High-performance M68HC08 architecture • Fully upward-compatible object code with M6805, M146805, and M68HC05 Families • Maximum internal bus frequency: – 8-MHz at 5V operating voltage – 4-MHz at 3.3V operating voltage • 32-kHz crystal oscillator clock input with 32MHz internal phaselock-loop • Optional continuous crystal oscillator operation in stop mode • 12k-bytes user program FLASH memory with security1 feature • 512 bytes of on-chip RAM • Two 16-bit, 2-channel timer interface modules (TIM1 and TIM2) with selectable input capture, output compare, and PWM capability on each channel • Real time clock (RTC) with clock, calendar, alarm, and chronograph functions. Selectable periodic interrupt requests for seconds, minutes, hours, days, 2-Hz, 4-Hz, and 100-Hz • Serial communications interface module (SCI) with infrared (IR) encoder/decoder 1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users. Technical Data 34 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 General Description MOTOROLA General Description Features • Serial peripheral interface module (SPI) • IRQ external interrupt pin with integrated pullup • 8-bit keyboard wakeup port with programmable pullup • 32 general-purpose input/output (I/O) pins: – High current 8-mA sink capability on PTB2–PTB5 – High current 20-mA sink capability on PTB0–PTB1 • 4/3 backplanes and static with maximum 27 frontplanes liquid crystal display (LCD) driver • 6-channel, 10-bit successive approximation analog-to-digital converter (ADC) • Resident routines for in-circuit programming and EEPROM emulation • Low-power design (fully static with stop and wait modes) • Master reset pin (with integrated pullup) and power-on reset • Spike filter protection for EMC performance enhancement • System protection features – Optional computer operating properly (COP) reset, driven by internal 64-kHz RC oscillator – Low-voltage detection with optional reset or interrupt – Illegal opcode detection with reset – Illegal address detection with reset • 64-pin quad flat pack (QFP), 64-pin low-profile quad flat pack (LQFP), 52-pin low-profile quad flat pack (LQFP), and die form • Specific features of the MC68HC908LJ12 in 52-pin LQFP are: – 20 general-purpose I/Os only – High current 8-mA sink capability on PTB2–PTB3 only – 4-bit keyboard wakeup port with programmable pullup – No serial peripheral interface module (SPI) – No TIM2 input capture/output compare pins – 4-channel analog-to-digital converter only MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data General Description 35 General Description Features of the CPU08 include the following: • Enhanced HC05 programming model • Extensive loop control functions • 16 addressing modes (eight more than the HC05) • 16-bit Index register and stack pointer • Memory-to-memory data transfers • Fast 8 × 8 multiply instruction • Fast 16/8 divide instruction • Binary-coded decimal (BCD) instructions • Optimization for controller applications • Efficient C language support 1.4 MCU Block Diagram Figure 1-1 shows the structure of the MC68HC908LJ12. Technical Data 36 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 General Description MOTOROLA General Description MCU Block Diagram INTERNAL BUS PORTA CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 96 BYTES KEYBOARD INTERRUPT MODULE PORTB ARITHMETIC/LOGIC UNIT (ALU) PTA7/ADC3 PTA6/ADC2 PTA5/ADC1 PTA4/ADC0 PTA3/KBI3** PTA2/KBI2** PTA1/KBI1** PTA0/KBI0** PTB7/ADC5 PTB6/ADC4 PTB5/T2CH1‡ PTB4/T2CH0‡ PTB3/T1CH1‡ PTB2/T1CH0‡ PTB1/RxD† PTB0/TxD† PORTC CPU REGISTERS DDRA M68HC08 CPU PTC7/FP26 PTC6/FP25 PTC5/FP24 PTC4/FP23 PTC3/FP22 PTC2/FP21 PTC1/FP20 PTC0/FP19 10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER MODULE USER FLASH — 12,288 BYTES USER RAM — 512 BYTES 2-CHANNEL TIMER INTERFACE MODULE 1 USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 48 BYTES CLOCK GENERATOR MODULE OSC1 CGMXFC 32.768-kHz OSCILLATOR SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE (WITH INFRARED ENCODER/DECODER) PHASE-LOCKED LOOP REAL TIME CLOCK MODULE * RST SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE * IRQ EXTERNAL INTERRUPT MODULE DDRC OSC2 2-CHANNEL TIMER INTERFACE MODULE 2 DDRB MONITOR ROM — 960 BYTES LIQUID CRYSTAL DISPLAY DRIVER MODULE # FP1–FP18 BP0–BP2 COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY MODULE LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT MODULE VDDA VDD POWER VSS VREFH VREFL ADC REFERENCE PORTD SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE MODULE DDRD POWER-ON RESET MODULE FP0/BP3 PTD7/KBI7** PTD6/KBI6** PTD5/KBI5** PTD4/KBI4** PTD3/SPSCK PTD2/MOSI PTD1/MISO PTD0/SS # * Pin contains integrated pullup device. ** Pin contains integrated pullup device if configured as KBI. † High current sink pin, 15mA. ‡ High current sink pin, 8mA. # Pins available on 64-pin packages only. Figure 1-1. MC68HC908LJ12 Block Diagram MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data General Description 37 General Description BP1 BP0 PTB5/T2CH1 PTB4/T2CH0 PTB3/T1CH1 PTB2/T1CH0 PTB1/RxD PTB0/TxD CGMXFC OSC2 OSC1 VSS VDD 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 FP0/BP3 1 49 VDDA BP2 63 64 PTD4/KBI4 1.5 Pin Assignments 48 VREFL FP7 9 40 PTA3/KBI3 FP8 10 39 PTA2/KBI2 PTD6/KBI6 11 38 PTA1/KBI1 PTD7/KBI7 12 37 PTA0/KBI0 FP9 13 36 PTC7/FP26 FP10 14 35 PTC6/FP25 FP11 15 34 PTC5/FP24 PTD3/SPSCK PTD0/SS 32 33 RST 16 17 FP12 31 PTA4/ADC0 IRQ 41 30 8 PTC4/FP23 FP6 29 PTA5/ADC1 PTC3/FP22 42 28 7 PTC2/FP21 FP5 27 PTA6/ADC2 PTC1/FP20 43 26 6 PTD1/MISO FP4 25 PTA7/ADC3 PTD2/MOSI 44 24 5 PTC0/FP19 FP3 23 PTB6/ADC4 FP18 45 22 4 FP17 FP2 21 PTB7/ADC5 FP16 46 20 3 FP15 FP1 19 VREFH FP14 47 18 2 FP13 PTD5/KBI5 Figure 1-2. 64-Pin QFP and 64-Pin LQFP Pin Assignment Technical Data 38 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 General Description MOTOROLA BP0 PTB3/T1CH1 PTB2/T1CH0 PTB1/RxD PTB0/TxD CGMXFC OSC2 OSC1 VSS VDD 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 FP0/BP3 1 40 VDDA BP1 51 52 BP2 General Description Pin Assignments 39 VREFL 33 PTA3/KBI3 FP7 8 32 PTA2/KBI2 FP8 9 31 PTA1/KBI1 FP9 10 30 PTA0/KBI0 FP10 11 29 PTC7/FP26 FP11 12 28 PTC6/FP25 FP13 PTC5/FP24 26 27 RST 13 14 FP12 25 7 IRQ FP6 24 PTA4/ADC0 PTC4/FP23 34 23 6 PTC3/FP22 FP5 22 PTA5/ADC1 PTC2/FP21 35 21 5 PTC1/FP20 FP4 20 PTA6/ADC2 PTC0/FP19 36 19 4 FP18 FP3 18 PTA7/ADC3 FP17 37 17 3 FP16 FP2 16 VREFH FP15 38 15 2 FP14 FP1 Pins not available on 52-LQFP package: PTB7ADC5 PTD7/KBI7 PTB6/ADC4 PTD6/KBI6 PTB5/T2CH1 PTD5/KBI5 PTB4/T2CH0 PTD4/KBI4 PTD3/SPSCK PTD2/MOSI PTD1/MISO PTD0/SS Internal pads are unconnected. Figure 1-3. 52-Pin LQFP Pin Assignment MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data General Description 39 General Description 1.6 Pin Functions Description of pin functions are provided here. 1.6.1 Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS) VDD and VSS are the power supply and ground pins. The MCU operates from a single power supply. Fast signal transitions on MCU pins place high, short-duration current demands on the power supply. To prevent noise problems, take special care to provide power supply bypassing at the MCU as Figure 1-4 shows. Place the C1 bypass capacitor as close to the MCU as possible. Use a high-frequency-response ceramic capacitor for C1. C2 is an optional bulk current bypass capacitor for use in applications that require the port pins to source high current levels. VSS must be grounded for proper MCU operation. 1.6.2 Analog Power Supply Pin (VDDA) VDDA is the voltage supply for the analog parts of the MCU. Connect the VDDA pin to the same voltage potential as VDD. For maximum noise immunity, route VDDA via a separate trace and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package (see Figure 1-4). MCU VDD 0.1 µF VDDA VSS 0.1 µF C1(a) C1(b) + + C2(a) C2(b) VDD NOTE: Component values shown represent typical applications. VDD Figure 1-4. Power Supply Bypassing Technical Data 40 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 General Description MOTOROLA General Description Pin Functions 1.6.3 Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) The OSC1 and OSC2 pins are the connections for the on-chip oscillator circuit. The OSC1 pin contains a schmitt-trigger and a spike filter for improved EMC performance. See Section 7. Oscillator (OSC). 1.6.4 External Reset Pin (RST) A logic 0 on the RST pin forces the MCU to a known start-up state. RST is bidirectional, allowing a reset of the entire system. It is driven low when any internal reset source is asserted. A schmitt-trigger and a spike filter is associated with this pin so that the device is more robust to EMC noise.This pin also contains an internal pullup resistor. See Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM). 1.6.5 External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) IRQ is an asynchronous external interrupt pin. This pin contains an internal pullup resistor. See Section 18. External Interrupt (IRQ). 1.6.6 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) CGMXFC is an external filter capacitor connection for the CGM. See Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM). 1.6.7 ADC Voltage High Reference Pin (VREFH) VREFH is the voltage input pin for the ADC voltage high reference. See Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 1.6.8 ADC Voltage Low Reference Pin (VREFL) VREFL is the voltage input pin for the ADC voltage low reference. See Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data General Description 41 General Description 1.6.9 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0) PTA7–PTA0 are special function, bidirectional port pins (Section 17.). PTA7/ADC3–PTA4/ADC0 are shared with the ADC (Section 15.), and PTA3/KBI3–PTA0/KBI0 are shared with the KBI module (Section 19.). 1.6.10 Port B I/O Pins (PTB7–PTB0) PTB7–PTB0 are special function, bidirectional port pins (Section 17.). PTB0/TxD–PTB1/RxD are shared with the SCI module (Section 13.), PTB5/T2CH1–PTB4/T2CH0 are shared with the TIM2 (Section 11.), PTB3/T1CH1–PTB2/T1CH0 are shared with the TIM1(Section 11.), PTB6/ADC4–PTB7/ADC5 are shared with the ADC (Section 15.). 1.6.11 Port C I/O Pins (PTC7–PTC0) PTC7–PTC0 are special function, bidirectional port pins (Section 17.). PTC7/FP26–PTC0/FP19 are shared with the LCD frontplane drivers (Section 16.). 1.6.12 Port D I/O Pins (PTD7–PTD0) PTD7–PTD0 are special function, bidirectional port pins (Section 17.). PTD7/KBI7–PTD4/KBI4 are shared with KBI module (Section 19.). PTD3/SPSCK–PTD0/SS are shared with SPI module (Section 14.). 1.6.13 LCD Backplane and Frontplane (BP0–BP2, FP0/BP3, FP1–FP18) BP0–BP2 are the LCD backplane driver pins and FP1– FP18 are the frontplane driver pins. FP0/BP3 is the shared driver pin between FP0 and BP3 (Section 16.). Technical Data 42 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 General Description MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 2. Memory Map 2.1 Contents 2.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 2.3 Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 2.4 Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 2.5 Input/Output (I/O) Section. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 2.2 Introduction The CPU08 can address 64k-bytes of memory space. The memory map, shown in Figure 2-1, includes: • 12,288 bytes of user FLASH memory • 512 bytes of random-access memory (RAM) • 48 bytes of user-defined vectors • 960 bytes of monitor ROM 2.3 Unimplemented Memory Locations Accessing an unimplemented location can cause an illegal address reset if illegal address resets are enabled. In the memory map (Figure 2-1) and in register figures in this document, unimplemented locations are shaded. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 43 Memory Map 2.4 Reserved Memory Locations Accessing a reserved location can have unpredictable effects on MCU operation. In the Figure 2-1 and in register figures in this document, reserved locations are marked with the word Reserved or with the letter R. 2.5 Input/Output (I/O) Section Most of the control, status, and data registers are in the zero page area of $0000–$005F. Additional I/O registers have these addresses: • $FE00; SIM break status register, SBSR • $FE01; SIM reset status register, SRSR • $FE02; Reserved • $FE03; SIM break flag control register, SBFCR • $FE04; Interrupt status register 1, INT1 • $FE05; Interrupt status register 2, INT2 • $FE06; Interrupt status register 3, INT3 • $FE07; Reserved • $FE08; FLASH control register, FLCR • $FE09; FLASH block protect register, FLBPR • $FE0A; Reserved • $FE0B; Reserved • $FE0C; Break address register high, BRKH • $FE0D; Break address register low, BRKL • $FE0E; Break status and control register, BRKSCR • $FE0F; LVI status register, LVISR • $FFFF; COP control register, COPCTL Data registers are shown in Figure 2-2. Table 2-1 is a list of vector locations. Technical Data 44 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Memory Map Input/Output (I/O) Section $0000 ↓ $005F I/O Registers 96 Bytes $0060 ↓ $025F RAM 512 Bytes $0260 ↓ $BFFF Unimplemented 48,544 Bytes $C000 ↓ $EFFF FLASH Memory 12,288 Bytes $F000 ↓ $FBFF Unimplemented 3,072 Bytes $FC00 ↓ $FDFF Monitor ROM 1 512 Bytes $FE00 SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) $FE01 SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) $FE02 Reserved $FE03 SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) $FE04 Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1) $FE05 Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2) $FE06 Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3) $FE07 Reserved $FE08 FLASH Control Register (FLCR) $FE09 FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR) $FE0A Reserved $FE0B Reserved $FE0C Break Address Register High (BRKH) $FE0D Break Address Register Low (BRKL) $FE0E Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR) $FE0F LVI Status Register (LVISR) $FE10 ↓ $FFCF Monitor ROM 2 448 Bytes $FFD0 ↓ $FFFF FLASH Vectors 48 Bytes Figure 2-1. Memory Map MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 45 Memory Map Addr. Register Name $0000 Read: Port A Data Register Write: (PTA) Reset: $0001 $0002 $0003 Read: Port B Data Register Write: (PTB) Reset: Read: Port C Data Register Write: (PTC) Reset: Read: Port D Data Register Write: (PTD) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PTA7 PTA6 PTA5 PTA4 PTA3 PTA2 PTA1 PTA0 U U U U U U U U PTB7 PTB6 PTB5 PTB4 PTB3 PTB2 PTB1 PTB0 U U U U U U U U PTC7 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1 PTC0 U U U U U U U U PTD7 PTD6 PTD5 PTD4 PTD3 PTD2 PTD1 PTD0 U U U U U U U U DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R Read: DDRA7 Data Direction Register A $0004 Write: (DDRA) Reset: 0 Read: DDRB7 Data Direction Register B $0005 Write: (DDRB) Reset: 0 Read: DDRC7 Data Direction Register C $0006 Write: (DDRC) Reset: 0 Read: DDRD7 Data Direction Register D $0007 Write: (DDRD) Reset: 0 Read: $0008 Unimplemented Write: Reset: Read: $0009 Unimplemented Write: Reset: U = Unaffected X = Indeterminate = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 1 of 12) Technical Data 46 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Memory Map Input/Output (I/O) Section Addr. Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 LEDB5 LEDB4 LEDB3 LEDB2 LEDB1 LEDB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SPRIE R SPMSTR CPOL CPHA SPWOM SPE SPTIE 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 OVRF MODF SPTE MODFEN SPR1 SPR0 Read: $000A Unimplemented Write: Reset: Read: $000B Unimplemented Write: Reset: Read: Port B LED Control Register Write: (LEDB) Reset: $000C Read: $000D Unimplemented Write: Reset: Read: Unimplemented $000E Write: Reset: Read: $000F Unimplemented Write: Reset: $0010 $0011 Read: SPI Control Register Write: (SPCR) Reset: Read: SPI Status and Control Register Write: (SPSCR) Reset: Read: SPI Data Register Write: (SPDR) Reset: $0012 $0013 SPRF 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 R7 R6 R5 R4 R3 R2 R1 R0 T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 U U U U U U U U M WAKE ILTY PEN PTY 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R Read: LOOPS SCI Control Register 1 Write: (SCC1) Reset: 0 U = Unaffected ERRIE ENSCI 0 0 0 X = Indeterminate = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 2 of 12) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 47 Memory Map Addr. $0014 $0015 $0016 $0017 $0018 $0019 $001A $001B $001C $001D Register Name Read: SCI Control Register 2 Write: (SCC2) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 SCTIE TCIE SCRIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 T8 DMARE DMATE ORIE NEIE FEIE PEIE Read: SCI Control Register 3 Write: (SCC3) Reset: R8 U U 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: SCI Status Register 1 Write: (SCS1) Reset: SCTE TC SCRF IDLE OR NF FE PE 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: SCI Status Register 2 Write: (SCS2) Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 BKF RPF 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: SCI Data Register Write: (SCDR) Reset: R7 R6 R5 R4 R3 R2 R1 R0 T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 U U U U U U U U SCP1 SCP0 R SCR2 SCR1 SCR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R TNP1 TNP0 IREN 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KEYF 0 IMASKK MODEK Read: SCI Baud Rate Register Write: (SCBR) Reset: Read: SCI Infrared Control Register Write: (SCIRCR) Reset: Keyboard Status and Read: Control Register Write: (KBSCR) Reset: Read: Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register Write: (KBIER) Reset: Read: Configuration Register 2 Write: (CONFIG2)† Reset: U = Unaffected CKS 0 R 0 ACKK 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KBIE7 KBIE6 KBIE5 KBIE4 KBIE3 KBIE2 KBIE1 KBIE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 STOP_ IRCDIS PCEH PCEL LVISEL1 LVISEL0 0 0 0 0 0†† 0†† = Unimplemented R STOP_ DIV2CLK XCLKEN 0 X = Indeterminate 0 = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 3 of 12) Technical Data 48 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Memory Map Input/Output (I/O) Section Addr. $001E $001F Register Name Read: IRQ Status and Control Register Write: (INTSCR) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 IRQF 0 IMASK MODE 0 0 0 SSREC STOP COPD 0 0 0 PS2 PS1 PS0 ACK 0 Read: COPRS Configuration Register 1 † Write: (CONFIG1) Reset: 0 0 0 0 LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD 0 0 TOIE TSTOP 0 0 1 0 0 0 † One-time writable register after each reset. †† Reset by POR only. $0020 $0021 $0022 $0023 $0024 Read: Timer 1 Status and Control Register Write: (T1SC) Reset: TOF 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 1 Counter Register High Write: (T1CNTH) Reset: Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 1 Counter Register Low Write: (T1CNTL) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 CH0IE MS0B MS0A ELS0B ELS0A TOV0 CH0MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 X X X X X X X X = Unimplemented R Read: Timer 1 Counter Modulo Register High Write: (T1MODH) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Counter Modulo Register Low Write: (T1MODL) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Channel 0 Status $0025 and Control Register Write: (T1SC0) Reset: $0026 Read: Timer 1 Channel 0 Register High Write: (T1CH0H) Reset: U = Unaffected 0 CH0F 0 X = Indeterminate TRST = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 4 of 12) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 49 Memory Map Addr. $0027 Register Name Read: Timer 1 Channel 0 Register Low Write: (T1CH0L) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Channel 1 Status $0028 and Control Register Write: (T1SC1) Reset: $0029 $002A $002B Read: Timer 1 Channel 1 Register High Write: (T1CH1H) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Channel 1 Register Low Write: (T1CH1L) Reset: 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 X X X X X X X X MS1A ELS1B ELS1A TOV1 CH1MAX CH1F 0 CH1IE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 X X X X X X X X Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 X X X X X X X X TOIE TSTOP 0 0 PS2 PS1 PS0 TOF 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 2 Counter Register High Write: (T2CNTH) Reset: Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 2 Counter Register Low Write: (T2CNTL) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 CH0IE MS0B MS0A ELS0B ELS0A TOV0 CH0MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R $002D $002F 6 Read: Timer 2 Status and Control Register Write: (T2SC) Reset: $002C $002E Bit 7 Read: Timer 2 Counter Modulo Register High Write: (T2MODH) Reset: Read: Timer 2 Counter Modulo Register Low Write: (T2MODL) Reset: Read: Timer 2 Channel 0 Status $0030 and Control Register Write: (T2SC0) Reset: U = Unaffected 0 CH0F 0 0 X = Indeterminate TRST = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 5 of 12) Technical Data 50 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Memory Map Input/Output (I/O) Section Addr. Register Name Read: Timer 2 Channel 0 Register High Write: (T2CH0H) Reset: $0031 Read: Timer 2 Channel 0 Register Low Write: (T2CH0L) Reset: $0032 Read: Timer 2 Channel 1 Status $0033 and Control Register Write: (T2SC1) Reset: Read: Timer 2 Channel 1 Register High Write: (T2CH1H) Reset: $0034 Read: Timer 2 Channel 1 Register Low Write: (T2CH1L) Reset: $0035 $0036 $0037 $0038 $0039 $003A Read: PLL Control Register Write: (PTCL) Reset: Read: PLL Bandwidth Control Register Write: (PBWC) Reset: Read: PLL Multiplier Select Register High Write: (PMSH) Reset: Read: PLL Multiplier Select Register Low Write: (PMSL) Reset: Read: PLL VCO Range Select Register Write: (PMRS) Reset: U = Unaffected Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 X X X X X X X X Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 X X X X X X X X MS1A ELS1B ELS1A TOV1 CH1MAX CH1F 0 CH1IE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 X X X X X X X X Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 X X X X X X X X PLLON BCS PRE1 PRE0 VPR1 VPR0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MUL11 MUL10 MUL9 MUL8 PLLIE 0 AUTO PLLF 0 LOCK ACQ R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MUL7 MUL6 MUL5 MUL4 MUL3 MUL2 MUL1 MUL0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 VRS7 VRS6 VRS5 VRS4 VRS3 VRS2 VRS1 VRS0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R X = Indeterminate = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 6 of 12) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 51 Memory Map Addr. $003B $003C $003D $003E Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 Read: PLL Reference Divider Select Register Write: (PMDS) Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: ADC Status and Control Register Write: (ADSCR) Reset: COCO AIEN 0 Read: ADC Data Register High Write: (ADRH) Reset: Read: ADC Data Register Low (ADRL) Write: Reset: $003F Read: ADC Clock Register (ADCLK) Write: Reset: 3 2 1 Bit 0 RDS3 RDS2 RDS1 RDS0 0 0 0 0 1 ADCO ADCH4 ADCH3 ADCH2 ADCH1 ADCH0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADIV2 ADIV1 ADIV0 ADICLK MODE1 MODE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 ALMIE CHRIE DAYIE HRIE MINIE SECIE TB1IE TB2IE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R CHRCLR CHRE RTCE XTL2 XTL1 XTL0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ALMF CHRF DAYF HRF MINF SECF TB1F TB2F 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R R Read: Unimplemented $0040 Write: Reset: Read: $0041 Unimplemented Write: Reset: $0042 $0043 $0044 Read: RTC Control Register 1 Write: (RTCCR1) Reset: Read: RTC Control Register 2 Write: (RTCCR2) Reset: Read: RTC Status Register Write: (RTCSR) Reset: U = Unaffected X = Indeterminate 0 = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 7 of 12) Technical Data 52 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Memory Map Input/Output (I/O) Section Addr. $0045 $0046 Register Name Bit 7 6 Read: Alarm Minute Register Write: (ALMR) Reset: 0 0 0 Read: Alarm Hour Register Write: (ALHR) Reset: Read: Second Register Write: (SECR) Reset: $0047 Read: Minute Register Write: (MINR) Reset: $0048 Read: Hour Register Write: (HRR) Reset: $0049 Read: Day Register Write: (DAYR) Reset: $004A Read: Month Register Write: (MTHR) Reset: $004B Read: Year Register Write: (YRR) Reset: $004C $004D Read: Day-Of-Week Register Write: (DOWR) Reset: $004E Read: Chronograph Data Register Write: (CHRR) Reset: U = Unaffected 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AH4 AH3 AH2 AH1 AH0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SEC5 SEC4 SEC3 SEC2 SEC1 SEC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MIN5 MIN4 MIN3 MIN2 MIN1 MIN0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 HR4 HR3 HR2 HR1 HR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DAY4 DAY3 DAY2 DAY1 DAY0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 MTH3 MTH2 MTH1 MTH0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 YR7 YR6 YR5 YR4 YR3 YR2 YR1 YR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DOW2 DOW1 DOW0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CHR6 CHR5 CHR4 CHR3 CHR2 CHR1 CHR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R X = Indeterminate = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 8 of 12) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 53 Memory Map Addr. $004F Register Name Bit 7 Read: LCD Clock Register Write: (LCDCLK) Reset: Read: $0050 Reserved Write: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 FCCTL1 FCCTL0 DUTY1 DUTY0 LCLK2 LCLK1 LCLK0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R R R R R R R R FC LC LCCON3 LCCON2 LCCON1 LCCON0 0 Reset: $0051 $0052 $0053 $0054 $0055 $0056 $0057 $0058 Read: LCD Control Register Write: (LCDCR) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 1 Write: (LDAT1) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 2 Write: (LDAT2) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 3 Write: (LDAT3) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 4 Write: (LDAT4) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 5 Write: (LDAT5) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 6 Write: (LDAT6) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 7 Write: (LDAT7) Reset: U = Unaffected LCDE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 F1B3 F1B2 F1B1 F1B0 F0B3 F0B2 F0B1 F0B0 U U U U U U U U F3B3 F3B2 F3B1 F3B0 F2B3 F2B2 F2B1 F2B0 U U U U U U U U F5B3 F5B2 F5B1 F5B0 F4B3 F4B2 F4B1 F4B0 U U U U U U U U F7B3 F7B2 F7B1 F7B0 F6B3 F6B2 F6B1 F6B0 U U U U U U U U F9B3 F9B2 F9B1 F9B0 F8B3 F8B2 F8B1 F8B0 U U U U U U U U F11B3 F11B2 F11B1 F11B0 F10B3 F10B2 F10B1 F10B0 U U U U U U U U F13B3 F13B2 F13B1 F13B0 F12B3 F12B2 F12B1 F12B0 U U U U U U U U = Unimplemented R X = Indeterminate = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 9 of 12) Technical Data 54 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Memory Map Input/Output (I/O) Section Addr. Register Name $0059 Read: LCD Data Register 8 Write: (LDAT8) Reset: $005A $005B $005C $005D $005E $005F Read: LCD Data Register 9 Write: (LDAT9) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 10 Write: (LDAT10) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 11 Write: (LDAT11) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 12 Write: (LDAT12) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 13 Write: (LDAT13) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 14 Write: (LDAT14) Reset: Read: SIM Break Status Register $FE00 Write: (SBSR) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 F15B3 F15B2 F15B1 F15B0 F14B3 F14B2 F14B1 F14B0 U U U U U U U U F17B3 F17B2 F17B1 F17B0 F16B3 F16B2 F16B1 F16B0 U U U U U U U U F19B3 F19B2 F19B1 F19B0 F18B3 F18B2 F18B1 F18B0 U U U U U U U U F21B3 F21B2 F21B1 F21B0 F20B3 F20B2 F20B1 F20B0 U U U U U U U U F23B3 F23B2 F23B1 F23B0 F22B3 F22B2 F22B1 F22B0 U U U U U U U U F25B3 F25B2 F25B1 F25B0 F24B3 F24B2 F24B1 F24B0 U U U U U U U U F26B3 F26B2 F26B1 F26B0 U U U U U U U U R R R R R R SBSW Note R 0 Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW. Read: SIM Reset Status Register $FE01 Write: (SRSR) POR: U = Unaffected POR PIN COP ILOP ILAD 0 LVI 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R X = Indeterminate = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 10 of 12) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 55 Memory Map Addr. Register Name Read: $FE02 Reserved Write: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 R R R R R R R R BCFE R R R R R R R Reset: $FE03 Read: SIM Break Flag Control Register Write: (SBFCR) Reset: 0 Read: Interrupt Status Register 1 $FE04 Write: (INT1) Reset: IF6 IF5 IF4 IF3 IF2 IF1 0 0 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Interrupt Status Register 2 Write: $FE05 (INT2) Reset: IF14 IF13 IF12 IF11 IF10 IF9 IF8 IF7 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Interrupt Status Register 3 $FE06 Write: (INT3) Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 IF17 IF16 IF15 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 HVEN MASS ERASE PGM 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BPR7 BPR6 BPR5 BPR4 BPR3 BPR2 BPR1 BPR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R R = Unimplemented R Read: $FE07 Reserved Write: Reset: $FE08 $FE09 Read: FLASH Control Register Write: (FLCR) Reset: Read: FLASH Block Protect Register Write: (FLBPR) Reset: Read: $FE0A Reserved Write: Reset: Read: $FE0B Reserved Write: Reset: U = Unaffected X = Indeterminate = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 11 of 12) Technical Data 56 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Memory Map Input/Output (I/O) Section Addr. Register Name Read: Break Address Register High Write: (BRKH) Reset: $FE0C Read: Break Address Register Low Write: (BRKL) Reset: $FE0D Read: Break Status and Control $FE0E Register Write: (BRKSCR) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BRKE BRKA 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 LVIIF 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: LVIOUT Low-Voltage Inhibit Status $FE0F Register Write: (LVISR) Reset: 0 $FFFF LVIIE 0 Read: COP Control Register Write: (COPCTL) Reset: U = Unaffected LVIIAK 0 0 Low byte of reset vector Writing clears COP counter (any value) Unaffected by reset X = Indeterminate = Unimplemented R = Reserved Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers (Sheet 12 of 12) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Memory Map 57 Memory Map . Table 2-1. Vector Addresses Priority INT Flag Lowest IF17 IF16 IF15 IF14 IF13 IF12 IF11 IF10 IF9 IF8 IF7 IF6 IF5 IF4 IF3 IF2 IF1 — Highest — Address $FFDA Real Time Clock Vector (High) $FFDB Real Time Clock Vector (Low) $FFDC ADC Conversion Complete Vector (High) $FFDD ADC Conversion Complete Vector (Low) $FFDE Keyboard Vector (High) $FFDF Keyboard Vector (Low) $FFE0 SCI Transmit Vector (High) $FFE1 SCI Transmit Vector (Low) $FFE2 SCI Receive Vector (High) $FFE3 SCI Receive Vector (Low) $FFE4 SCI Error Vector (High) $FFE5 SCI Error Vector (Low) $FFE6 SPI Receive Vector (High) $FFE7 SPI Receive Vector (Low) $FFE8 SPI Transmit Vector (High) $FFE9 SPI Transmit Vector (Low) $FFEA TIM2 Overflow Vector (High) $FFEB TIM2 Overflow Vector (Low) $FFEC TIM2 Channel 1 Vector (High) $FFED TIM2 Channel 1 Vector (Low) $FFEE TIM2 Channel 0 Vector (High) $FFEF TIM2 Channel 0 Vector (Low) $FFF0 TIM1 Overflow Vector (High) $FFF1 TIM1 Overflow Vector (Low) $FFF2 TIM1 Channel 1 Vector (High) $FFF3 TIM1 Channel 1 Vector (Low) $FFF4 TIM1 Channel 0 Vector (High) $FFF5 TIM1 Channel 0 Vector (Low) $FFF6 PLL Vector (High) $FFF7 PLL Vector (Low) $FFF8 LVI Vector (High) $FFF9 LVI Vector (Low) $FFFA IRQ Vector (High) $FFFB IRQ Vector (Low) $FFFC SWI Vector (High) $FFFD SWI Vector (Low) $FFFE Reset Vector (High) $FFFF Reset Vector (Low) Technical Data 58 Vector MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Memory Map MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM) 3.1 Contents 3.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 3.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 3.2 Introduction This section describes the 512 bytes of RAM (random-access memory). 3.3 Functional Description Addresses $0060 through $025F are RAM locations. The location of the stack RAM is programmable. The 16-bit stack pointer allows the stack to be anywhere in the 64k-byte memory space. NOTE: For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM locations. Within page zero are 160 bytes of RAM. Because the location of the stack RAM is programmable, all page zero RAM locations can be used for I/O control and user data or code. When the stack pointer is moved from its reset location at $00FF out of page zero, direct addressing mode instructions can efficiently access all page zero RAM locations. Page zero RAM, therefore, provides ideal locations for frequently accessed global variables. Before processing an interrupt, the CPU uses five bytes of the stack to save the contents of the CPU registers. NOTE: For M6805 compatibility, the H register is not stacked. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Random-Access Memory (RAM) 59 Random-Access Memory (RAM) During a subroutine call, the CPU uses two bytes of the stack to store the return address. The stack pointer decrements during pushes and increments during pulls. NOTE: Be careful when using nested subroutines. The CPU may overwrite data in the RAM during a subroutine or during the interrupt stacking operation. Technical Data 60 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Random-Access Memory (RAM) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 4. FLASH Memory (FLASH) 4.1 Contents 4.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 4.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 4.4 FLASH Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 4.5 FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 4.6 FLASH Mass Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 4.7 FLASH Program Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 4.8 FLASH Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 4.8.1 FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 4.2 Introduction This section describes the operation of the embedded FLASH memory. This memory can be read, programmed, and erased from a single external supply. The program and erase operations are enabled through the use of an internal charge pump. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data FLASH Memory (FLASH) 61 FLASH Memory (FLASH) Addr. $FE08 $FE09 Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BPR7 BPR6 0 0 Read: FLASH Control Register Write: (FLCR) Reset: Read: FLASH Block Protect Register Write: (FLBPR) Reset: 3 2 1 Bit 0 HVEN MASS ERASE PGM 0 0 0 0 0 BPR5 BPR4 BPR3 BPR2 BPR1 BPR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 4-1. FLASH I/O Register Summary 4.3 Functional Description The FLASH memory consists of an array of 12,288 bytes for user memory plus a block of 48 bytes for user interrupt vectors. An erased bit reads as logic 1 and a programmed bit reads as a logic 0. The FLASH memory page size is defined as 128 bytes, and is the minimum size that can be erased in a page erase operation. Program and erase operations are facilitated through control bits in FLASH control register (FLCR). The address ranges for the FLASH memory are: • $C000–$EFFF; user memory; 12,288 bytes • $FFD0–$FFFF; user interrupt vectors; 48 bytes Programming tools are available from Motorola. Contact your local Motorola representative for more information. NOTE: A security feature prevents viewing of the FLASH contents.1 1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users. Technical Data 62 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 FLASH Memory (FLASH) MOTOROLA FLASH Memory (FLASH) FLASH Control Register 4.4 FLASH Control Register The FLASH control register (FLCR) controls FLASH program and erase operations. Address: Read: $FE08 Bit 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 3 2 1 Bit 0 HVEN MASS ERASE PGM 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 Figure 4-2. FLASH Control Register (FLCR) HVEN — High Voltage Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the charge pump to drive high voltages for program and erase operations in the array. HVEN can only be set if either PGM = 1 or ERASE = 1 and the proper sequence for program or erase is followed. 1 = High voltage enabled to array and charge pump on 0 = High voltage disabled to array and charge pump off MASS — Mass Erase Control Bit This read/write bit configures the memory for mass erase operation or block erase operation when the ERASE bit is set. 1 = Mass Erase operation selected 0 = Block Erase operation selected ERASE — Erase Control Bit This read/write bit configures the memory for erase operation. ERASE is interlocked with the PGM bit such that both bits cannot be equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time. 1 = Erase operation selected 0 = Erase operation not selected PGM — Program Control Bit This read/write bit configures the memory for program operation. PGM is interlocked with the ERASE bit such that both bits cannot be equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time. 1 = Program operation selected 0 = Program operation not selected MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data FLASH Memory (FLASH) 63 FLASH Memory (FLASH) 4.5 FLASH Page Erase Operation Use the following procedure to erase a page of FLASH memory. A page consists of 128 consecutive bytes starting from addresses $xx00 or $xx80. The 48-byte user interrupt vectors area also forms a page. The 48-byte user interrupt vectors cannot be erased by the page erase operation because of security reasons. Mass erase is required to erase this page. 1. Set the ERASE bit and clear the MASS bit in the FLASH control register. 2. Write any data to any FLASH address within the page address range desired. 3. Wait for a time, tnvs (at least 10µs). 4. Set the HVEN bit. 5. Wait for a time, terase (1ms). 6. Clear the ERASE bit. 7. Wait for a time, tnvh (5µs). 8. Clear the HVEN bit. 9. After time, trcv (1µs), the memory can be accessed again in read mode. NOTE: Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by executing code from the FLASH memory; the code must be executed from RAM. While these operations must be performed in the order as shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. Technical Data 64 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 FLASH Memory (FLASH) MOTOROLA FLASH Memory (FLASH) FLASH Mass Erase Operation 4.6 FLASH Mass Erase Operation Use the following procedure to erase the entire FLASH memory to read as logic 1: 1. Set both the ERASE bit and the MASS bit in the FLASH control register. 2. Write any data to any FLASH address within the FLASH memory address range. 3. Wait for a time, tnvs (10µs). 4. Set the HVEN bit. 5. Wait for a time tmerase (4ms). 6. Clear the ERASE bit. 7. Wait for a time, tnvhl (100µs). 8. Clear the HVEN bit. 9. After time, trcv (1µs), the memory can be accessed again in read mode. NOTE: Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by executing code from the FLASH memory; the code must be executed from RAM. While these operations must be performed in the order as shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data FLASH Memory (FLASH) 65 FLASH Memory (FLASH) 4.7 FLASH Program Operation Programming of the FLASH memory is done on a row basis. A row consists of 64 consecutive bytes starting from addresses $xx00, $xx40, $xx80, or $xxC0. The procedure for programming a row of the FLASH memory is outlined below: 1. Set the PGM bit. This configures the memory for program operation and enables the latching of address and data for programming. 2. Write any data to any FLASH address within the row address range desired. 3. Wait for a time, tnvs (10µs). 4. Set the HVEN bit. 5. Wait for a time, tpgs (5µs). 6. Write data to the FLASH address to be programmed. 7. Wait for time, tprog (30µs). 8. Repeat step 6 and 7 until all the bytes within the row are programmed. 9. Clear the PGM bit. 10. Wait for time, tnvh (5µs). 11. Clear the HVEN bit. 12. After time, trcv (1µs), the memory can be accessed again in read mode. This program sequence is repeated throughout the memory until all data is programmed. NOTE: Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by executing code from the FLASH memory; the code must be executed from RAM. While these operations must be performed in the order as shown, but other unrelated operations may occur between the steps. Do not exceed tprog maximum. See 23.18 FLASH Memory Characteristics. Figure 4-3 shows a flowchart representation for programming the FLASH memory. Technical Data 66 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 FLASH Memory (FLASH) MOTOROLA FLASH Memory (FLASH) FLASH Program Operation 1 Set PGM bit Algorithm for programming a row (64 bytes) of FLASH memory 2 Write any data to any FLASH address within the row address range desired 3 Wait for a time, tnvs 4 Set HVEN bit 5 Wait for a time, tpgs 6 7 Write data to the FLASH address to be programmed Wait for a time, tprog Completed programming this row? Y N NOTE: The time between each FLASH address change (step 6 to step 6), or the time between the last FLASH address programmed to clearing PGM bit (step 6 to step 9) must not exceed the maximum programming time, tPROG max. 9 Clear PGM bit 10 Wait for a time, tnvh 11 Clear HVEN bit 12 Wait for a time, trcv This row program algorithm assumes the row/s to be programmed are initially erased. End of Programming Figure 4-3. FLASH Programming Flowchart MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data FLASH Memory (FLASH) 67 FLASH Memory (FLASH) 4.8 FLASH Protection Due to the ability of the on-board charge pump to erase and program the FLASH memory in the target application, provision is made to protect pages of memory from unintentional erase or program operations due to system malfunction. This protection is done by use of a FLASH block protect register (FLBPR). The FLBPR determines the range of the FLASH memory which is to be protected. The range of the protected area starts from a location defined by FLBPR and ends to the bottom of the FLASH memory ($FFFF). When the memory is protected, the HVEN bit cannot be set in either erase or program operations. NOTE: When the FLBPR is cleared (all 0’s), the entire FLASH memory is protected from being programmed and erased. When all the bits are set, the entire FLASH memory is accessible for program and erase. 4.8.1 FLASH Block Protect Register The FLASH block protect register is implemented as an 8-bit I/O register. The content of this register determine the starting location of the protected range within the FLASH memory. Address: $FE09 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 BPR7 BPR6 BPR5 BPR4 BPR3 BPR2 BPR1 BPR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 4-4. FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR) BPR[7:0] — FLASH Block Protect Register Bit 7 to Bit 0 BPR[7:1] represent bits [13:7] of a 16-bit memory address. Bits [15:14] are logic 1’s and bits [6:0] are logic 0’s. 16-bit memory address Start address of FLASH block protect 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BPR[7:1] Figure 4-5. FLASH Block Protect Start Address Technical Data 68 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 FLASH Memory (FLASH) MOTOROLA FLASH Memory (FLASH) FLASH Protection BPR0 is used only for BPR[7:0] = $FF, for no block protection. The resultant 16-bit address is used for specifying the start address of the FLASH memory for block protection. The FLASH is protected from this start address to the end of FLASH memory, at $FFFF. With this mechanism, the protect start address can be XX00 or XX80 (at page boundaries — 128 bytes) within the FLASH memory. Examples of protect start address: BPR[7:0] Start of Address of Protect Range $00 or $01 $C000 (1100 0000 0000 0000) The entire FLASH memory is protected. $02 or $03 $C080 (1100 0000 1000 0000) $04 or $05 $C100 (1100 0001 0000 0000) $06 or $07 $C180 (1100 0001 1000 0000) $08 or $09 $C200 (1100 0010 0000 0000) and so on... $F8 or $F9 $FE00 (1111 1110 0000 0000) $FA or $FB $FE80 (1111 1110 1000 0000) $FC or $FD $FF00 (1111 1111 0000 0000) $FE $FF80 (1111 1111 1000 0000) $FF The entire FLASH memory is not protected. Note: The end address of the protected range is always $FFFF. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data FLASH Memory (FLASH) 69 FLASH Memory (FLASH) Technical Data 70 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 FLASH Memory (FLASH) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG) 5.1 Contents 5.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 5.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 5.4 Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 5.5 Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 5.2 Introduction This section describes the configuration registers, CONFIG1 and CONFIG2. The configuration registers enable or disable these options: • Computer operating properly module (COP) • COP timeout period (218 – 24 or 213 – 24 ICLK cycles) • Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module power • LVI module reset • LVI module in stop mode • LVI module voltage trip point selection • STOP instruction • Stop mode recovery time (32 ICLK cycles or 4096 ICLK cycles) • Oscillator during stop mode • LCD frontplanes FP19–FP26 on port C MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Configuration Registers (CONFIG) 71 Configuration Registers (CONFIG) Addr. $001D $001F Register Name Bit 7 6 0 STOP_ IRCDIS 0 0 Read: Configuration Register 2 Write: (CONFIG2)† Reset: Read: COPRS Configuration Register 1 † Write: (CONFIG1) Reset: 0 5 4 STOP_ DIV2CLK XCLKEN 0 0 LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD 0 0 1 3 2 1 Bit 0 PCEH PCEL LVISEL1 LVISEL0 0 0 0†† 0†† SSREC STOP COPD 0 0 0 0 0 † One-time writable register after each reset. = Unimplemented †† Reset by POR only. Figure 5-1. CONFIG Registers Summary 5.3 Functional Description The configuration registers are used in the initialization of various options. The configuration registers can be written once after each reset. All of the configuration register bits are cleared during reset. Since the various options affect the operation of the MCU, it is recommended that these registers be written immediately after reset. The configuration registers are located at $001D and $001F. The configuration registers may be read at anytime. NOTE: The options except LVISEL[1:0] are one-time writable by the user after each reset. The LVISEL[1:0] bits are one-time writable by the user only after each POR (power-on reset). The CONFIG registers are not in the FLASH memory but are special registers containing one-time writable latches after each reset. Upon a reset, the CONFIG registers default to predetermined settings as shown in Figure 5-2 and Figure 5-3. Technical Data 72 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Configuration Registers (CONFIG) MOTOROLA Configuration Registers (CONFIG) Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) 5.4 Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) Address: $001F Bit 7 6 5 4 Read: 3 2 1 Bit 0 SSREC STOP COPD 0 0 0 0 COPRS LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD Write: Reset: 0 0 0 1 0 = Unimplemented Figure 5-2. Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) COPRS — COP Rate Select COPRS selects the COP time-out period. Reset clears COPRS. (See Section 20. Computer Operating Properly (COP).) 1 = COP time out period = 213 – 24 ICLK cycles 0 = COP time out period = 218 – 24 ICLK cycles LVISTOP — LVI Enable in Stop Mode When the LVIPWRD bit is clear, setting the LVISTOP bit enables the LVI to operate during stop mode. Reset clears LVISTOP. (See Section 21. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).) 1 = LVI enabled during stop mode 0 = LVI disabled during stop mode LVIRSTD — LVI Reset Disable LVIRSTD disables the reset signal from the LVI module. (See Section 21. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).) 1 = LVI module resets disabled 0 = LVI module resets enabled LVIPWRD — LVI Power Disable Bit LVIPWRD disables the LVI module. (See Section 21. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).) Reset sets LVIPWRD. 1 = LVI module power disabled 0 = LVI module power enabled MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Configuration Registers (CONFIG) 73 Configuration Registers (CONFIG) SSREC — Short Stop Recovery SSREC enables the CPU to exit stop mode with a delay of 32 ICLK cycles instead of a 4096 ICLK cycle delay. 1 = Stop mode recovery after 32 ICLK cycles 0 = Stop mode recovery after 4096 ICLK cycles NOTE: Exiting stop mode by pulling reset will result in the long stop recovery. If using an external crystal oscillator, do not set the SSREC bit. NOTE: When the LVISTOP is enabled, the system stabilization time for power on reset and long stop recovery (both 4096 ICLK cycles) gives a delay longer than the enable time for the LVI. There is no period where the MCU is not protected from a low power condition. However, when using the short stop recovery configuration option, the 32 ICLK delay is less than the LVI’s turn-on time and there exists a period in start-up where the LVI is not protecting the MCU. STOP — STOP Instruction Enable STOP enables the STOP instruction. 1 = STOP instruction enabled 0 = STOP instruction treated as illegal opcode COPD — COP Disable Bit COPD disables the COP module. (See Section 20. Computer Operating Properly (COP).) 1 = COP module disabled 0 = COP module enabled Technical Data 74 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Configuration Registers (CONFIG) MOTOROLA Configuration Registers (CONFIG) Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) 5.5 Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) Address: Read: $001D Bit 7 6 0 STOP_ IRCDIS Write: Reset: 0 0 5 4 STOP_ DIV2CLK XCLKEN 0 0 = Unimplemented 3 2 1 Bit 0 PCEH PCEL LVISEL1 LVISEL0 0 0 0†† 0†† †† Reset by POR only. Figure 5-3. Configuration Register 2 (CONFIG2) STOP_IRCDIS — Internal RC Oscillator Stop Mode Disable Setting STOP_IRCDIS disables the internal RC oscillator during stop mode. When this bit is cleared, the internal RC oscillator continues to operate in stop mode. Reset clears this bit. 1 = Internal RC oscillator disabled during stop mode 0 = Internal RC oscillator enabled during stop mode STOP_XCLKEN — Crystal Oscillator Stop Mode Enable Setting STOP_XCLKEN enables the external crystal (XTAL) oscillator to continue operating during stop mode. This is useful for driving the real time clock module to allow it to generate periodic wake-up while in stop mode. When this bit is cleared, the external XTAL oscillator will be disabled during stop mode. Reset clears this bit. 1 = XTAL oscillator enabled during stop mode 0 = XTAL oscillator disabled during stop mode DIV2CLK — Divide-by-2 Clock Bypass When CGMXCLK is selected to drive the system clocks (BCS=0), setting DIV2CLK allows the CGMXCLK to bypass the divide-by-2 divider in the CGM module; CGMOUT will equal CGMXCLK and bus clock will equal CGMXCLK divide-by-2. DIV2CLK bit has no effect when the BCS=1 in the PLL control register (CGMVCLK selected and divide-by-2 always enabled). Reset clears this bit. 1 = Divide-by-2 divider bypassed; When BSC=0, CGMOUT equals CGMXCLK 0 = Divide-by-2 divider enabled; When BSC=0, CGMOUT equals CGMXCLK divide-by-2 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Configuration Registers (CONFIG) 75 Configuration Registers (CONFIG) PCEH — Port C Enable High Nibble Setting PCEH configures the PTC4/FP23–PTC7/FP26 pins for LCD frontplane driver use. Reset clears this bit. 1 = PTC4/FP23–PTC7/FP26 pins configured as LCD frontplane driver pins: FP23–FP26 0 = PTC4/FP23–PTC7/FP26 pins configured as standard I/O pins: PTC4–PTC7 PCEL — Port C Enable Low Nibble Setting PCEL configures the PTC0/FP19–PTC3/FP22 pins for LCD frontplane driver use. Reset clears this bit. 1 = PTC0/FP19–PTC3/FP22 pins configured as LCD frontplane driver pins: FP19–FP22 0 = PTC0/FP19–PTC3/FP22 pins configured as standard I/O pins: PTC0–PTC3 LVISEL[1:0] — LVI Operating Mode Selection LVISEL[1:0] selects the voltage operating mode of the LVI module. (See Section 21. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).) The voltage mode selected for the LVI should match the operating VDD. See Section 23. Electrical Specifications for the LVI voltage trip points for each of the modes. LVISEL1 LVISEL0 Operating Mode 0 0 Reserved (2.5V) 0 1 3V 1 0 5V 1 1 Reserved Table 5-1. LVI Trip Point Selection Technical Data 76 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Configuration Registers (CONFIG) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU) 6.1 Contents 6.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 6.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 6.4 CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 6.4.1 Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .79 6.4.2 Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 6.4.3 Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 6.4.4 Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 6.4.5 Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 6.5 Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 6.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 6.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 6.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 6.7 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 6.8 Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 6.9 Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 77 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 6.2 Introduction The M68HC08 CPU (central processor unit) is an enhanced and fully object-code-compatible version of the M68HC05 CPU. The CPU08 Reference Manual (Motorola document order number CPU08RM/AD) contains a description of the CPU instruction set, addressing modes, and architecture. 6.3 Features Feature of the CPU include: • Object code fully upward-compatible with M68HC05 Family • 16-bit stack pointer with stack manipulation instructions • 16-Bit index register with X-register manipulation instructions • 8-MHz CPU internal bus frequency • 64-Kbyte program/data memory space • 16 addressing modes • Memory-to-memory data moves without using accumulator • Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions • Enhanced binary-coded decimal (BCD) data handling • Modular architecture with expandable internal bus definition for extension of addressing range beyond 64-Kbytes • Low-power stop and wait modes Technical Data 78 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) CPU Registers 6.4 CPU Registers Figure 6-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of the memory map. 7 0 ACCUMULATOR (A) 15 0 H X INDEX REGISTER (H:X) 0 15 STACK POINTER (SP) 0 15 PROGRAM COUNTER (PC) 7 0 V 1 1 H I N Z C CONDITION CODE REGISTER (CCR) CARRY/BORROW FLAG ZERO FLAG NEGATIVE FLAG INTERRUPT MASK HALF-CARRY FLAG TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW FLAG Figure 6-1. CPU Registers 6.4.1 Accumulator The accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. The CPU uses the accumulator to hold operands and the results of arithmetic/logic operations. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: Write: Reset: Unaffected by reset Figure 6-2. Accumulator (A) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 79 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 6.4.2 Index Register The 16-bit index register allows indexed addressing of a 64K-byte memory space. H is the upper byte of the index register, and X is the lower byte. H:X is the concatenated 16-bit index register. In the indexed addressing modes, the CPU uses the contents of the index register to determine the conditional address of the operand. The index register can serve also as a temporary data storage location. Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 X X X X X X X X Read: Write: Reset: X = Indeterminate Figure 6-3. Index Register (H:X) 6.4.3 Stack Pointer The stack pointer is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next location on the stack. During a reset, the stack pointer is preset to $00FF. The reset stack pointer (RSP) instruction sets the least significant byte to $FF and does not affect the most significant byte. The stack pointer decrements as data is pushed onto the stack and increments as data is pulled from the stack. In the stack pointer 8-bit offset and 16-bit offset addressing modes, the stack pointer can function as an index register to access data on the stack. The CPU uses the contents of the stack pointer to determine the conditional address of the operand. Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 6-4. Stack Pointer (SP) Technical Data 80 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) CPU Registers NOTE: The location of the stack is arbitrary and may be relocated anywhere in RAM. Moving the SP out of page 0 ($0000 to $00FF) frees direct address (page 0) space. For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM locations. 6.4.4 Program Counter The program counter is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next instruction or operand to be fetched. Normally, the program counter automatically increments to the next sequential memory location every time an instruction or operand is fetched. Jump, branch, and interrupt operations load the program counter with an address other than that of the next sequential location. During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector address located at $FFFE and $FFFF. The vector address is the address of the first instruction to be executed after exiting the reset state. Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: Write: Reset: Loaded with Vector from $FFFE and $FFFF Figure 6-5. Program Counter (PC) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 81 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 6.4.5 Condition Code Register The 8-bit condition code register contains the interrupt mask and five flags that indicate the results of the instruction just executed. Bits 6 and 5 are set permanently to logic 1. The following paragraphs describe the functions of the condition code register. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 V 1 1 H I N Z C X 1 1 X 1 X X X Read: Write: Reset: X = Indeterminate Figure 6-6. Condition Code Register (CCR) V — Overflow Flag The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two's complement overflow occurs. The signed branch instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use the overflow flag. 1 = Overflow 0 = No overflow H — Half-Carry Flag The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between accumulator bits 3 and 4 during an add-without-carry (ADD) or addwith-carry (ADC) operation. The half-carry flag is required for binarycoded decimal (BCD) arithmetic operations. The DAA instruction uses the states of the H and C flags to determine the appropriate correction factor. 1 = Carry between bits 3 and 4 0 = No carry between bits 3 and 4 Technical Data 82 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) CPU Registers I — Interrupt Mask When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are disabled. CPU interrupts are enabled when the interrupt mask is cleared. When a CPU interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but before the interrupt vector is fetched. 1 = Interrupts disabled 0 = Interrupts enabled NOTE: To maintain M6805 Family compatibility, the upper byte of the index register (H) is not stacked automatically. If the interrupt service routine modifies H, then the user must stack and unstack H using the PSHH and PULH instructions. After the I bit is cleared, the highest-priority interrupt request is serviced first. A return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction pulls the CPU registers from the stack and restores the interrupt mask from the stack. After any reset, the interrupt mask is set and can be cleared only by the clear interrupt mask software instruction (CLI). N — Negative Flag The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation produces a negative result, setting bit 7 of the result. 1 = Negative result 0 = Non-negative result Z — Zero Flag The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation produces a result of $00. 1 = Zero result 0 = Non-zero result MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 83 Central Processor Unit (CPU) C — Carry/Borrow Flag The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation produces a carry out of bit 7 of the accumulator or when a subtraction operation requires a borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test and branch, shift, and rotate — also clear or set the carry/borrow flag. 1 = Carry out of bit 7 0 = No carry out of bit 7 6.5 Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) The ALU performs the arithmetic and logic operations defined by the instruction set. Refer to the CPU08 Reference Manual (Motorola document order number CPU08RM/AD) for a description of the instructions and addressing modes and more detail about the architecture of the CPU. 6.6 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes. 6.6.1 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction: • Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling interrupts. After exit from wait mode by interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set. • Disables the CPU clock. Technical Data 84 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) CPU During Break Interrupts 6.6.2 Stop Mode The STOP instruction: • Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register, enabling external interrupts. After exit from stop mode by external interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set. • Disables the CPU clock. After exiting stop mode, the CPU clock begins running after the oscillator stabilization delay. 6.7 CPU During Break Interrupts If the break module is enabled, a break interrupt causes the CPU to execute the software interrupt instruction (SWI) at the completion of the current CPU instruction. (See Section 22. Break Module (BRK).) The program counter vectors to $FFFC–$FFFD ($FEFC–$FEFD in monitor mode). A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the break interrupt and returns the MCU to normal operation if the break interrupt has been deasserted. 6.8 Instruction Set Summary Table 6-1 provides a summary of the M68HC08 instruction set. 6.9 Opcode Map The opcode map is provided in Table 6-2. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 85 Central Processor Unit (CPU) V H I N Z C ADC #opr ADC opr ADC opr ADC opr,X ADC opr,X ADC ,X ADC opr,SP ADC opr,SP A ← (A) + (M) + (C) Add with Carry IMM DIR EXT IX2 ↕ ↕ – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A9 B9 C9 D9 E9 F9 9EE9 9ED9 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff IMM DIR EXT IX2 ↕ ↕ – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 SP2 AB BB CB DB EB FB 9EEB 9EDB ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ADD #opr ADD opr ADD opr ADD opr,X ADD opr,X ADD ,X ADD opr,SP ADD opr,SP Add without Carry AIS #opr Add Immediate Value (Signed) to SP SP ← (SP) + (16 « M) – – – – – – IMM AIX #opr Add Immediate Value (Signed) to H:X H:X ← (H:X) + (16 « M) A ← (A) & (M) AND #opr AND opr AND opr AND opr,X AND opr,X AND ,X AND opr,SP AND opr,SP ASL opr ASLA ASLX ASL opr,X ASL ,X ASL opr,SP Logical AND Arithmetic Shift Left (Same as LSL) ASR opr ASRA ASRX ASR opr,X ASR opr,X ASR opr,SP Arithmetic Shift Right BCC rel Branch if Carry Bit Clear BCLR n, opr A ← (A) + (M) C 0 b7 b0 C b7 Clear Bit n in M b0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0 Mn ← 0 Technical Data 86 ff ee ff Cycles Effect on CCR Description Operand Operation Opcode Source Form Address Mode Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 1 of 8) 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 ff ee ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 A7 ii 2 – – – – – – IMM AF ii 2 IMM DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A4 B4 C4 D4 E4 F4 9EE4 9ED4 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 38 48 58 68 78 9E68 dd DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 37 47 57 67 77 9E67 dd ff 4 1 1 4 3 5 – – – – – – REL 24 rr 3 DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) – – – – – – DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) 11 13 15 17 19 1B 1D 1F dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 ff ee ff ff ff ff 4 1 1 4 3 5 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) Opcode Map Effect on CCR V H I N Z C Cycles Description Operand Operation Opcode Source Form Address Mode Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 2 of 8) BCS rel Branch if Carry Bit Set (Same as BLO) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1 – – – – – – REL 25 rr 3 BEQ rel Branch if Equal PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 1 – – – – – – REL 27 rr 3 BGE opr Branch if Greater Than or Equal To (Signed Operands) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) = 0 – – – – – – REL 90 rr 3 BGT opr Branch if Greater Than (Signed Operands) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 0 – – – – – – REL 92 rr 3 BHCC rel Branch if Half Carry Bit Clear PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 0 – – – – – – REL 28 rr 3 BHCS rel Branch if Half Carry Bit Set PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 1 – – – – – – REL 29 rr 3 BHI rel Branch if Higher PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 0 – – – – – – REL 22 rr 3 BHS rel Branch if Higher or Same (Same as BCC) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0 – – – – – – REL 24 rr 3 BIH rel Branch if IRQ Pin High PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 1 – – – – – – REL 2F rr 3 BIL rel Branch if IRQ Pin Low PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 0 – – – – – – REL 2E rr 3 (A) & (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A5 B5 C5 D5 E5 F5 9EE5 9ED5 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 BIT #opr BIT opr BIT opr BIT opr,X BIT opr,X BIT ,X BIT opr,SP BIT opr,SP Bit Test BLE opr Branch if Less Than or Equal To (Signed Operands) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 1 – – – – – – REL 93 rr 3 BLO rel Branch if Lower (Same as BCS) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1 – – – – – – REL 25 rr 3 BLS rel Branch if Lower or Same PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 1 – – – – – – REL 23 rr 3 BLT opr Branch if Less Than (Signed Operands) PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) =1 – – – – – – REL 91 rr 3 BMC rel Branch if Interrupt Mask Clear PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 0 – – – – – – REL 2C rr 3 BMI rel Branch if Minus PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 1 – – – – – – REL 2B rr 3 BMS rel Branch if Interrupt Mask Set PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 1 – – – – – – REL 2D rr 3 BNE rel Branch if Not Equal PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 0 – – – – – – REL 26 rr 3 BPL rel Branch if Plus PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 0 – – – – – – REL 2A rr 3 BRA rel Branch Always PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel – – – – – – REL 20 rr 3 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 87 Central Processor Unit (CPU) Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 3 of 8) Operand Cycles Effect on CCR Opcode Operation DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) – – – – – ↕ DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) 01 03 05 07 09 0B 0D 0F dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 – – – – – – REL 21 rr 3 PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 1 DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) – – – – – ↕ DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) 00 02 04 06 08 0A 0C 0E dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr dd rr 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 Mn ← 1 DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) – – – – – – DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) 10 12 14 16 18 1A 1C 1E dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 – – – – – – REL AD rr 4 dd rr ii rr ii rr ff rr rr ff rr 5 4 4 5 4 6 Description V H I N Z C BRCLR n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Clear BRN rel Branch Never BRSET n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Set BSET n,opr Set Bit n in M BSR rel Branch to Subroutine CBEQ opr,rel CBEQA #opr,rel CBEQX #opr,rel Compare and Branch if Equal CBEQ opr,X+,rel CBEQ X+,rel CBEQ opr,SP,rel PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 PC ← (PC) + 2; push (PCL) SP ← (SP) – 1; push (PCH) SP ← (SP) – 1 PC ← (PC) + rel Address Mode Source Form DIR PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 IMM PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 IMM PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (X) – (M) = $00 – – – – – – IX1+ PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 IX+ PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 SP1 PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (A) – (M) = $00 31 41 51 61 71 9E61 CLC Clear Carry Bit C←0 – – – – – 0 INH 98 1 CLI Clear Interrupt Mask I←0 – – 0 – – – INH 9A 2 M ← $00 A ← $00 X ← $00 H ← $00 M ← $00 M ← $00 M ← $00 DIR INH INH 0 – – 0 1 – INH IX1 IX SP1 3F 4F 5F 8C 6F 7F 9E6F CLR opr CLRA CLRX CLRH CLR opr,X CLR ,X CLR opr,SP Clear Technical Data 88 dd ff ff 3 1 1 1 3 2 4 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) Opcode Map Effect on CCR V H I N Z C CMP #opr CMP opr CMP opr CMP opr,X CMP opr,X CMP ,X CMP opr,SP CMP opr,SP Compare A with M (A) – (M) COM opr COMA COMX COM opr,X COM ,X COM opr,SP Complement (One’s Complement) CPHX #opr CPHX opr Compare H:X with M CPX #opr CPX opr CPX opr CPX ,X CPX opr,X CPX opr,X CPX opr,SP CPX opr,SP Compare X with M DAA Decimal Adjust A M ← (M) = $FF – (M) A ← (A) = $FF – (M) X ← (X) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1 F1 9EE1 9ED1 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff DIR INH INH 0 – – ↕ ↕ 1 IX1 IX SP1 33 43 53 63 73 9E63 dd ff ee ff Cycles Description Operand Operation Opcode Source Form Address Mode Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 4 of 8) 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 ff 4 1 1 4 3 5 65 75 ii ii+1 dd 3 4 IMM DIR EXT IX2 ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 F3 9EE3 9ED3 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 U – – ↕ ↕ ↕ INH 72 PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0 DIR INH – – – – – – INH IX1 IX SP1 3B 4B 5B 6B 7B 9E6B dd rr rr rr ff rr rr ff rr 5 3 3 5 4 6 M ← (M) – 1 A ← (A) – 1 X ← (X) – 1 M ← (M) – 1 M ← (M) – 1 M ← (M) – 1 DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 9E6A dd 4 1 1 4 3 5 A ← (H:A)/(X) H ← Remainder – – – – ↕ ↕ INH 52 A ← (A ⊕ M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A8 B8 C8 D8 E8 F8 9EE8 9ED8 (H:X) – (M:M + 1) (X) – (M) (A)10 ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IMM DIR ff ff ee ff 2 A ← (A) – 1 or M ← (M) – 1 or X ← (X) – 1 DBNZ opr,rel DBNZA rel Decrement and Branch if Not Zero DBNZX rel DBNZ opr,X,rel DBNZ X,rel DBNZ opr,SP,rel DEC opr DECA DECX DEC opr,X DEC ,X DEC opr,SP Decrement DIV Divide EOR #opr EOR opr EOR opr EOR opr,X EOR opr,X EOR ,X EOR opr,SP EOR opr,SP Exclusive OR M with A MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA ff ff 7 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 89 Central Processor Unit (CPU) V H I N Z C INC opr INCA INCX INC opr,X INC ,X INC opr,SP JMP opr JMP opr JMP opr,X JMP opr,X JMP ,X JSR opr JSR opr JSR opr,X JSR opr,X JSR ,X Load A from M LDHX #opr LDHX opr Load H:X from M LSL opr LSLA LSLX LSL opr,X LSL ,X LSL opr,SP LSR opr LSRA LSRX LSR opr,X LSR ,X LSR opr,SP DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 3C 4C 5C 6C 7C 9E6C PC ← Jump Address DIR EXT – – – – – – IX2 IX1 IX BC CC DC EC FC dd hh ll ee ff ff 2 3 4 3 2 PC ← (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3) Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – 1 Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – 1 PC ← Unconditional Address DIR EXT – – – – – – IX2 IX1 IX BD CD DD ED FD dd hh ll ee ff ff 4 5 6 5 4 A ← (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A6 B6 C6 D6 E6 F6 9EE6 9ED6 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 ii jj dd 3 4 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 Jump LDA #opr LDA opr LDA opr LDA opr,X LDA opr,X LDA ,X LDA opr,SP LDA opr,SP LDX #opr LDX opr LDX opr LDX opr,X LDX opr,X LDX ,X LDX opr,SP LDX opr,SP M ← (M) + 1 A ← (A) + 1 X ← (X) + 1 M ← (M) + 1 M ← (M) + 1 M ← (M) + 1 Increment Jump to Subroutine H:X ← (M:M + 1) Logical Shift Right 0 – – ↕ ↕ – X ← (M) Load X from M Logical Shift Left (Same as ASL) C 0 b7 b0 0 C b7 b0 Technical Data 90 Cycles Effect on CCR Description Operand Operation Opcode Source Form Address Mode Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 5 of 8) IMM DIR 45 55 dd ff ff IMM DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 AE BE CE DE EE FE 9EEE 9EDE ii dd hh ll ee ff ff DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 38 48 58 68 78 9E68 dd DIR INH INH ↕ – – 0 ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 34 44 54 64 74 9E64 dd ff ee ff ff ff ff ff 4 1 1 4 3 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) Opcode Map Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 6 of 8) Opcode Operand Cycles Effect on CCR DD DIX+ 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IMD IX+D 4E 5E 6E 7E dd dd dd ii dd dd 5 4 4 4 X:A ← (X) × (A) – 0 – – – 0 INH 42 M ← –(M) = $00 – (M) A ← –(A) = $00 – (A) X ← –(X) = $00 – (X) M ← –(M) = $00 – (M) M ← –(M) = $00 – (M) DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 30 40 50 60 70 9E60 None – – – – – – INH 9D 1 A ← (A[3:0]:A[7:4]) – – – – – – INH 62 3 A ← (A) | (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 AA BA CA DA EA FA 9EEA 9EDA Operation Description V H I N Z C MOV opr,opr MOV opr,X+ MOV #opr,opr MOV X+,opr Move MUL Unsigned multiply (M)Destination ← (M)Source H:X ← (H:X) + 1 (IX+D, DIX+) NEG opr NEGA NEGX NEG opr,X NEG ,X NEG opr,SP Negate (Two’s Complement) NOP No Operation NSA Nibble Swap A Address Mode Source Form 5 dd ff ff 4 1 1 4 3 5 ORA #opr ORA opr ORA opr ORA opr,X ORA opr,X ORA ,X ORA opr,SP ORA opr,SP Inclusive OR A and M PSHA Push A onto Stack Push (A); SP ← (SP) – 1 – – – – – – INH 87 2 PSHH Push H onto Stack Push (H); SP ← (SP) – 1 – – – – – – INH 8B 2 PSHX Push X onto Stack Push (X); SP ← (SP) – 1 – – – – – – INH 89 2 PULA Pull A from Stack SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (A) – – – – – – INH 86 2 PULH Pull H from Stack SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (H) – – – – – – INH 8A 2 PULX Pull X from Stack SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (X) – – – – – – INH 88 2 39 49 59 69 79 9E69 dd C DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 DIR INH INH ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 36 46 56 66 76 9E66 dd – – – – – – INH 9C ROL opr ROLA ROLX ROL opr,X ROL ,X ROL opr,SP Rotate Left through Carry b7 ROR opr RORA RORX ROR opr,X ROR ,X ROR opr,SP Rotate Right through Carry RSP Reset Stack Pointer b0 C b7 b0 SP ← $FF MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff ff ff ff ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 4 1 1 4 3 5 1 Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 91 Central Processor Unit (CPU) Effect on CCR V H I N Z C RTI Return from Interrupt RTS Return from Subroutine Cycles Description Operand Operation Opcode Source Form Address Mode Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 7 of 8) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (CCR) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (A) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (X) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCH) SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCL) ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ INH 80 7 SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCH) SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCL) – – – – – – INH 81 4 A ← (A) – (M) – (C) IMM DIR EXT IX2 ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 F2 9EE2 9ED2 SBC #opr SBC opr SBC opr SBC opr,X SBC opr,X SBC ,X SBC opr,SP SBC opr,SP Subtract with Carry SEC Set Carry Bit C←1 – – – – – 1 INH 99 1 SEI Set Interrupt Mask I←1 – – 1 – – – INH 9B 2 M ← (A) DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 B7 C7 D7 E7 F7 9EE7 9ED7 (M:M + 1) ← (H:X) 0 – – ↕ ↕ – DIR 35 I ← 0; Stop Oscillator – – 0 – – – INH 8E M ← (X) DIR EXT IX2 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 SP2 BF CF DF EF FF 9EEF 9EDF dd hh ll ee ff ff IMM DIR EXT IX2 ↕ – – ↕ ↕ ↕ IX1 IX SP1 SP2 A0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 9EE0 9ED0 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff STA opr STA opr STA opr,X STA opr,X STA ,X STA opr,SP STA opr,SP Store A in M STHX opr Store H:X in M STOP Enable IRQ Pin; Stop Oscillator STX opr STX opr STX opr,X STX opr,X STX ,X STX opr,SP STX opr,SP SUB #opr SUB opr SUB opr SUB opr,X SUB opr,X SUB ,X SUB opr,SP SUB opr,SP Store X in M Subtract A ← (A) – (M) Technical Data 92 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ff ee ff dd hh ll ee ff ff 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 ff ee ff 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 dd 4 1 ff ee ff ff ee ff 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 2 3 4 4 3 2 4 5 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) MOTOROLA Central Processor Unit (CPU) Opcode Map V H I N Z C Cycles Effect on CCR Description Operand Operation Opcode Source Form Address Mode Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 8 of 8) SWI Software Interrupt PC ← (PC) + 1; Push (PCL) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (PCH) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (X) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (A) SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (CCR) SP ← (SP) – 1; I ← 1 PCH ← Interrupt Vector High Byte PCL ← Interrupt Vector Low Byte TAP Transfer A to CCR CCR ← (A) ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ ↕ INH 84 2 TAX Transfer A to X X ← (A) – – – – – – INH 97 1 TPA Transfer CCR to A A ← (CCR) – – – – – – INH 85 1 (A) – $00 or (X) – $00 or (M) – $00 DIR INH INH 0 – – ↕ ↕ – IX1 IX SP1 3D 4D 5D 6D 7D 9E6D H:X ← (SP) + 1 – – – – – – INH 95 2 A ← (X) – – – – – – INH 9F 1 (SP) ← (H:X) – 1 – – – – – – INH 94 2 TST opr TSTA TSTX TST opr,X TST ,X TST opr,SP Test for Negative or Zero TSX Transfer SP to H:X TXA Transfer X to A TXS Transfer H:X to SP A C CCR dd dd rr DD DIR DIX+ ee ff EXT ff H H hh ll I ii IMD IMM INH IX IX+ IX+D IX1 IX1+ IX2 M N Accumulator Carry/borrow bit Condition code register Direct address of operand Direct address of operand and relative offset of branch instruction Direct to direct addressing mode Direct addressing mode Direct to indexed with post increment addressing mode High and low bytes of offset in indexed, 16-bit offset addressing Extended addressing mode Offset byte in indexed, 8-bit offset addressing Half-carry bit Index register high byte High and low bytes of operand address in extended addressing Interrupt mask Immediate operand byte Immediate source to direct destination addressing mode Immediate addressing mode Inherent addressing mode Indexed, no offset addressing mode Indexed, no offset, post increment addressing mode Indexed with post increment to direct addressing mode Indexed, 8-bit offset addressing mode Indexed, 8-bit offset, post increment addressing mode Indexed, 16-bit offset addressing mode Memory location Negative bit n opr PC PCH PCL REL rel rr SP1 SP2 SP U V X Z & | ⊕ () –( ) # « ← ? : ↕ — 83 9 dd ff ff 3 1 1 3 2 4 Any bit Operand (one or two bytes) Program counter Program counter high byte Program counter low byte Relative addressing mode Relative program counter offset byte Relative program counter offset byte Stack pointer, 8-bit offset addressing mode Stack pointer 16-bit offset addressing mode Stack pointer Undefined Overflow bit Index register low byte Zero bit Logical AND Logical OR Logical EXCLUSIVE OR Contents of Negation (two’s complement) Immediate value Sign extend Loaded with If Concatenated with Set or cleared Not affected MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA – – 1 – – – INH Technical Data Central Processor Unit (CPU) 93 MSB Branch REL DIR INH 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C MOTOROLA MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 1 2 5 BRSET0 3 DIR 5 BRCLR0 3 DIR 5 BRSET1 3 DIR 5 BRCLR1 3 DIR 5 BRSET2 3 DIR 5 BRCLR2 3 DIR 5 BRSET3 3 DIR 5 BRCLR3 3 DIR 5 BRSET4 3 DIR 5 BRCLR4 3 DIR 5 BRSET5 3 DIR 5 BRCLR5 3 DIR 5 BRSET6 3 DIR 5 BRCLR6 3 DIR 5 BRSET7 3 DIR 5 BRCLR7 3 DIR 4 BSET0 2 DIR 4 BCLR0 2 DIR 4 BSET1 2 DIR 4 BCLR1 2 DIR 4 BSET2 2 DIR 4 BCLR2 2 DIR 4 BSET3 2 DIR 4 BCLR3 2 DIR 4 BSET4 2 DIR 4 BCLR4 2 DIR 4 BSET5 2 DIR 4 BCLR5 2 DIR 4 BSET6 2 DIR 4 BCLR6 2 DIR 4 BSET7 2 DIR 4 BCLR7 2 DIR 3 BRA 2 REL 3 BRN 2 REL 3 BHI 2 REL 3 BLS 2 REL 3 BCC 2 REL 3 BCS 2 REL 3 BNE 2 REL 3 BEQ 2 REL 3 BHCC 2 REL 3 BHCS 2 REL 3 BPL 2 REL 3 BMI 2 REL 3 BMC 2 REL 3 BMS 2 REL 3 BIL 2 REL 3 BIH 2 REL 5 6 1 NEGX 1 INH 4 CBEQX 3 IMM 7 DIV 1 INH 1 COMX 1 INH 1 LSRX 1 INH 4 LDHX 2 DIR 1 RORX 1 INH 1 ASRX 1 INH 1 LSLX 1 INH 1 ROLX 1 INH 1 DECX 1 INH 3 DBNZX 2 INH 1 INCX 1 INH 1 TSTX 1 INH 4 MOV 2 DIX+ 1 CLRX 1 INH 4 NEG 2 IX1 5 CBEQ 3 IX1+ 3 NSA 1 INH 4 COM 2 IX1 4 LSR 2 IX1 3 CPHX 3 IMM 4 ROR 2 IX1 4 ASR 2 IX1 4 LSL 2 IX1 4 ROL 2 IX1 4 DEC 2 IX1 5 DBNZ 3 IX1 4 INC 2 IX1 3 TST 2 IX1 4 MOV 3 IMD 3 CLR 2 IX1 SP1 IX 9E6 7 Control INH INH 8 9 Register/Memory IX2 SP2 IMM DIR EXT A B C D 4 SUB 3 EXT 4 CMP 3 EXT 4 SBC 3 EXT 4 CPX 3 EXT 4 AND 3 EXT 4 BIT 3 EXT 4 LDA 3 EXT 4 STA 3 EXT 4 EOR 3 EXT 4 ADC 3 EXT 4 ORA 3 EXT 4 ADD 3 EXT 3 JMP 3 EXT 5 JSR 3 EXT 4 LDX 3 EXT 4 STX 3 EXT 4 SUB IX2 4 CMP IX2 4 SBC IX2 4 CPX IX2 4 AND IX2 4 BIT IX2 4 LDA IX2 4 STA IX2 4 EOR IX2 4 ADC IX2 4 ORA IX2 4 ADD IX2 4 JMP IX2 6 JSR IX2 4 LDX IX2 4 STX IX2 9ED IX1 SP1 IX E 9EE F LSB 0 Central Processor Unit (CPU) 0 Read-Modify-Write INH IX1 D E F 4 1 NEG NEGA 2 DIR 1 INH 5 4 CBEQ CBEQA 3 DIR 3 IMM 5 MUL 1 INH 4 1 COM COMA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 LSR LSRA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 3 STHX LDHX 2 DIR 3 IMM 4 1 ROR RORA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 ASR ASRA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 LSL LSLA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 ROL ROLA 2 DIR 1 INH 4 1 DEC DECA 2 DIR 1 INH 5 3 DBNZ DBNZA 3 DIR 2 INH 4 1 INC INCA 2 DIR 1 INH 3 1 TST TSTA 2 DIR 1 INH 5 MOV 3 DD 3 1 CLR CLRA 2 DIR 1 INH INH Inherent REL Relative IMM Immediate IX Indexed, No Offset DIR Direct IX1 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset EXT Extended IX2 Indexed, 16-Bit Offset DD Direct-Direct IMD Immediate-Direct IX+D Indexed-Direct DIX+ Direct-Indexed *Pre-byte for stack pointer indexed instructions 5 3 NEG NEG 3 SP1 1 IX 6 4 CBEQ CBEQ 4 SP1 2 IX+ 2 DAA 1 INH 5 3 COM COM 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 LSR LSR 3 SP1 1 IX 4 CPHX 2 DIR 5 3 ROR ROR 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 ASR ASR 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 LSL LSL 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 ROL ROL 3 SP1 1 IX 5 3 DEC DEC 3 SP1 1 IX 6 4 DBNZ DBNZ 4 SP1 2 IX 5 3 INC INC 3 SP1 1 IX 4 2 TST TST 3 SP1 1 IX 4 MOV 2 IX+D 4 2 CLR CLR 3 SP1 1 IX SP1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset SP2 Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset IX+ Indexed, No Offset with Post Increment IX1+ Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with Post Increment 7 3 RTI BGE 1 INH 2 REL 4 3 RTS BLT 1 INH 2 REL 3 BGT 2 REL 9 3 SWI BLE 1 INH 2 REL 2 2 TAP TXS 1 INH 1 INH 1 2 TPA TSX 1 INH 1 INH 2 PULA 1 INH 2 1 PSHA TAX 1 INH 1 INH 2 1 PULX CLC 1 INH 1 INH 2 1 PSHX SEC 1 INH 1 INH 2 2 PULH CLI 1 INH 1 INH 2 2 PSHH SEI 1 INH 1 INH 1 1 CLRH RSP 1 INH 1 INH 1 NOP 1 INH 1 STOP * 1 INH 1 1 WAIT TXA 1 INH 1 INH 2 SUB 2 IMM 2 CMP 2 IMM 2 SBC 2 IMM 2 CPX 2 IMM 2 AND 2 IMM 2 BIT 2 IMM 2 LDA 2 IMM 2 AIS 2 IMM 2 EOR 2 IMM 2 ADC 2 IMM 2 ORA 2 IMM 2 ADD 2 IMM 3 SUB 2 DIR 3 CMP 2 DIR 3 SBC 2 DIR 3 CPX 2 DIR 3 AND 2 DIR 3 BIT 2 DIR 3 LDA 2 DIR 3 STA 2 DIR 3 EOR 2 DIR 3 ADC 2 DIR 3 ORA 2 DIR 3 ADD 2 DIR 2 JMP 2 DIR 4 4 BSR JSR 2 REL 2 DIR 2 3 LDX LDX 2 IMM 2 DIR 2 3 AIX STX 2 IMM 2 DIR MSB 0 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 5 SUB SP2 5 CMP SP2 5 SBC SP2 5 CPX SP2 5 AND SP2 5 BIT SP2 5 LDA SP2 5 STA SP2 5 EOR SP2 5 ADC SP2 5 ORA SP2 5 ADD SP2 3 SUB 2 IX1 3 CMP 2 IX1 3 SBC 2 IX1 3 CPX 2 IX1 3 AND 2 IX1 3 BIT 2 IX1 3 LDA 2 IX1 3 STA 2 IX1 3 EOR 2 IX1 3 ADC 2 IX1 3 ORA 2 IX1 3 ADD 2 IX1 3 JMP 2 IX1 5 JSR 2 IX1 5 3 LDX LDX SP2 2 IX1 5 3 STX STX SP2 2 IX1 4 SUB 3 SP1 4 CMP 3 SP1 4 SBC 3 SP1 4 CPX 3 SP1 4 AND 3 SP1 4 BIT 3 SP1 4 LDA 3 SP1 4 STA 3 SP1 4 EOR 3 SP1 4 ADC 3 SP1 4 ORA 3 SP1 4 ADD 3 SP1 2 SUB 1 IX 2 CMP 1 IX 2 SBC 1 IX 2 CPX 1 IX 2 AND 1 IX 2 BIT 1 IX 2 LDA 1 IX 2 STA 1 IX 2 EOR 1 IX 2 ADC 1 IX 2 ORA 1 IX 2 ADD 1 IX 2 JMP 1 IX 4 JSR 1 IX 4 2 LDX LDX 3 SP1 1 IX 4 2 STX STX 3 SP1 1 IX High Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal LSB Low Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal 0 5 Cycles BRSET0 Opcode Mnemonic 3 DIR Number of Bytes / Addressing Mode Central Processor Unit (CPU) Technical Data 94 Table 6-2. Opcode Map Bit Manipulation DIR DIR Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 7. Oscillator (OSC) 7.1 Contents 7.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 7.3 Internal Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 7.4 Crystal (X-tal) Oscillator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 7.5 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 7.5.1 Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.2 Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.3 Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.4 Internal RC Clock (ICLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 7.5.5 CGM Oscillator Clock (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.5.6 CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 7.6 Low Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 7.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 7.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 7.7 Oscillator During Break Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 7.2 Introduction The oscillator module provides the reference clock for the clock generator module (CGM), the real time clock module (RTC), and other MCU sub-systems. The oscillator module consist of two types of oscillator circuits: • Internal RC oscillator • Crystal (x-tal) oscillator MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Oscillator (OSC) 95 Oscillator (OSC) The reference clock for the CGM, real time clock module (RTC), and other MCU sub-systems is driven by the crystal oscillator. The COP module is always driven by internal RC oscillator. The RC internal oscillator runs continuously after a POR or reset and is always available in run and wait modes. In stop mode, it can be disabled by setting the STOP_IRCDIS bit in CONFIG2 register. Figure 7-1. shows the block diagram of the oscillator module. SIMOSCEN From SIM CONFIG2 EN STOP_IRCDIS ICLK INTERNAL RC To SIM, COP OSCILLATOR INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR CGMRCLK To CGM PLL CONFIG2 CGMXCLK STOP_XCLKEN MCU To RTC, ADC, LCD, CGM Clock Selection MUX CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR OSC1 OSC2 RB RS* *RS can be zero (shorted) when used with higher-frequency crystals. Refer to manufacturer’s data. X1 See Section 23. for component value requirements. C1 C2 Figure 7-1. Oscillator Module Block Diagram Technical Data 96 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Oscillator (OSC) MOTOROLA Oscillator (OSC) Internal Oscillator 7.3 Internal Oscillator The internal RC oscillator clock (ICLK) is a free running 64kHz clock (at VDD = 5V) that requires no external components. It is the reference clock input to the computer operating properly (COP) module. The ICLK can be turned off in stop mode by setting the STOP_IRCDIS bit in CONFIG2. After reset, the bit is clear by default and ICLK is enabled during stop mode. 7.4 Crystal (X-tal) Oscillator The crystal (x-tal) oscillator circuit is designed for use with an external crystal or ceramic resonator to provide an accurate clock source. In its typical configuration, the X-tal oscillator is connected in a Pierce oscillator configuration, as shown in Figure 7-1. This figure shows only the logical representation of the internal components and may not represent actual circuitry. The oscillator configuration uses five components: • Crystal, X1 • Fixed capacitor, C1 • Tuning capacitor, C2 (can also be a fixed capacitor) • Feedback resistor, RB • Series resistor, RS (optional) The series resistor (RS) is included in the diagram to follow strict Pierce oscillator guidelines and may not be required for all ranges of operation, especially with high frequency crystals. Refer to the crystal manufacturer’s data for more information. 7.5 I/O Signals The following paragraphs describe the oscillator I/O signals. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Oscillator (OSC) 97 Oscillator (OSC) 7.5.1 Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1) OSC1 pin is an input to the crystal oscillator amplifier. Schmitt trigger and glitch filter are implemented on this pin to improve EMC performance. See Section 23. Electrical Specifications for detail specification of the glitch filter. 7.5.2 Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) OSC2 pin is the output of the crystal oscillator inverting amplifier. 7.5.3 Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN) The SIMOSCEN signal from the system integration module (SIM) enables/disables the internal RC and x-tal oscillator circuits. 7.5.4 Internal RC Clock (ICLK) The ICLK clock is the output from the internal RC oscillator. This clock drives the SIM and COP modules. 7.5.5 CGM Oscillator Clock (CGMXCLK) The CGMXCLK clock is the output from the x-tal oscillator. This clock drives to CGM, real time clock module, analog-to-digital converter, liquid crystal display driver module, and other MCU sub-systems. 7.5.6 CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) This is buffered signal of CGMXCLK, it is used by the CGM as the phase-locked-loop (PLL) reference clock. 7.6 Low Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low-power consumption standby modes. Technical Data 98 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Oscillator (OSC) MOTOROLA Oscillator (OSC) Oscillator During Break Mode 7.6.1 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction has no effect on the oscillator module. CGMXCLK, CGMRCLK, and ICLK continues to drive the MCU modules. 7.6.2 Stop Mode The STOP instruction clears the SIMOSCEN signal, and hence the CGMXCLK (and CGMRCLK) clock stops running. For continuous CGMXCLK operation in stop mode, set the STOP_XCLKEN to logic 1 before entering stop mode. Continuous CGMXCLK operation in stop mode allows the RTC module to generate interrupts to wake up the CPU. By default, the internal RC oscillator clock, ICLK, continues to run in stop mode. To disable the ICLK in stop mode, set the STOP_IRCDIS bit to logic 1 before entering stop mode. 7.7 Oscillator During Break Mode The oscillator circuits continue to drive CGMXCLK, CGMRCLK, and ICLK when the device enters the break state. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Oscillator (OSC) 99 Oscillator (OSC) Technical Data 100 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Oscillator (OSC) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.1 Contents 8.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 8.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 8.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 8.4.1 Oscillator Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 8.4.2 Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 8.4.3 PLL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 8.4.4 Acquisition and Tracking Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 8.4.5 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes. . . . . . . . . . 108 8.4.6 Programming the PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 8.4.9 CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 8.5 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 8.5.1 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.2 PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.3 PLL Analog Ground Pin (VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.4 Oscillator Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . 116 8.5.5 CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 8.5.6 CGM VCO Clock Output (CGMVCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 8.5.7 CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 8.5.8 CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 8.6 CGM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117 8.6.1 PLL Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 8.6.3 PLL Multiplier Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 8.6.4 PLL VCO Range Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 8.6.5 PLL Reference Divider Select Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 101 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.7 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8 Special Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 8.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 8.8.3 CGM During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 8.9.1 Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 8.9.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 8.9.3 Choosing a Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 8.2 Introduction This section describes the clock generator module (CGM). The CGM generates the base clock signal, CGMOUT, which is based on either the oscillator clock divided by two or the divided phase-locked loop (PLL) clock, CGMPCLK, divided by two. CGMOUT is the clock from which the SIM derives the system clocks, including the bus clock, which is at a frequency of CGMOUT÷2. The PLL is a frequency generator designed for use with a low frequency crystal (typically 32.768kHz) to generate a base frequency and dividing to a maximum bus frequency of 8MHz. Technical Data 102 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Features 8.3 Features Features of the CGM include: • Phase-locked loop with output frequency in integer multiples of an integer dividend of the crystal reference • Low-frequency crystal operation with low-power operation and high-output frequency resolution • Programmable prescaler for power-of-two increases in frequency • Programmable hardware voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO) for low-jitter operation • Automatic bandwidth control mode for low-jitter operation • Automatic frequency lock detector • CPU interrupt on entry or exit from locked condition • Configuration register bit to allow oscillator operation during stop mode 8.4 Functional Description The CGM consists of three major sub-modules: • Oscillator module — The oscillator module generates the constant reference frequency clock, CGMRCLK (buffered CGMXCLK). • Phase-locked loop (PLL) — The PLL generates the programmable VCO frequency clock, CGMVCLK, and the divided, CGMPCLK. The CGMPCLK is one of the reference clocks to the base clock selector circuit. • Base clock selector circuit — This software-controlled circuit selects the one of three clocks as the base clock, CGMOUT: CGMXCLK, CGMXCLK divided by two, or CGMPCLK divided by two. Figure 8-1 shows the structure of the CGM. Figure 8-2 is a summary of the CGM registers. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 103 Clock Generator Module (CGM) OSCILLATOR (OSC) MODULE See Section 7. Oscillator (OSC). SIMOSCEN From SIM ICLK INTERNAL RC OSC To SIM (and COP) CGMXCLK OSC2 CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR T0 RTC, ADC, LCD CGMRCLK OSC1 USER MODE: CGMOUT = B RESET: A PHASE-LOCKED LOOP (PLL) RESET: A A B1 CGMRDV REFERENCE DIVIDER ÷2 S CGMOUT A 1 B1 S CGMRCLK B S BASE CLOCK SELECT CIRCUIT BCS R A To SIM SIMDIV2 From SIM DIV2CLK RDS[3:0] VDDA CGMXFC CGMPCLK VSSA CONFIG2 VPR[1:0] VRS[7:0] L PHASE DETECTOR 2E VOLTAGE CONTROLLED OSCILLATOR LOOP FILTER PLL ANALOG AUTOMATIC MODE CONTROL LOCK DETECTOR LOCK AUTO MUL[11:0] N CGMVDV FREQUENCY DIVIDER ACQ CGMINT INTERRUPT CONTROL PLLIE To SIM PLLF PRE[1:0] 2P FREQUENCY DIVIDER CGMVCLK CGMPCLK Figure 8-1. CGM Block Diagram Technical Data 104 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Functional Description Addr. Register Name Bit 7 Read: $0036 $0037 $0038 $0039 $003A $003B PLL Control Register Write: (PTCL) Reset: Read: PLL Bandwidth Control Register Write: (PBWC) Reset: Read: PLL Multiplier Select Register High Write: (PMSH) Reset: Read: PLL Multiplier Select Register Low Write: (PMSL) Reset: Read: PLL VCO Range Select Register Write: (PMRS) Reset: Read: PLL Reference Divider Select Register Write: (PMDS) Reset: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PLLON BCS PRE1 PRE0 VPR1 VPR0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 PLLF PLLIE 0 0 LOCK AUTO R ACQ 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MUL11 MUL10 MUL9 MUL8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MUL7 MUL6 MUL5 MUL4 MUL3 MUL2 MUL1 MUL0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 VRS7 VRS6 VRS5 VRS4 VRS3 VRS2 VRS1 VRS0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 RDS3 RDS2 RDS1 RDS0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R = Reserved NOTES: 1. When AUTO = 0, PLLIE is forced clear and is read-only. 2. When AUTO = 0, PLLF and LOCK read as clear. 3. When AUTO = 1, ACQ is read-only. 4. When PLLON = 0 or VRS7:VRS0 = $0, BCS is forced clear and is read-only. 5. When PLLON = 1, the PLL programming register is read-only. 6. When BCS = 1, PLLON is forced set and is read-only. Figure 8-2. CGM I/O Register Summary MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 105 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.4.1 Oscillator Module The oscillator module provides two clock outputs CGMXCLK and CGMRCLK to the CGM module. CGMXCLK or CGMXCLK divide-by-two can be selected to drive the SIM module to generate the system bus clocks. CGMRCLK is the reference clock for the phase-lock-loop, to generate a higher frequency clock. The oscillator module also provides the reference clock for the real time clock (RTC) module. See Section 7. Oscillator (OSC) for detailed description on oscillator module. See Section 12. Real Time Clock (RTC) for detailed description on RTC. 8.4.2 Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) The PLL is a frequency generator that can operate in either acquisition mode or tracking mode, depending on the accuracy of the output frequency. The PLL can change between acquisition and tracking modes either automatically or manually. 8.4.3 PLL Circuits The PLL consists of these circuits: • Voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO) • Reference divider • Frequency pre-scaler • Modulo VCO frequency divider • Phase detector • Loop filter • Lock detector Technical Data 106 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Functional Description The operating range of the VCO is programmable for a wide range of frequencies and for maximum immunity to external noise, including supply and CGMXFC noise. The VCO frequency is bound to a range from roughly one-half to twice the center-of-range frequency, fVRS. Modulating the voltage on the CGMXFC pin changes the frequency within this range. By design, fVRS is equal to the nominal center-of-range frequency, fNOM, (38.4 kHz) times a linear factor, L, and a power-of-two factor, E, or (L × 2E)fNOM. CGMRCLK is the PLL reference clock, a buffered version of CGMXCLK. CGMRCLK runs at a frequency, fRCLK, and is fed to the PLL through a programmable modulo reference divider, which divides fRCLK by a factor, R. The divider’s output is the final reference clock, CGMRDV, running at a frequency, fRDV = fRCLK/R. With an external crystal (30kHz–100kHz), always set R = 1 for specified performance. With an external high-frequency clock source, use R to divide the external frequency to between 30kHz and 100kHz. The VCO’s output clock, CGMVCLK, running at a frequency, fVCLK, is fed back through a programmable pre-scaler divider and a programmable modulo divider. The pre-scaler divides the VCO clock by a power-of-two factor P (the CGMPCLK) and the modulo divider reduces the VCO clock by a factor, N. The dividers’ output is the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV, running at a frequency, fVDV = fVCLK/(N × 2P). (See 8.4.6 Programming the PLL for more information.) The phase detector then compares the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV, with the final reference clock, CGMRDV. A correction pulse is generated based on the phase difference between the two signals. The loop filter then slightly alters the DC voltage on the external capacitor connected to CGMXFC based on the width and direction of the correction pulse. The filter can make fast or slow corrections depending on its mode, described in 8.4.4 Acquisition and Tracking Modes. The value of the external capacitor and the reference frequency determines the speed of the corrections and the stability of the PLL. The lock detector compares the frequencies of the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV, and the final reference clock, CGMRDV. Therefore, the speed of the lock detector is directly proportional to the final reference frequency, fRDV. The circuit determines the mode of the PLL and the lock condition based on this comparison. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 107 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.4.4 Acquisition and Tracking Modes The PLL filter is manually or automatically configurable into one of two operating modes: • Acquisition mode — In acquisition mode, the filter can make large frequency corrections to the VCO. This mode is used at PLL start up or when the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the VCO frequency is far off the desired frequency. When in acquisition mode, the ACQ bit is clear in the PLL bandwidth control register. (See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.) • Tracking mode — In tracking mode, the filter makes only small corrections to the frequency of the VCO. PLL jitter is much lower in tracking mode, but the response to noise is also slower. The PLL enters tracking mode when the VCO frequency is nearly correct, such as when the PLL is selected as the base clock source. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.) The PLL is automatically in tracking mode when not in acquisition mode or when the ACQ bit is set. 8.4.5 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes The PLL can change the bandwidth or operational mode of the loop filter manually or automatically. Automatic mode is recommended for most users. In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the lock detector automatically switches between acquisition and tracking modes. Automatic bandwidth control mode also is used to determine when the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is safe to use as the source for the base clock, CGMOUT. (See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.) If PLL interrupts are enabled, the software can wait for a PLL interrupt request and then check the LOCK bit. If interrupts are disabled, software can poll the LOCK bit continuously (during PLL start-up, usually) or at periodic intervals. In either case, when the LOCK bit is set, the VCO clock is safe to use as the source for the base clock. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.) If the VCO is selected as the source for the base clock and the LOCK bit is clear, the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the software must take appropriate action, depending on the application. (See 8.7 Interrupts for information and precautions on using interrupts.) Technical Data 108 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Functional Description The following conditions apply when the PLL is in automatic bandwidth control mode: • The ACQ bit (See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.) is a read-only indicator of the mode of the filter. (See 8.4.4 Acquisition and Tracking Modes.) • The ACQ bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain tolerance and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of a certain tolerance. (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications for more information.) • The LOCK bit is a read-only indicator of the locked state of the PLL. • The LOCK bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain tolerance and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of a certain tolerance. (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications for more information.) • CPU interrupts can occur if enabled (PLLIE = 1) when the PLL’s lock condition changes, toggling the LOCK bit. (See 8.6.1 PLL Control Register.) The PLL also may operate in manual mode (AUTO = 0). Manual mode is used by systems that do not require an indicator of the lock condition for proper operation. Such systems typically operate well below fBUSMAX. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 109 Clock Generator Module (CGM) The following conditions apply when in manual mode: • ACQ is a writable control bit that controls the mode of the filter. Before turning on the PLL in manual mode, the ACQ bit must be clear. • Before entering tracking mode (ACQ = 1), software must wait a given time, tACQ (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications.), after turning on the PLL by setting PLLON in the PLL control register (PCTL). • Software must wait a given time, tAL, after entering tracking mode before selecting the PLL as the clock source to CGMOUT (BCS = 1). • The LOCK bit is disabled. • CPU interrupts from the CGM are disabled. 8.4.6 Programming the PLL The following procedure shows how to program the PLL. NOTE: The round function in the following equations means that the real number should be rounded to the nearest integer number. 1. Choose the desired bus frequency, fBUSDES. 2. Calculate the desired VCO frequency, fVCLKDES. P P f VCLKDES = 2 × f CGMPCLK = 2 × 4 × fBUSDES where P is the power of two multiplier, and can be 0, 1, 2, or 3 3. Choose a practical PLL reference frequency, fRCLK, and the reference clock divider, R. Typically, the reference is 32.768kHz and R = 1. Frequency errors to the PLL are corrected at a rate of fRCLK/R. For stability and lock time reduction, this rate must be as fast as possible. The VCO frequency must be an integer multiple of this rate. Technical Data 110 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Functional Description The relationship between the VCO frequency, fVCLK, and the reference frequency, fRCLK, is P 2 N f VCLK = ----------- ( f RCLK ) R where N is the integer range multiplier, between 1 and 4095. In cases where desired bus frequency has some tolerance, choose fRCLK to a value determined either by other module requirements (such as modules which are clocked by CGMXCLK), cost requirements, or ideally, as high as the specified range allows. See Section 23. Electrical Specifications. Choose the reference divider, R = 1. When the tolerance on the bus frequency is tight, choose fRCLK to an integer divisor of fBUSDES, and R = 1. If fRCLK cannot meet this requirement, use the following equation to solve for R with practical choices of fRCLK, and choose the fRCLK that gives the lowest R.  f VCLKDES    f VCLKDES R = round R MAX ×   -------------------------- – integer  --------------------------   f RCLK     f RCLK  4. Calculate N:  R × fVCLKDES N = round  ------------------------------------ P  f ×2  RCLK 5. Calculate and verify the adequacy of the VCO and bus frequencies fVCLK and fBUS. P 2 N f VCLK = ----------- ( f RCLK ) R f f BUS = VCLK ----------P 2 ×4 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 111 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 6. Select the VCO’s power-of-two range multiplier E, according to this table: Frequency Range E 0 < fVCLK < 9,830,400 0 9,830,400 ≤ fVCLK < 19,660,800 1 19,660,800 ≤ fVCLK < 39,321,600 2 NOTE: Do not program E to a value of 3. 7. Select a VCO linear range multiplier, L, where fNOM = 38.4kHz  f VCLK  L = round  -------------------------  2E × f  NOM 8. Calculate and verify the adequacy of the VCO programmed center-of-range frequency, fVRS. The center-of-range frequency is the midpoint between the minimum and maximum frequencies attainable by the PLL. E f VRS = ( L × 2 )f NOM For proper operation, E f VRS – f VCLK f NOM × 2 ≤ -------------------------2 9. Verify the choice of P, R, N, E, and L by comparing fVCLK to fVRS and fVCLKDES. For proper operation, fVCLK must be within the application’s tolerance of fVCLKDES, and fVRS must be as close as possible to fVCLK. NOTE: Exceeding the recommended maximum bus frequency or VCO frequency can crash the MCU. Technical Data 112 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Functional Description 10. Program the PLL registers accordingly: a. In the PRE bits of the PLL control register (PCTL), program the binary equivalent of P. b. In the VPR bits of the PLL control register (PCTL), program the binary equivalent of E. c. In the PLL multiplier select register low (PMSL) and the PLL multiplier select register high (PMSH), program the binary equivalent of N. d. In the PLL VCO range select register (PMRS), program the binary coded equivalent of L. e. In the PLL reference divider select register (PMDS), program the binary coded equivalent of R. NOTE: The values for P, E, N, L, and R can only be programmed when the PLL is off (PLLON = 0). Table 8-1 provides numeric examples (numbers are in hexadecimal notation): Table 8-1. Numeric Examples CGMVCLK CGMPCLK fBUS fRCLK R N P E L 8.0 MHz 8.0 MHz 2.0 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 F5 0 0 D1 9.8304 MHz 9.8304 MHz 2.4576 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 12C 0 1 80 10.0 MHz 10.0 MHz 2.5 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 132 0 1 83 16 MHz 16 MHz 4.0 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 1E9 0 1 D1 19.6608 MHz 19.6608 MHz 4.9152 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 258 0 2 80 20 MHz 20 MHz 5.0 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 263 0 2 82 29.4912 MHz 29.4912 MHz 7.3728 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 384 0 2 C0 32 MHz 32 MHz 8.0 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 3D1 0 2 D0 32 MHz 16 MHz 4.0 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 1E9 1 2 D0 32 MHz 8 MHz 2.0 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 F5 2 2 D0 32 MHz 4 MHz 1.0 MHz 32.768 kHz 1 7B 3 2 D0 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 113 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions The programming method described in 8.4.6 Programming the PLL does not account for three possible exceptions. A value of 0 for R, N, or L is meaningless when used in the equations given. To account for these exceptions: • A 0 value for R or N is interpreted exactly the same as a value of 1. • A 0 value for L disables the PLL and prevents its selection as the source for the base clock. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.) 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit This circuit is used to select either the oscillator clock, CGMXCLK, or the divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, as the source of the base clock, CGMOUT. The two input clocks go through a transition control circuit that waits up to three CGMXCLK cycles and three CGMPCLK cycles to change from one clock source to the other. During this time, CGMOUT is held in stasis. The output of the transition control circuit is then divided by two to correct the duty cycle. Therefore, the bus clock frequency, which is one-half of CGMOUT, is one-fourth the frequency of the selected clock (CGMXCLK or CGMPCLK). For the CGMXCLK, the divide-by-2 can be by-passed by setting the DIV2CLK bit in the CONFIG2 register. Therefore, the bus clock frequency can be one-half of CGMXCLK. The BCS bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) selects which clock drives CGMOUT. The divided VCO clock cannot be selected as the base clock source if the PLL is not turned on. The PLL cannot be turned off if the divided VCO clock is selected. The PLL cannot be turned on or off simultaneously with the selection or deselection of the divided VCO clock. The divided VCO clock also cannot be selected as the base clock source if the factor L is programmed to a 0. This value would set up a condition inconsistent with the operation of the PLL, so that the PLL would be disabled and the oscillator clock would be forced as the source of the base clock. Technical Data 114 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) I/O Signals 8.4.9 CGM External Connections In its typical configuration, the CGM requires up to four external components. Figure 8-3 shows the external components for the PLL: • Bypass capacitor, CBYP • Filter network Care should be taken with PCB routing in order to minimize signal cross talk and noise. (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications for routing information, filter network and its effects on PLL performance.) MCU CGMXFC VSSA VDDA VDD 10 kΩ 0.01 µF CBYP 0.1 µF 0.033 µF Note: Filter network in box can be replaced with a 0.47µF capacitor, but will degrade stability. Figure 8-3. CGM External Connections 8.5 I/O Signals The following paragraphs describe the CGM I/O signals. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 115 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.5.1 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) The CGMXFC pin is required by the loop filter to filter out phase corrections. An external filter network is connected to this pin. (See Figure 8-3.) NOTE: To prevent noise problems, the filter network should be placed as close to the CGMXFC pin as possible, with minimum routing distances and no routing of other signals across the network. 8.5.2 PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) VDDA is a power pin used by the analog portions of the PLL. Connect the VDDA pin to the same voltage potential as the VDD pin. NOTE: Route VDDA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. 8.5.3 PLL Analog Ground Pin (VSSA) VSSA is a ground pin used by the analog portions of the PLL. Connect the VSSA pin to the same voltage potential as the VSS pin. NOTE: Route VSSA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. NOTE: On this MCU, the VSSA is physically bonded to the VSS pin. 8.5.4 Oscillator Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) CGMXCLK is the oscillator output signal. It runs at the full speed of the oscillator, and is generated directly from the crystal oscillator circuit, the RC oscillator circuit, or the internal oscillator circuit. 8.5.5 CGM Reference Clock (CGMRCLK) CGMRCLK is a buffered version of CGMXCLK, this clock is the reference clock for the phase-locked-loop circuit. Technical Data 116 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) CGM Registers 8.5.6 CGM VCO Clock Output (CGMVCLK) CGMVCLK is the clock output from the VCO. 8.5.7 CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT) CGMOUT is the clock output of the CGM. This signal goes to the SIM, which generates the MCU clocks. CGMOUT is a 50 percent duty cycle clock running at twice the bus frequency. CGMOUT is software programmable to be equal to CGMXCLK, CGMXCLK divided by two, or CGMPCLK divided by two. 8.5.8 CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) CGMINT is the interrupt signal generated by the PLL lock detector. 8.6 CGM Registers The following registers control and monitor operation of the CGM: • PLL control register (PCTL) (See 8.6.1 PLL Control Register.) • PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) (See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.) • PLL multiplier select registers (PMSH and PMSL) (See 8.6.3 PLL Multiplier Select Registers.) • PLL VCO range select register (PMRS) (See 8.6.4 PLL VCO Range Select Register.) • PLL reference divider select register (PMDS) (See 8.6.5 PLL Reference Divider Select Register.) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 117 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.6.1 PLL Control Register The PLL control register (PCTL) contains the interrupt enable and flag bits, the on/off switch, the base clock selector bit, the prescaler bits, and the VCO power-of-two range selector bits. Address: $0036 Bit 7 Read: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PLLON BCS PRE1 PRE0 VPR1 VPR0 1 0 0 0 0 0 PLLF PLLIE Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 8-4. PLL Control Register (PCTL) PLLIE — PLL Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the PLL to generate an interrupt request when the LOCK bit toggles, setting the PLL flag, PLLF. When the AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) is clear, PLLIE cannot be written and reads as logic 0. Reset clears the PLLIE bit. 1 = PLL interrupts enabled 0 = PLL interrupts disabled PLLF — PLL Interrupt Flag Bit This read-only bit is set whenever the LOCK bit toggles. PLLF generates an interrupt request if the PLLIE bit also is set. PLLF always reads as logic 0 when the AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) is clear. Clear the PLLF bit by reading the PLL control register. Reset clears the PLLF bit. 1 = Change in lock condition 0 = No change in lock condition NOTE: Do not inadvertently clear the PLLF bit. Any read or read-modify-write operation on the PLL control register clears the PLLF bit. Technical Data 118 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) CGM Registers PLLON — PLL On Bit This read/write bit activates the PLL and enables the VCO clock, CGMVCLK. PLLON cannot be cleared if the VCO clock is driving the base clock, CGMOUT (BCS = 1). (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.) Reset sets this bit so that the loop can stabilize as the MCU is powering up. 1 = PLL on 0 = PLL off BCS — Base Clock Select Bit This read/write bit selects either the oscillator output, CGMXCLK, or the divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, as the source of the CGM output, CGMOUT. CGMOUT frequency is one-half the frequency of the selected clock. BCS cannot be set while the PLLON bit is clear. After toggling BCS, it may take up to three CGMXCLK and three CGMPCLK cycles to complete the transition from one source clock to the other. During the transition, CGMOUT is held in stasis. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.) Reset clears the BCS bit. 1 = CGMPCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT 0 = CGMXCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT NOTE: PLLON and BCS have built-in protection that prevents the base clock selector circuit from selecting the VCO clock as the source of the base clock if the PLL is off. Therefore, PLLON cannot be cleared when BCS is set, and BCS cannot be set when PLLON is clear. If the PLL is off (PLLON = 0), selecting CGMPCLK requires two writes to the PLL control register. (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit.) PRE1 and PRE0 — Prescaler Program Bits These read/write bits control a prescaler that selects the prescaler power-of-two multiplier, P. (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits and 8.4.6 Programming the PLL.) PRE1 and PRE0 cannot be written when the PLLON bit is set. Reset clears these bits. These prescaler bits affects the relationship between the VCO clock and the final system bus clock. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 119 Clock Generator Module (CGM) Table 8-2. PRE 1 and PRE0 Programming PRE1 and PRE0 P Prescaler Multiplier 00 0 1 01 1 2 10 2 4 11 3 8 VPR1 and VPR0 — VCO Power-of-Two Range Select Bits These read/write bits control the VCO’s hardware power-of-two range multiplier E that, in conjunction with L (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits, 8.4.6 Programming the PLL, and 8.6.4 PLL VCO Range Select Register.) controls the hardware center-of-range frequency, fVRS. VPR1:VPR0 cannot be written when the PLLON bit is set. Reset clears these bits. Table 8-3. VPR1 and VPR0 Programming VPR1 and VPR0 E VCO Power-of-Two Range Multiplier 00 0 1 01 1 2 10 2 4 NOTE: Do not program E to a value of 3. 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register The PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC): • Selects automatic or manual (software-controlled) bandwidth control mode • Indicates when the PLL is locked • In automatic bandwidth control mode, indicates when the PLL is in acquisition or tracking mode • In manual operation, forces the PLL into acquisition or tracking mode Technical Data 120 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) CGM Registers Address: $0037 Bit 7 Read: 6 5 LOCK AUTO 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 ACQ Bit 0 R Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 R 0 0 0 = Reserved Figure 8-5. PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWCR) AUTO — Automatic Bandwidth Control Bit This read/write bit selects automatic or manual bandwidth control. When initializing the PLL for manual operation (AUTO = 0), clear the ACQ bit before turning on the PLL. Reset clears the AUTO bit. 1 = Automatic bandwidth control 0 = Manual bandwidth control LOCK — Lock Indicator Bit When the AUTO bit is set, LOCK is a read-only bit that becomes set when the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is locked (running at the programmed frequency). When the AUTO bit is clear, LOCK reads as logic 0 and has no meaning. The write one function of this bit is reserved for test, so this bit must always be written a 0. Reset clears the LOCK bit. 1 = VCO frequency correct or locked 0 = VCO frequency incorrect or unlocked ACQ — Acquisition Mode Bit When the AUTO bit is set, ACQ is a read-only bit that indicates whether the PLL is in acquisition mode or tracking mode. When the AUTO bit is clear, ACQ is a read/write bit that controls whether the PLL is in acquisition or tracking mode. In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the last-written value from manual operation is stored in a temporary location and is recovered when manual operation resumes. Reset clears this bit, enabling acquisition mode. 1 = Tracking mode 0 = Acquisition mode MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 121 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.6.3 PLL Multiplier Select Registers The PLL multiplier select registers (PMSH and PMSL) contain the programming information for the modulo feedback divider. Address: Read: $0038 Bit 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 3 2 1 Bit 0 MUL11 MUL10 MUL9 MUL8 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 8-6. PLL Multiplier Select Register High (PMSH) Address: $0039 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 MUL7 MUL6 MUL5 MUL4 MUL3 MUL2 MUL1 MUL0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 8-7. PLL Multiplier Select Register Low (PMSL) MUL[11:0] — Multiplier Select Bits These read/write bits control the modulo feedback divider that selects the VCO frequency multiplier N. (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits and 8.4.6 Programming the PLL.) A value of $0000 in the multiplier select registers configure the modulo feedback divider the same as a value of $0001. Reset initializes the registers to $0040 for a default multiply value of 64. NOTE: The multiplier select bits have built-in protection such that they cannot be written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1). Technical Data 122 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) CGM Registers 8.6.4 PLL VCO Range Select Register The PLL VCO range select register (PMRS) contains the programming information required for the hardware configuration of the VCO. Address: $003A Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 VRS7 VRS6 VRS5 VRS4 VRS3 VRS2 VRS1 VRS0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 8-8. PLL VCO Range Select Register (PMRS) VRS[7:0] — VCO Range Select Bits These read/write bits control the hardware center-of-range linear multiplier L which, in conjunction with E (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits, 8.4.6 Programming the PLL, and 8.6.1 PLL Control Register.), controls the hardware center-of-range frequency, fVRS. VRS[7:0] cannot be written when the PLLON bit in the PCTL is set. (See 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions.)A value of $00 in the VCO range select register disables the PLL and clears the BCS bit in the PLL control register (PCTL). (See 8.4.8 Base Clock Selector Circuit and 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions.). Reset initializes the register to $40 for a default range multiply value of 64. NOTE: The VCO range select bits have built-in protection such that they cannot be written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1) and such that the VCO clock cannot be selected as the source of the base clock (BCS = 1) if the VCO range select bits are all clear. The PLL VCO range select register must be programmed correctly. Incorrect programming can result in failure of the PLL to achieve lock. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 123 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.6.5 PLL Reference Divider Select Register The PLL reference divider select register (PMDS) contains the programming information for the modulo reference divider. Address: Read: $003B Bit 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 3 2 1 Bit 0 RDS3 RDS2 RDS1 RDS0 0 0 0 1 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 8-9. PLL Reference Divider Select Register (PMDS) RDS[3:0] — Reference Divider Select Bits These read/write bits control the modulo reference divider that selects the reference division factor, R. (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits and 8.4.6 Programming the PLL.) RDS[3:0] cannot be written when the PLLON bit in the PCTL is set. A value of $00 in the reference divider select register configures the reference divider the same as a value of $01. (See 8.4.7 Special Programming Exceptions.) Reset initializes the register to $01 for a default divide value of 1. NOTE: The reference divider select bits have built-in protection such that they cannot be written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1). NOTE: The default divide value of 1 is recommended for all applications. Technical Data 124 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Interrupts 8.7 Interrupts When the AUTO bit is set in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC), the PLL can generate a CPU interrupt request every time the LOCK bit changes state. The PLLIE bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) enables CPU interrupts from the PLL. PLLF, the interrupt flag in the PCTL, becomes set whether interrupts are enabled or not. When the AUTO bit is clear, CPU interrupts from the PLL are disabled and PLLF reads as logic 0. Software should read the LOCK bit after a PLL interrupt request to see if the request was due to an entry into lock or an exit from lock. When the PLL enters lock, the divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, divided by two can be selected as the CGMOUT source by setting BCS in the PCTL. When the PLL exits lock, the VCO clock frequency is corrupt, and appropriate precautions should be taken. If the application is not frequency sensitive, interrupts should be disabled to prevent PLL interrupt service routines from impeding software performance or from exceeding stack limitations. NOTE: Software can select the CGMPCLK divided by two as the CGMOUT source even if the PLL is not locked (LOCK = 0). Therefore, software should make sure the PLL is locked before setting the BCS bit. 8.8 Special Modes The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes. 8.8.1 Wait Mode The WAIT instruction does not affect the CGM. Before entering wait mode, software can disengage and turn off the PLL by clearing the BCS and PLLON bits in the PLL control register (PCTL) to save power. Less power-sensitive applications can disengage the PLL without turning it off, so that the PLL clock is immediately available at WAIT exit. This would be the case also when the PLL is to wake the MCU from wait mode, such as when the PLL is first enabled and waiting for LOCK or LOCK is lost. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 125 Clock Generator Module (CGM) 8.8.2 Stop Mode If the oscillator stop mode enable bit (STOP_XCLKEN in CONFIG2 register) is configured to disabled the oscillator in stop mode, then the STOP instruction disables the CGM (oscillator and phase locked loop) and holds low all CGM outputs (CGMOUT, CGMVCLK, CGMPCLK, and CGMINT). If the STOP instruction is executed with the divided VCO clock, CGMPCLK, divided by two driving CGMOUT, the PLL automatically clears the BCS bit in the PLL control register (PCTL), thereby selecting the oscillator clock, CGMXCLK, divided by two as the source of CGMOUT. When the MCU recovers from STOP, the crystal clock divided by two drives CGMOUT and BCS remains clear. If the oscillator stop mode enable bit is configured for continuous oscillator operation in stop mode, then the phase locked loop is shut off but the CGMXCLK will continue to drive the SIM and other MCU subsystems. 8.8.3 CGM During Break Interrupts The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in other modules can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. (See 9.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register.) To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state. To protect the PLLF bit during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write the PLL control register during the break state without affecting the PLLF bit. Technical Data 126 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications The acquisition and lock times of the PLL are, in many applications, the most critical PLL design parameters. Proper design and use of the PLL ensures the highest stability and lowest acquisition/lock times. 8.9.1 Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions Typical control systems refer to the acquisition time or lock time as the reaction time, within specified tolerances, of the system to a step input. In a PLL, the step input occurs when the PLL is turned on or when it suffers a noise hit. The tolerance is usually specified as a percent of the step input or when the output settles to the desired value plus or minus a percent of the frequency change. Therefore, the reaction time is constant in this definition, regardless of the size of the step input. For example, consider a system with a 5 percent acquisition time tolerance. If a command instructs the system to change from 0Hz to 1MHz, the acquisition time is the time taken for the frequency to reach 1MHz ±50kHz. 50kHz = 5% of the 1MHz step input. If the system is operating at 1MHz and suffers a –100kHz noise hit, the acquisition time is the time taken to return from 900kHz to 1MHz ±5kHz. 5kHz = 5% of the 100kHz step input. Other systems refer to acquisition and lock times as the time the system takes to reduce the error between the actual output and the desired output to within specified tolerances. Therefore, the acquisition or lock time varies according to the original error in the output. Minor errors may not even be registered. Typical PLL applications prefer to use this definition because the system requires the output frequency to be within a certain tolerance of the desired frequency regardless of the size of the initial error. 8.9.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time Acquisition and lock times are designed to be as short as possible while still providing the highest possible stability. These reaction times are not constant, however. Many factors directly and indirectly affect the acquisition time. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 127 Clock Generator Module (CGM) The most critical parameter which affects the reaction times of the PLL is the reference frequency, fRDV. This frequency is the input to the phase detector and controls how often the PLL makes corrections. For stability, the corrections must be small compared to the desired frequency, so several corrections are required to reduce the frequency error. Therefore, the slower the reference the longer it takes to make these corrections. This parameter is under user control via the choice of crystal frequency fXCLK and the R value programmed in the reference divider. (See 8.4.3 PLL Circuits, 8.4.6 Programming the PLL, and 8.6.5 PLL Reference Divider Select Register.) Another critical parameter is the external filter network. The PLL modifies the voltage on the VCO by adding or subtracting charge from capacitors in this network. Therefore, the rate at which the voltage changes for a given frequency error (thus change in charge) is proportional to the capacitance. The size of the capacitor also is related to the stability of the PLL. If the capacitor is too small, the PLL cannot make small enough adjustments to the voltage and the system cannot lock. If the capacitor is too large, the PLL may not be able to adjust the voltage in a reasonable time. (See 8.9.3 Choosing a Filter.) Also important is the operating voltage potential applied to VDDA. The power supply potential alters the characteristics of the PLL. A fixed value is best. Variable supplies, such as batteries, are acceptable if they vary within a known range at very slow speeds. Noise on the power supply is not acceptable, because it causes small frequency errors which continually change the acquisition time of the PLL. Temperature and processing also can affect acquisition time because the electrical characteristics of the PLL change. The part operates as specified as long as these influences stay within the specified limits. External factors, however, can cause drastic changes in the operation of the PLL. These factors include noise injected into the PLL through the filter capacitor, filter capacitor leakage, stray impedances on the circuit board, and even humidity or circuit board contamination. Technical Data 128 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Clock Generator Module (CGM) Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications 8.9.3 Choosing a Filter As described in 8.9.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time, the external filter network is critical to the stability and reaction time of the PLL. The PLL is also dependent on reference frequency and supply voltage. Either of the filter networks in Figure 8-10 is recommended when using a 32.768kHz reference clock (CGMRCLK). Figure 8-10 (a) is used for applications requiring better stability. Figure 8-10 (b) is used in low-cost applications where stability is not critical. CGMXFC 10 kΩ CGMXFC 0.01 µF 0.47 µF 0.033 µF VSSA VSSA (a) (b) Figure 8-10. PLL Filter MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Clock Generator Module (CGM) 129 Clock Generator Module (CGM) Technical Data 130 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Clock Generator Module (CGM) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM) 9.1 Contents 9.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 9.3 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134 9.3.1 Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 9.3.2 Clock Start-up from POR or LVI Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 9.3.3 Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 9.4 Reset and System Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 9.4.1 External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 9.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 9.4.2.1 Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 9.4.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset. . . . . . . . . . 139 9.4.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 9.4.2.4 Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 9.4.2.5 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 9.4.2.6 Monitor Mode Entry Module Reset (MODRST) . . . . . . . 140 9.5 SIM Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 9.5.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 9.5.2 SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 9.5.3 SIM Counter and Reset States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 9.6 Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 9.6.1 Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 9.6.1.1 Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 9.6.1.2 SWI Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 9.6.1.3 Interrupt Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 9.6.1.4 Interrupt Status Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 9.6.1.5 Interrupt Status Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 9.6.1.6 Interrupt Status Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 9.6.2 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 9.6.3 Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 131 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.6.4 Status Flag Protection in Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 9.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 9.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 9.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 9.8 SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 9.8.1 SIM Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 9.8.2 SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 9.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 9.2 Introduction This section describes the system integration module (SIM). Together with the CPU, the SIM controls all MCU activities. A block diagram of the SIM is shown in Figure 9-1. Table 9-1 is a summary of the SIM input/output (I/O) registers. The SIM is a system state controller that coordinates CPU and exception timing. The SIM is responsible for: • Bus clock generation and control for CPU and peripherals: – Stop/wait/reset/break entry and recovery – Internal clock control • Master reset control, including power-on reset (POR) and COP timeout • Interrupt control: – Acknowledge timing – Arbitration control timing – Vector address generation • CPU enable/disable timing • Modular architecture expandable to 128 interrupt sources Table 9-1 shows the internal signal names used in this section. Technical Data 132 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) Introduction MODULE STOP MODULE WAIT CPU STOP (FROM CPU) CPU WAIT (FROM CPU) STOP/WAIT CONTROL SIMOSCEN (TO CGM, OSC) SIM COUNTER COP CLOCK ICLK (FROM OSC) CGMOUT (FROM CGM) ÷2 CLOCK CONTROL VDD CLOCK GENERATORS INTERNAL CLOCKS INTERNAL PULLUP DEVICE RESET PIN LOGIC LVI (FROM LVI MODULE) POR CONTROL MASTER RESET CONTROL RESET PIN CONTROL SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER ILLEGAL OPCODE (FROM CPU) ILLEGAL ADDRESS (FROM ADDRESS MAP DECODERS) COP (FROM COP MODULE) RESET INTERRUPT SOURCES INTERRUPT CONTROL AND PRIORITY DECODE CPU INTERFACE Figure 9-1. SIM Block Diagram Table 9-1. Signal Name Conventions Signal Name ICLK Description Internal RC oscillator clock CGMXCLK Buffered version of OSC1 from the oscillator module CGMPCLK PLL output and the divided PLL output CGMOUT PLL-based or oscillator-based clock output from CGM module (Bus clock = CGMOUT ÷ 2) IAB Internal address bus IDB Internal data bus PORRST Signal from the power-on reset module to the SIM IRST Internal reset signal R/W Read/write signal MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 133 System Integration Module (SIM) Addr. Register Name Read: SIM Break Status Register $FE00 Write: (SBSR) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 R R R R R R 1 Bit 0 SBSW Note R 0 Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW. Read: SIM Reset Status Register $FE01 Write: (SRSR) POR: $FE03 Read: SIM Break Flag Control Register Write: (SBFCR) Reset: POR PIN COP ILOP ILAD 0 LVI 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BCFE R R R R R R R 0 Read: Interrupt Status Register 1 $FE04 Write: (INT1) Reset: IF6 IF5 IF4 IF3 IF2 IF1 0 0 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Interrupt Status Register 2 $FE05 Write: (INT2) Reset: IF14 IF13 IF12 IF11 IF10 IF9 IF8 IF7 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Interrupt Status Register 3 $FE06 Write: (INT3) Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 IF17 IF16 IF15 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R = Reserved Figure 9-2. SIM I/O Register Summary 9.3 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation The bus clock generator provides system clock signals for the CPU and peripherals on the MCU. The system clocks are generated from an incoming clock, CGMOUT, as shown in Figure 9-3. This clock can come from either the oscillator module or from the on-chip PLL. (See Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).) Technical Data 134 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation OSC2 OSCILLATOR (OSC) MODULE CGMXCLK OSC1 ICLK STOP MODE CLOCK ENABLE SIGNALS FROM CONFIG2 TO RTC, ADC SIM COUNTER SIMOSCEN SYSTEM INTEGRATION MODULE CGMRCLK CGMOUT ÷2 PHASE-LOCKED LOOP (PLL) SIMDIV2 IT12 TO REST OF MCU BUS CLOCK GENERATORS IT23 TO REST OF MCU PTC1 MONITOR MODE USER MODE Figure 9-3. CGM Clock Signals 9.3.1 Bus Timing In user mode, the internal bus frequency is either the oscillator output (CGMXCLK) divided by four, CGMXCLK divided by two, or the PLL output (CGMPCLK) divided by four. 9.3.2 Clock Start-up from POR or LVI Reset When the power-on reset module or the low-voltage inhibit module generates a reset, the clocks to the CPU and peripherals are inactive and held in an inactive phase until after the 4096 ICLK cycle POR timeout has completed. The RST pin is driven low by the SIM during this entire period. The IBUS clocks start upon completion of the timeout. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 135 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.3.3 Clocks in Stop Mode and Wait Mode Upon exit from stop mode by an interrupt, break, or reset, the SIM allows ICLK to clock the SIM counter. The CPU and peripheral clocks do not become active until after the stop delay timeout. This timeout is selectable as 4096 or 32 ICLK cycles. (See 9.7.2 Stop Mode.) In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. The SIM also produces two sets of clocks for other modules. Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the module is active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode. 9.4 Reset and System Initialization The MCU has these reset sources: • Power-on reset module (POR) • External reset pin (RST) • Computer operating properly module (COP) • Low-voltage inhibit module (LVI) • Illegal opcode • Illegal address All of these resets produce the vector $FFFE:$FFFF ($FEFE:$FEFF in monitor mode) and assert the internal reset signal (IRST). IRST causes all registers to be returned to their default values and all modules to be returned to their reset states. An internal reset clears the SIM counter (see 9.5 SIM Counter), but an external reset does not. Each of the resets sets a corresponding bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). (See 9.8 SIM Registers.) Technical Data 136 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) Reset and System Initialization 9.4.1 External Pin Reset The RST pin circuit includes an internal pull-up device. Pulling the asynchronous RST pin low halts all processing. The PIN bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set as long as RST is held low for a minimum of 67 ICLK cycles, assuming that neither the POR nor the LVI was the source of the reset. See Table 9-2 for details. Figure 9-4 shows the relative timing. Table 9-2. PIN Bit Set Timing Reset Type Number of Cycles Required to Set PIN POR/LVI 4163 (4096 + 64 + 3) All others 67 (64 + 3) CGMOUT RST IAB VECT H VECT L PC Figure 9-4. External Reset Timing 9.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources All internal reset sources actively pull the RST pin low for 32 ICLK cycles to allow resetting of external peripherals. The internal reset signal IRST continues to be asserted for an additional 32 cycles (see Figure 9-5). An internal reset can be caused by an illegal address, illegal opcode, COP timeout, LVI, or POR (see Figure 9-6). NOTE: For LVI or POR resets, the SIM cycles through 4096 + 32 ICLK cycles during which the SIM forces the RST pin low. The internal reset signal then follows the sequence from the falling edge of RST shown in Figure 9-5. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 137 System Integration Module (SIM) IRST RST RST PULLED LOW BY MCU 32 CYCLES 32 CYCLES ICLK IAB VECTOR HIGH Figure 9-5. Internal Reset Timing The COP reset is asynchronous to the bus clock. ILLEGAL ADDRESS RST ILLEGAL OPCODE RST COPRST LVI POR INTERNAL RESET Figure 9-6. Sources of Internal Reset The active reset feature allows the part to issue a reset to peripherals and other chips within a system built around the MCU. 9.4.2.1 Power-On Reset When power is first applied to the MCU, the power-on reset module (POR) generates a pulse to indicate that power-on has occurred. The external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out 4096 + 32 ICLK cycles. Thirty-two ICLK cycles later, the CPU and memories are released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur. At power-on, these events occur: • A POR pulse is generated. • The internal reset signal is asserted. • The SIM enables CGMOUT. • Internal clocks to the CPU and modules are held inactive for 4096 ICLK cycles to allow stabilization of the oscillator. • The RST pin is driven low during the oscillator stabilization time. • The POR bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set and all other bits in the register are cleared. Technical Data 138 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) Reset and System Initialization OSC1 PORRST 4096 CYCLES 32 CYCLES 32 CYCLES ICLK CGMOUT RST IRST $FFFE IAB $FFFF Figure 9-7. POR Recovery 9.4.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset An input to the SIM is reserved for the COP reset signal. The overflow of the COP counter causes an internal reset and sets the COP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources. To prevent a COP module timeout, write any value to location $FFFF. Writing to location $FFFF clears the COP counter and bits 12 through 5 of the SIM counter. The SIM counter output, which occurs at least every 213 – 24 ICLK cycles, drives the COP counter. The COP should be serviced as soon as possible out of reset to guarantee the maximum amount of time before the first timeout. The COP module is disabled if the RST pin or the IRQ pin is held at VTST while the MCU is in monitor mode. The COP module can be disabled only through combinational logic conditioned with the high voltage signal on the RST or the IRQ pin. This prevents the COP from becoming disabled as a result of external noise. During a break state, VTST on the RST pin disables the COP module. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 139 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.4.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset The SIM decodes signals from the CPU to detect illegal instructions. An illegal instruction sets the ILOP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and causes a reset. If the stop enable bit, STOP, in the mask option register is logic 0, the SIM treats the STOP instruction as an illegal opcode and causes an illegal opcode reset. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources. 9.4.2.4 Illegal Address Reset An opcode fetch from an unmapped address generates an illegal address reset. The SIM verifies that the CPU is fetching an opcode prior to asserting the ILAD bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and resetting the MCU. A data fetch from an unmapped address does not generate a reset. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources. 9.4.2.5 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset The low-voltage inhibit module (LVI) asserts its output to the SIM when the VDD voltage falls to the LVI trip falling voltage, VTRIPF. The LVI bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set, and the external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out 4096 + 32 ICLK cycles. Thirty-two ICLK cycles later, the CPU is released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to occur. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources. 9.4.2.6 Monitor Mode Entry Module Reset (MODRST) The monitor mode entry module reset (MODRST) asserts its output to the SIM when monitor mode is entered in the condition where the reset vectors are blank ($FF). (See Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON).) When MODRST gets asserted, an internal reset occurs. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for all internal reset sources. Technical Data 140 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) SIM Counter 9.5 SIM Counter The SIM counter is used by the power-on reset module (POR) and in stop mode recovery to allow the oscillator time to stabilize before enabling the internal bus (IBUS) clocks. The SIM counter also serves as a prescaler for the computer operating properly module (COP). The SIM counter overflow supplies the clock for the COP module. The SIM counter is 12 bits long and is clocked by the falling edge of ICLK. 9.5.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset The power-on reset module (POR) detects power applied to the MCU. At power-on, the POR circuit asserts the signal PORRST. Once the SIM is initialized, it enables the clock generation module (CGM) to drive the bus clock state machine. 9.5.2 SIM Counter During Stop Mode Recovery The SIM counter also is used for stop mode recovery. The STOP instruction clears the SIM counter. After an interrupt, break, or reset, the SIM senses the state of the short stop recovery bit, SSREC, in the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1). If the SSREC bit is a logic 1, then the stop recovery is reduced from the normal delay of 4096 ICLK cycles down to 32 ICLK cycles. This is ideal for applications using canned oscillators that do not require long start-up times from stop mode. External crystal applications should use the full stop recovery time, that is, with SSREC cleared. 9.5.3 SIM Counter and Reset States External reset has no effect on the SIM counter. (See 9.7.2 Stop Mode for details.) The SIM counter is free-running after all reset states. (See 9.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources for counter control and internal reset recovery sequences.) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 141 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.6 Exception Control Normal, sequential program execution can be changed in three different ways: • Interrupts: – Maskable hardware CPU interrupts – Non-maskable software interrupt instruction (SWI) • Reset • Break interrupts 9.6.1 Interrupts At the beginning of an interrupt, the CPU saves the CPU register contents on the stack and sets the interrupt mask (I bit) to prevent additional interrupts. At the end of an interrupt, the RTI instruction recovers the CPU register contents from the stack so that normal processing can resume. Figure 9-8 shows interrupt entry timing, and Figure 9-9 shows interrupt recovery timing. MODULE INTERRUPT I-BIT IAB IDB DUMMY SP DUMMY SP – 1 SP – 2 PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8] SP – 3 X SP – 4 A VECT H CCR VECT L V DATA H START ADDR V DATA L OPCODE R/W Figure 9-8. Interrupt Entry Timing MODULE INTERRUPT I-BIT IAB IDB SP – 4 SP – 3 CCR SP – 2 A SP – 1 X SP PC PC – 1[15:8] PC – 1[7:0] PC + 1 OPCODE OPERAND R/W Figure 9-9. Interrupt Recovery Timing Technical Data 142 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) Exception Control Interrupts are latched, and arbitration is performed in the SIM at the start of interrupt processing. The arbitration result is a constant that the CPU uses to determine which vector to fetch. Once an interrupt is latched by the SIM, no other interrupt can take precedence, regardless of priority, until the latched interrupt is serviced (or the I bit is cleared). (See Figure 9-10.) FROM RESET BREAK I BIT SET? INTERRUPT? YES NO YES I-BIT SET? NO IRQ INTERRUPT? YES NO STACK CPU REGISTERS SET I-BIT LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR AS MANY INTERRUPTS AS EXIST ON CHIP FETCH NEXT INSTRUCTION SWI INSTRUCTION? YES NO RTI INSTRUCTION? YES UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS NO EXECUTE INSTRUCTION Figure 9-10. Interrupt Processing MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 143 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.6.1.1 Hardware Interrupts A hardware interrupt does not stop the current instruction. Processing of a hardware interrupt begins after completion of the current instruction. When the current instruction is complete, the SIM checks all pending hardware interrupts. If interrupts are not masked (I bit clear in the condition code register) and if the corresponding interrupt enable bit is set, the SIM proceeds with interrupt processing; otherwise, the next instruction is fetched and executed. If more than one interrupt is pending at the end of an instruction execution, the highest priority interrupt is serviced first. Figure 9-11 demonstrates what happens when two interrupts are pending. If an interrupt is pending upon exit from the original interrupt service routine, the pending interrupt is serviced before the LDA instruction is executed. CLI LDA #$FF INT1 BACKGROUND ROUTINE PSHH INT1 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE PULH RTI INT2 PSHH INT2 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE PULH RTI Figure 9-11. Interrupt Recognition Example The LDA opcode is prefetched by both the INT1 and INT2 RTI instructions. However, in the case of the INT1 RTI prefetch, this is a redundant operation. NOTE: To maintain compatibility with the M6805 Family, the H register is not pushed on the stack during interrupt entry. If the interrupt service routine modifies the H register or uses the indexed addressing mode, software should save the H register and then restore it prior to exiting the routine. Technical Data 144 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) Exception Control 9.6.1.2 SWI Instruction The SWI instruction is a non-maskable instruction that causes an interrupt regardless of the state of the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register. NOTE: A software interrupt pushes PC onto the stack. A software interrupt does not push PC – 1, as a hardware interrupt does. 9.6.1.3 Interrupt Status Registers The flags in the interrupt status registers identify maskable interrupt sources. Table 9-3 summarizes the interrupt sources and the interrupt status register flags that they set. The interrupt status registers can be useful for debugging. 9.6.1.4 Interrupt Status Register 1 Address: $FE04 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: IF6 IF5 IF4 IF3 IF2 IF1 0 0 Write: R R R R R R R R Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R = Reserved Figure 9-12. Interrupt Status Register 1 (INT1) IF6–IF1 — Interrupt Flags 6–1 These flags indicate the presence of interrupt requests from the sources shown in Table 9-3. 1 = Interrupt request present 0 = No interrupt request present Bit 0 and Bit 1 — Always read 0 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 145 System Integration Module (SIM) Table 9-3. Vector Addresses Priority INT Flag Lowest IF17 IF16 IF15 IF14 IF13 IF12 IF11 IF10 IF9 IF8 IF7 IF6 IF5 IF4 IF3 IF2 IF1 — Highest — Address Vector $FFDA Real Time Clock Vector (High) $FFDB Real Time Clock Vector (Low) $FFDC ADC Conversion Complete Vector (High) $FFDD ADC Conversion Complete Vector (Low) $FFDE Keyboard Vector (High) $FFDF Keyboard Vector (Low) $FFE0 SCI Transmit Vector (High) $FFE1 SCI Transmit Vector (Low) $FFE2 SCI Receive Vector (High) $FFE3 SCI Receive Vector (Low) $FFE4 SCI Error Vector (High) $FFE5 SCI Error Vector (Low) $FFE6 SPI Receive Vector (High) $FFE7 SPI Receive Vector (Low) $FFE8 SPI Transmit Vector (High) $FFE9 SPI Transmit Vector (Low) $FFEA TIM2 Overflow Vector (High) $FFEB TIM2 Overflow Vector (Low) $FFEC TIM2 Channel 1 Vector (High) $FFED TIM2 Channel 1 Vector (Low) $FFEE TIM2 Channel 0 Vector (High) $FFEF TIM2 Channel 0 Vector (Low) $FFF0 TIM1 Overflow Vector (High) $FFF1 TIM1 Overflow Vector (Low) $FFF2 TIM1 Channel 1 Vector (High) $FFF3 TIM1 Channel 1 Vector (Low) $FFF4 TIM1 Channel 0 Vector (High) $FFF5 TIM1 Channel 0 Vector (Low) $FFF6 PLL Vector (High) $FFF7 PLL Vector (Low) $FFF8 LVI Vector (High) $FFF9 LVI Vector (Low) $FFFA IRQ Vector (High) $FFFB IRQ Vector (Low) $FFFC SWI Vector (High) $FFFD SWI Vector (Low) $FFFE Reset Vector (High) $FFFF Reset Vector (Low) Technical Data 146 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) Exception Control 9.6.1.5 Interrupt Status Register 2 Address: $FE05 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: IF14 IF13 IF12 IF11 IF10 IF9 IF8 IF7 Write: R R R R R R R R Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R = Reserved Figure 9-13. Interrupt Status Register 2 (INT2) IF14–IF7 — Interrupt Flags 14–7 These flags indicate the presence of interrupt requests from the sources shown in Table 9-3. 1 = Interrupt request present 0 = No interrupt request present 9.6.1.6 Interrupt Status Register 3 Address: $FE06 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: 0 0 0 0 0 IF17 IF16 IF15 Write: R R R R R R R R Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R = Reserved Figure 9-14. Interrupt Status Register 3 (INT3) IF17–IF15 — Interrupt Flags 17–15 These flags indicate the presence of an interrupt request from the source shown in Table 9-3. 1 = Interrupt request present 0 = No interrupt request present MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 147 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.6.2 Reset All reset sources always have equal and highest priority and cannot be arbitrated. 9.6.3 Break Interrupts The break module can stop normal program flow at a softwareprogrammable break point by asserting its break interrupt output. (See Section 22. Break Module (BRK).) The SIM puts the CPU into the break state by forcing it to the SWI vector location. Refer to the break interrupt subsection of each module to see how each module is affected by the break state. 9.6.4 Status Flag Protection in Break Mode The SIM controls whether status flags contained in other modules can be cleared during break mode. The user can select whether flags are protected from being cleared by properly initializing the break clear flag enable bit (BCFE) in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR). Protecting flags in break mode ensures that set flags will not be cleared while in break mode. This protection allows registers to be freely read and written during break mode without losing status flag information. Setting the BCFE bit enables the clearing mechanisms. Once cleared in break mode, a flag remains cleared even when break mode is exited. Status flags with a 2-step clearing mechanism — for example, a read of one register followed by the read or write of another — are protected, even when the first step is accomplished prior to entering break mode. Upon leaving break mode, execution of the second step will clear the flag as normal. Technical Data 148 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) Low-Power Modes 9.7 Low-Power Modes Executing the WAIT or STOP instruction puts the MCU in a low powerconsumption mode for standby situations. The SIM holds the CPU in a non-clocked state. The operation of each of these modes is described in the following subsections. Both STOP and WAIT clear the interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register, allowing interrupts to occur. 9.7.1 Wait Mode In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive while the peripheral clocks continue to run. Figure 9-15 shows the timing for wait mode entry. A module that is active during wait mode can wake up the CPU with an interrupt if the interrupt is enabled. Stacking for the interrupt begins one cycle after the WAIT instruction during which the interrupt occurred. In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the module is active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode. Wait mode also can be exited by a reset or break. A break interrupt during wait mode sets the SIM break stop/wait bit, SBSW, in the SIM break status register (SBSR). If the COP disable bit, COPD, in the mask option register is logic 0, then the computer operating properly module (COP) is enabled and remains active in wait mode. IAB IDB WAIT ADDR WAIT ADDR + 1 PREVIOUS DATA SAME NEXT OPCODE SAME SAME SAME R/W NOTE: Previous data can be operand data or the WAIT opcode, depending on the last instruction. Figure 9-15. Wait Mode Entry Timing Figure 9-16 and Figure 9-17 show the timing for WAIT recovery. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 149 System Integration Module (SIM) IAB $6E0B IDB $A6 $6E0C $A6 $A6 $00FF $01 $0B $00FE $00FD $00FC $6E EXITSTOPWAIT NOTE: EXITSTOPWAIT = RST pin OR CPU interrupt OR break interrupt Figure 9-16. Wait Recovery from Interrupt or Break 32 CYCLES IAB IDB 32 CYCLES $6E0B $A6 $A6 RST VCT H RST VCT L $A6 RST ICLK Figure 9-17. Wait Recovery from Internal Reset 9.7.2 Stop Mode In stop mode, the SIM counter is reset and the system clocks are disabled. An interrupt request from a module can cause an exit from stop mode. Stacking for interrupts begins after the selected stop recovery time has elapsed. Reset or break also causes an exit from stop mode. The SIM disables the clock generator module output (CGMOUT) in stop mode, stopping the CPU and peripherals. Stop recovery time is selectable using the SSREC bit in the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1). If SSREC is set, stop recovery is reduced from the normal delay of 4096 ICLK cycles down to 32. This is ideal for applications using canned oscillators that do not require long start-up times from stop mode. NOTE: External crystal applications should use the full stop recovery time by clearing the SSREC bit. Technical Data 150 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) SIM Registers A break interrupt during stop mode sets the SIM break stop/wait bit (SBSW) in the SIM break status register (SBSR). The SIM counter is held in reset from the execution of the STOP instruction until the beginning of stop recovery. It is then used to time the recovery period. Figure 9-18 shows stop mode entry timing. NOTE: To minimize stop current, all pins configured as inputs should be driven to a logic 1 or logic 0. CPUSTOP IAB IDB STOP ADDR STOP ADDR + 1 PREVIOUS DATA SAME NEXT OPCODE SAME SAME SAME R/W NOTE: Previous data can be operand data or the STOP opcode, depending on the last instruction. Figure 9-18. Stop Mode Entry Timing STOP RECOVERY PERIOD ICLK INT/BREAK IAB STOP +1 STOP + 2 STOP + 2 SP SP – 1 SP – 2 SP – 3 Figure 9-19. Stop Mode Recovery from Interrupt or Break 9.8 SIM Registers The SIM has three memory-mapped registers: • SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) — $FE00 • SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) — $FE01 • SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) — $FE03 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 151 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.8.1 SIM Break Status Register The SIM break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break caused an exit from stop mode or wait mode. Address: $FE00 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 R R R R R R Read: 1 Bit 0 SBSW R Write: Note Reset: 0 Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW. R = Reserved Figure 9-20. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) SBSW — Break Wait Bit This status bit is set when a break interrupt causes an exit from wait mode or stop mode. Clear SBSW by writing a logic 0 to it. Reset clears SBSW. 1 = Stop mode or wait mode was exited by break interrupt 0 = Stop mode or wait mode was not exited by break interrupt SBSW can be read within the break interrupt routine. The user can modify the return address on the stack by subtracting 1 from it. The following code is an example. This code works if the H register has been pushed onto the stack in the break service routine software. This code should be executed at the end of the break service routine software. HIBYTE EQU LOBYTE EQU If not SBSW, do RTI BRCLR SBSW,SBSR, RETURN ; See if wait mode or stop mode was exited by ; break. TST LOBYTE,SP ;If RETURNLO is not zero, BNE DOLO ;then just decrement low byte. DEC HIBYTE,SP ;Else deal with high byte, too. DOLO DEC LOBYTE,SP ;Point to WAIT/STOP opcode. RETURN PULH RTI ;Restore H register. Technical Data 152 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA System Integration Module (SIM) SIM Registers 9.8.2 SIM Reset Status Register This register contains six flags that show the source of the last reset provided all previous reset status bits have been cleared. Clear the SIM reset status register by reading it. A power-on reset sets the POR bit and clears all other bits in the register. Address: Read: $FE01 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 POR PIN COP ILOP ILAD 0 LVI 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: = Unimplemented Figure 9-21. SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) POR — Power-On Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by POR circuit 0 = Read of SRSR PIN — External Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by external reset pin (RST) 0 = POR or read of SRSR COP — Computer Operating Properly Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by COP counter 0 = POR or read of SRSR ILOP — Illegal Opcode Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by an illegal opcode 0 = POR or read of SRSR ILAD — Illegal Address Reset Bit (opcode fetches only) 1 = Last reset caused by an opcode fetch from an illegal address 0 = POR or read of SRSR LVI — Low-Voltage Inhibit Reset Bit 1 = Last reset caused by the LVI circuit 0 = POR or read of SRSR MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data System Integration Module (SIM) 153 System Integration Module (SIM) 9.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register The SIM break control register contains a bit that enables software to clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state. Address: $FE03 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 BCFE R R R R R R R Read: Write: Reset: 0 R = Reserved Figure 9-22. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set. 1 = Status bits clearable during break 0 = Status bits not clearable during break Technical Data 154 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 System Integration Module (SIM) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON) 10.1 Contents 10.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 10.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156 10.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 10.4.2 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163 10.4.3 Break Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163 10.4.4 Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 10.4.5 Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 10.5 Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 10.6 ROM-Resident Routines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171 10.6.1 PRGRNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 10.6.2 ERARNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175 10.6.3 LDRNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176 10.6.4 MON_PRGRNGE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 10.6.5 MON_ERARNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 10.6.6 MON_LDRNGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .179 10.6.7 EE_WRITE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180 10.6.8 EE_READ. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 155 Monitor ROM (MON) 10.2 Introduction This section describes the monitor ROM (MON) and the monitor mode entry methods. The monitor ROM allows complete testing of the MCU through a single-wire interface with a host computer. Monitor mode entry can be achieved without use of the higher test voltage, VTST, as long as vector addresses $FFFE and $FFFF are blank, thus reducing the hardware requirements for in-circuit programming. In addition, to simply user coding, routines are also stored in the monitor ROM area for FLASH memory program /erase and EEPROM emulation. 10.3 Features Features of the monitor ROM include: • Normal user-mode pin functionality • One pin dedicated to serial communication between monitor ROM and host computer • Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) communication with host computer • Execution of code in RAM or FLASH • FLASH memory security feature1 • FLASH memory programming interface • Enhanced PLL (phase-locked loop) option to allow use of external 32.768-kHz crystal to generate internal frequency of 2.4576 MHz • 960 bytes monitor ROM code size ($FC00–$FDFF and $FE10–$FFCE) • Monitor mode entry without high voltage, VTST, if reset vector is blank ($FFFE and $FFFF contain $FF) • Standard monitor mode entry if high voltage, VTST, is applied to IRQ • Resident routines for in-circuit programming and EEPROM emulation 1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading or copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users. Technical Data 156 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) Functional Description 10.4 Functional Description The monitor ROM receives and executes commands from a host computer. Figure 10-1 shows an example circuit used to enter monitor mode and communicate with a host computer via a standard RS-232 interface. Simple monitor commands can access any memory address. In monitor mode, the MCU can execute code downloaded into RAM by a host computer while most MCU pins retain normal operating mode functions. All communication between the host computer and the MCU is through the PTA0 pin. A level-shifting and multiplexing interface is required between PTA0 and the host computer. PTA0 is used in a wired-OR configuration and requires a pullup resistor. The monitor code allows enabling the PLL to generate the internal clock, provided the reset vector is blank, when the device is being clocked by a low-frequency crystal. This entry method, which is enabled when IRQ is held low out of reset, is intended to support serial communication/ programming at 9600 baud in monitor mode by stepping up the external frequency (assumed to be 32.768 kHz) by a fixed amount to generate the desired internal frequency (2.4576 MHz). Since this feature is enabled only when IRQ is held low out of reset, it cannot be used when the reset vector is non-zero because entry into monitor mode in this case requires VTST on IRQ. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 157 Monitor ROM (MON) 68HC908LJ12 RST 0.1 µF VTST (SEE NOTE 3) RESET VECTORS $FFFE 10 kΩ (SEE NOTES 2 AND 3) C SW2 0.033 µF SW3 (SEE NOTE 2) C + 3 MC145407 + D 10 MΩ 10 µF 10 µF 18 C 32.768 kHz XTAL 4 10 µF 17 330 kΩ + + 2 19 DB-25 2 5 16 3 6 15 10 µF VDD 0.01 µF CGMXFC 10 kΩ 6–30 pF 20 IRQ D EXTERNAL OSCILLATOR MUST BE USED FOR MONITOR MODE ENTRY WHEN IRQ = VTST 1 $FFFF OSC1 OSC2 SW4 (SEE NOTE 2) VSS D 6–30 pF VREFL VDD VDD VDDA VREFH 0.1 µF 7 VDD 1 MC74HC125 2 3 6 5 4 VDD 14 10 kΩ PTA0 PTC1 VDD VDD 7 A (SEE NOTE 1) SW1 B PTA1 PTA2 Notes: 1. For monitor mode entry when IRQ = VTST: SW1: Position A — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 4 or CGMPCLK ÷ 4 SW1: Position B — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 2 2. SW2, SW3, and SW4: Position C — Enter monitor mode using external oscillator. SW2, SW3, and SW4: Position D — Enter monitor mode using external XTAL and internal PLL. 3. See 23.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics for IRQ voltage level requirements. Figure 10-1. Monitor Mode Circuit Technical Data 158 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) Functional Description 10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode Table 10-1 shows the pin conditions for entering monitor mode. As specified in the table, monitor mode may be entered after a POR and will allow communication at 9600 baud provided one of the following sets of conditions is met: 1. If $FFFE and $FFFF do not contain $FF (programmed state): – The external clock is 4.9152 MHz with PTC1 low or 9.8304 MHz with PTC1 high – IRQ = VTST (PLL off) 2. If $FFFE and $FFFF both contain $FF (erased state): – The external clock is 9.8304 MHz – IRQ = VDD (this can be implemented through the internal IRQ pullup; PLL off) 3. If $FFFE and $FFFF both contain $FF (erased state): – The external clock is 32.768 kHz (crystal) – IRQ = VSS (this setting initiates the PLL to boost the external 32.768 kHz to an internal bus frequency of 2.4576 MHz) If VTST is applied to IRQ and PTC1 is low upon monitor mode entry (above condition set 1), the bus frequency is a divide-by-two of the input clock. If PTC1 is high with VTST applied to IRQ upon monitor mode entry, the bus frequency will be a divide-by-four of the input clock. Holding the PTC1 pin low when entering monitor mode causes a bypass of a divideby-two stage at the oscillator only if VTST is applied to IRQ. In this event, the CGMOUT frequency is equal to the CGMXCLK frequency, and the OSC1 input directly generates internal bus clocks. In this case, the OSC1 signal must have a 50% duty cycle at maximum bus frequency. If entering monitor mode without high voltage on IRQ (above condition set 2 or 3, where applied voltage is either VDD or VSS), then all port A pin requirements and conditions, including the PTC1 frequency divisor selection, are not in effect. This is to reduce circuit requirements when performing in-circuit programming. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 159 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 IRQ RST Address $FFFE/ $FFFF PTA2 PTA1 PTA0(1) PTC1 External Clock(2) Bus Frequency PLL COP Baud Rate X GND X X X X X X 0 X Disabled 0 No operation until reset goes high VTST(3) VDD or VTST X 0 1 1 0 4.9152 MHz 2.4576 MHz OFF Disabled 9600 PTA1 and PTA2 voltages only required if IRQ = VTST; PTC1 determines frequency divider VTST(3) VDD or VTST X 0 1 1 1 9.8304 MHz 2.4576 MHz OFF Disabled 9600 PTA1 and PTA2 voltages only required if IRQ = VTST; PTC1 determines frequency divider VDD VDD Blank "$FFFF" X X 1 X 9.8304 MHz 2.4576 MHz OFF Disabled 9600 External frequency always divided by 4 GND VDD Blank "$FFFF" X X 1 X 32.768 kHz 2.4576 MHz ON Disabled 9600 PLL enabled (BCS set) in monitor code VDD or GND VTST Blank "$FFFF" X X X X X — OFF Enabled — Enters user mode — will encounter an illegal address reset VDD or GND VDD or VTST Not Blank X X X X X — OFF Enabled — Enters user mode Comment Notes: 1. PTA0 = 1 if serial communication; PTA0 = 0 if parallel communication 2. External clock is derived by a 32.768 kHz crystal or a 4.9152/9.8304 MHz off-chip oscillator 3. Monitor mode entry by IRQ = VTST, a 4.9152/9.8304 MHz off-chip oscillator must be used. The MCU internal crystal oscillator circuit is bypassed. Monitor ROM (MON) Technical Data 160 Table 10-1. Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options Monitor ROM (MON) Functional Description NOTE: If the reset vector is blank and monitor mode is entered, the chip will see an additional reset cycle after the initial POR reset. Once the part has been programmed, the traditional method of applying a voltage, VTST, to IRQ must be used to enter monitor mode. The COP module is disabled in monitor mode based on these conditions: • If monitor mode was entered as a result of the reset vector being blank (above condition set 2 or 3), the COP is always disabled regardless of the state of IRQ or RST. • If monitor mode was entered with VTST on IRQ (condition set 1), then the COP is disabled as long as VTST is applied to either IRQ or RST. The second condition states that as long as VTST is maintained on the IRQ pin after entering monitor mode, or if VTST is applied to RST after the initial reset to get into monitor mode (when VTST was applied to IRQ), then the COP will be disabled. In the latter situation, after VTST is applied to the RST pin, VTST can be removed from the IRQ pin in the interest of freeing the IRQ for normal functionality in monitor mode. Figure 10-2 shows a simplified diagram of the monitor mode entry when the reset vector is blank and just 1 × VDD voltage is applied to the IRQ pin. An external oscillator of 9.8304 MHz is required for a baud rate of 9600, as the internal bus frequency is automatically set to the external frequency divided by four. Enter monitor mode with pin configuration shown in Figure 10-1 by pulling RST low and then high. The rising edge of RST latches monitor mode. Once monitor mode is latched, the values on the specified pins can change. Once out of reset, the MCU waits for the host to send eight security bytes. (See 10.5 Security.) After the security bytes, the MCU sends a break signal (10 consecutive logic 0s) to the host, indicating that it is ready to receive a command. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 161 Monitor ROM (MON) POR RESET IS VECTOR BLANK? NO NORMAL USER MODE YES MONITOR MODE EXECUTE MONITOR CODE POR TRIGGERED? NO YES Figure 10-2. Low-Voltage Monitor Mode Entry Flowchart In monitor mode, the MCU uses different vectors for reset, SWI (software interrupt), and break interrupt than those for user mode. The alternate vectors are in the $FE page instead of the $FF page and allow code execution from the internal monitor firmware instead of user code. NOTE: Exiting monitor mode after it has been initiated by having a blank reset vector requires a power-on reset (POR). Pulling RST low will not exit monitor mode in this situation. Table 10-2 summarizes the differences between user mode and monitor mode vectors. Table 10-2. Mode Differences (Vectors) Functions Modes Reset Vector High Reset Vector Low Break Vector High Break Vector Low SWI Vector High SWI Vector Low User $FFFE $FFFF $FFFC $FFFD $FFFC $FFFD Monitor $FEFE $FEFF $FEFC $FEFD $FEFC $FEFD Technical Data 162 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) Functional Description 10.4.2 Data Format Communication with the monitor ROM is in standard non-return-to-zero (NRZ) mark/space data format. Transmit and receive baud rates must be identical. START BIT BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 5 BIT 6 NEXT START STOP BIT BIT BIT 7 Figure 10-3. Monitor Data Format 10.4.3 Break Signal A start bit (logic 0) followed by nine logic 0 bits is a break signal. When the monitor receives a break signal, it drives the PTA0 pin high for the duration of two bits and then echoes back the break signal. MISSING STOP BIT 2-STOP BIT DELAY BEFORE ZERO ECHO 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Figure 10-4. Break Transaction 10.4.4 Baud Rate The communication baud rate is controlled by the crystal frequency and the state of the PTC1 pin (when IRQ is set to VTST) upon entry into monitor mode. When PTC1 is high, the divide by ratio is 1024. If the PTC1 pin is at logic 0 upon entry into monitor mode, the divide by ratio is 512. If monitor mode was entered with VDD on IRQ, then the divide by ratio is set at 1024, regardless of PTC1. If monitor mode was entered with VSS on IRQ, then the internal PLL steps up the external frequency, presumed to be 32.768 kHz, to 2.4576 MHz. These latter two conditions for monitor mode entry require that the reset vector is blank. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 163 Monitor ROM (MON) Table 10-3 lists external frequencies required to achieve a standard baud rate of 9600 BPS. Other standard baud rates can be accomplished using proportionally higher or lower frequency generators. If using a crystal as the clock source, be aware of the upper frequency limit that the internal clock module can handle. See Section 23. Electrical Specifications for this limit. Table 10-3. Monitor Baud Rate Selection External Frequency IRQ PTC1 Internal Frequency Baud Rate (BPS) 4.9152 MHz VTST 0 2.4576 MHz 9600 9.8304 MHz VTST 1 2.4576 MHz 9600 9.8304 MHz VDD X 2.4576 MHz 9600 32.768 kHz VSS X 2.4576 MHz 9600 10.4.5 Commands The monitor ROM firmware uses these commands: • READ (read memory) • WRITE (write memory) • IREAD (indexed read) • IWRITE (indexed write) • READSP (read stack pointer) • RUN (run user program) The monitor ROM firmware echoes each received byte back to the PTA0 pin for error checking. An 11-bit delay at the end of each command allows the host to send a break character to cancel the command. A delay of two bit times occurs before each echo and before READ, IREAD, or READSP data is returned. The data returned by a read command appears after the echo of the last byte of the command. NOTE: Wait one bit time after each echo before sending the next byte. Technical Data 164 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) Functional Description FROM HOST READ 4 ADDRESS HIGH READ 4 1 ADDRESS HIGH 1 ADDRESS LOW 4 ADDRESS LOW DATA 1 3, 2 4 ECHO RETURN Notes: 1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times 2 = Data return delay, 2 bit times 3 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times 4 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte. Figure 10-5. Read Transaction FROM HOST WRITE 3 ADDRESS HIGH WRITE 1 3 ADDRESS HIGH 1 ADDRESS LOW 3 ADDRESS LOW 1 DATA DATA 3 1 2, 3 ECHO Notes: 1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times 2 = Cancel command delay, 11 bit times 3 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte. Figure 10-6. Write Transaction A brief description of each monitor mode command is given in Table 10-4 through Table 10-9. Table 10-4. READ (Read Memory) Command Description Read byte from memory Operand 2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order Data Returned Returns contents of specified address Opcode $4A Command Sequence SENT TO MONITOR READ READ ADDRESS HIGH ADDRESS HIGH ECHO ADDRESS LOW DATA RETURN MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA ADDRESS LOW Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 165 Monitor ROM (MON) Table 10-5. WRITE (Write Memory) Command Description Write byte to memory Operand 2-byte address in high-byte:low-byte order; low byte followed by data byte Data Returned None Opcode $49 Command Sequence FROM HOST WRITE ADDRESS HIGH WRITE ADDRESS HIGH ADDRESS LOW ADDRESS LOW DATA DATA ECHO Table 10-6. IREAD (Indexed Read) Command Description Read next 2 bytes in memory from last address accessed Operand 2-byte address in high byte:low byte order Data Returned Returns contents of next two addresses Opcode $1A Command Sequence FROM HOST IREAD IREAD ECHO Technical Data 166 DATA DATA RETURN MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) Functional Description Table 10-7. IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command Description Write to last address accessed + 1 Operand Single data byte Data Returned None Opcode $19 Command Sequence FROM HOST IWRITE IWRITE DATA DATA ECHO A sequence of IREAD or IWRITE commands can access a block of memory sequentially over the full 64k-byte memory map. Table 10-8. READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command Description Reads stack pointer Operand None Data Returned Returns incremented stack pointer value (SP + 1) in high-byte:low-byte order Opcode $0C Command Sequence FROM HOST READSP READSP ECHO MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA SP HIGH SP LOW RETURN Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 167 Monitor ROM (MON) Table 10-9. RUN (Run User Program) Command Description Executes PULH and RTI instructions Operand None Data Returned None Opcode $28 Command Sequence FROM HOST RUN RUN ECHO The MCU executes the SWI and PSHH instructions when it enters monitor mode. The RUN command tells the MCU to execute the PULH and RTI instructions. Before sending the RUN command, the host can modify the stacked CPU registers to prepare to run the host program. The READSP command returns the incremented stack pointer value, SP + 1. The high and low bytes of the program counter are at addresses SP + 5 and SP + 6. SP HIGH BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER SP + 1 CONDITION CODE REGISTER SP + 2 ACCUMULATOR SP + 3 LOW BYTE OF INDEX REGISTER SP + 4 HIGH BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER SP + 5 LOW BYTE OF PROGRAM COUNTER SP + 6 SP + 7 Figure 10-7. Stack Pointer at Monitor Mode Entry Technical Data 168 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) Security 10.5 Security A security feature discourages unauthorized reading of FLASH locations while in monitor mode. The host can bypass the security feature at monitor mode entry by sending eight security bytes that match the bytes at locations $FFF6–$FFFD. Locations $FFF6–$FFFD contain userdefined data. NOTE: Do not leave locations $FFF6–$FFFD blank. For security reasons, program locations $FFF6–$FFFD even if they are not used for vectors. During monitor mode entry, the MCU waits after the power-on reset for the host to send the eight security bytes on pin PTA0. If the received bytes match those at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host bypasses the security feature and can read all FLASH locations and execute code from FLASH. Security remains bypassed until a power-on reset occurs. If the reset was not a power-on reset, security remains bypassed and security code entry is not required. (See Figure 10-8.) VDD 4096 + 32 ICLK CYCLES RST COMMAND BYTE 8 BYTE 2 BYTE 1 256 BUS CYCLES (MINIMUM) FROM HOST PTA0 4 BREAK 2 1 COMMAND ECHO NOTES: 1 = Echo delay, 2 bit times. 2 = Data return delay, 2 bit times. 4 = Wait 1 bit time before sending next byte. 1 BYTE 8 ECHO BYTE 1 ECHO FROM MCU 1 BYTE 2 ECHO 4 1 Figure 10-8. Monitor Mode Entry Timing MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 169 Monitor ROM (MON) Upon power-on reset, if the received bytes of the security code do not match the data at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host fails to bypass the security feature. The MCU remains in monitor mode, but reading a FLASH location returns an invalid value and trying to execute code from FLASH causes an illegal address reset. After receiving the eight security bytes from the host, the MCU transmits a break character, signifying that it is ready to receive a command. NOTE: The MCU does not transmit a break character until after the host sends the eight security bits. To determine whether the security code entered is correct, check to see if bit 6 of RAM address $40 is set. If it is, then the correct security code has been entered and FLASH can be accessed. If the security sequence fails, the device should be reset by a power-on reset and brought up in monitor mode to attempt another entry. After failing the security sequence, the FLASH module can also be mass erased by executing an erase routine that was downloaded into internal RAM. The mass erase operation clears the security code locations so that all eight security bytes become $FF (blank). Technical Data 170 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) ROM-Resident Routines 10.6 ROM-Resident Routines Eight routines stored in the monitor ROM area (thus ROM-resident) are provided for FLASH memory manipulation. Six of the eight routines are intended to simply FLASH program, erase, and load operations. The other two routines are intended to simply the use of the FLASH memory as EEPROM. Table 10-10 shows a summary of the ROM-resident routines. Table 10-10. Summary of ROM-Resident Routines Routine Name Routine Description Call Address Stack Used (bytes) PRGRNGE Program a range of locations $FC06 14 ERARNGE Erase a page or the entire array $FCBE 9 Loads data from a range of locations $FF30 9 MON_PRGRNGE Program a range of locations in monitor mode $FF28 16 MON_ERARNGE Erase a page or the entire array in monitor mode $FF2C 11 MON_LDRNGE Loads data from a range of locations in monitor mode $FF24 11 EE_WRITE Emulated EEPROM write. Data size ranges from 2 to 15 bytes at a time. $FC00 17 EE_READ Emulated EEPROM read. Data size ranges from 2 to 15 bytes at a time. $FC03 15 LDRNGE The routines are designed to be called as stand-alone subroutines in the user program or monitor mode. The parameters that are passed to a routine are in the form of a contiguous data block, stored in RAM. The index register (H:X) is loaded with the address of the first byte of the data block (acting as a pointer), and the subroutine is called (JSR). Using the start address as a pointer, multiple data blocks can be used, any area of RAM be used. A data block has the control and data bytes in a defined order, as shown in Figure 10-9. During the software execution, it does not consume any dedicated RAM location, the run-time heap will extend the system stack, all other RAM location will not be affected. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 171 Monitor ROM (MON) R FILE_PTR $XXXX A M BUS SPEED (BUS_SPD) ADDRESS AS POINTER DATA SIZE (DATASIZE) START ADDRESS HIGH (ADDRH) START ADDRESS LOW (ADDRL) DATA 0 DATA BLOCK DATA 1 DATA ARRAY DATA N Figure 10-9. Data Block Format for ROM-Resident Routines The control and data bytes are described below. • Bus speed — This one byte indicates the operating bus speed of the MCU. The value of this byte should be equal to 4 times the bus speed. E.g., for a 4MHz bus, the value is 16 ($10). This control byte is useful where the MCU clock source is switched between the PLL clock and the crystal clock. • Data size — This one byte indicates the number of bytes in the data array that are to be manipulated. The maximum data array size is 255. Routines EE_WRITE and EE_READ are restricted to manipulate a data array between 2 to 15 bytes. Whereas routines ERARNGE and MON_ERARNGE do not manipulate a data array, thus, this data size byte has no meaning. • Start address — These two bytes, high byte followed by low byte, indicate the start address of the FLASH memory to be manipulated. • Data array — This data array contains data that are to be manipulated. Data in this array are programmed to FLASH memory by the programming routines: PRGRNGE, MON_PRGRNGE, EE_WRITE. For the read routines: LDRNGE, MON_LDRNGE, and EE_READ, data is read from FLASH and stored in this array. Technical Data 172 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) ROM-Resident Routines 10.6.1 PRGRNGE PRGRNGE is used to program a range of FLASH locations with data loaded into the data array. Table 10-11. PRGRNGE Routine Routine Name PRGRNGE Routine Description Program a range of locations Calling Address $FC06 Stack Used 14 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed (BUS_SPD) Data size (DATASIZE) Start address high (ADDRH) Start address (ADDRL) Data 1 (DATA1) : Data N (DATAN) The start location of the FLASH to be programmed is specified by the address ADDRH:ADDRL and the number of bytes from this location is specified by DATASIZE. The maximum number of bytes that can be programmed in one routine call is 255 bytes (max. DATASIZE is 255). ADDRH:ADDRL do not need to be at a page boundary, the routine handles any boundary misalignment during programming. A check to see that all bytes in the specified range are erased is not performed by this routine prior programming. Nor does this routine do a verification after programming, so there is no return confirmation that programming was successful. User must assure that the range specified is first erased. The coding example below is to program 64 bytes of data starting at FLASH location $EF00, with a bus speed of 4.9152 MHz. The coding assumes the data block is already loaded in RAM, with the address pointer, FILE_PTR, pointing to the first byte of the data block. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 173 Monitor ROM (MON) ORG RAM : FILE_PTR: BUS_SPD DATASIZE START_ADDR DATAARRAY DS.B DS.B DS.W DS.B 1 1 1 64 PRGRNGE FLASH_START EQU EQU $FC06 $EF00 ; ; ; ; Indicates 4x bus frequency Data size to be programmed FLASH start address Reserved data array ORG FLASH INITIALISATION: MOV #20, BUS_SPD MOV #64, DATASIZE LDHX #FLASH_START STHX START_ADDR RTS MAIN: BSR INITIALISATION : : LDHX FILE_PTR JSR PRGRNGE Technical Data 174 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) ROM-Resident Routines 10.6.2 ERARNGE ERARNGE is used to erase a range of locations in FLASH. Table 10-12. ERARNGE Routine Routine Name ERARNGE Routine Description Erase a page or the entire array Calling Address $FCBE Stack Used 9 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed (BUS_SPD) Data size (DATASIZE) Starting address (ADDRH) Starting address (ADDRL) There are two sizes of erase ranges: a page or the entire array. The ERARNGE will erase the page (128 consecutive bytes) in FLASH specified by the address ADDRH:ADDRL. This address can be any address within the page. Calling ERARNGE with ADDRH:ADDRL equal to $FFFF will erase the entire FLASH array (mass erase). Therefore, care must be taken when calling this routine to prevent an accidental mass erase. The ERARNGE routine do not use a data array. The DATASIZE byte is a dummy byte that is also not used. The coding example below is to perform a page erase, from $EF00–$EF7F. The Initialization subroutine is the same as the coding example for PRGRNGE (see 10.6.1 PRGRNGE). ERARNGE MAIN: EQU BSR : : LDHX JSR : $FCBE INITIALISATION FILE_PTR ERARNGE MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 175 Monitor ROM (MON) 10.6.3 LDRNGE LDRNGE is used to load the data array in RAM with data from a range of FLASH locations. Table 10-13. LDRNGE Routine Routine Name LDRNGE Routine Description Loads data from a range of locations Calling Address $FF30 Stack Used 9 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed (BUS_SPD) Data size (DATASIZE) Starting address (ADDRH) Starting address (ADDRL) Data 1 : Data N The start location of FLASH from where data is retrieved is specified by the address ADDRH:ADDRL and the number of bytes from this location is specified by DATASIZE. The maximum number of bytes that can be retrieved in one routine call is 255 bytes. The data retrieved from FLASH is loaded into the data array in RAM. Previous data in the data array will be overwritten. User can use this routine to retrieve data from FLASH that was previously programmed. The coding example below is to retrieve 64 bytes of data starting from $EF00 in FLASH. The Initialization subroutine is the same as the coding example for PRGRNGE (see 10.6.1 PRGRNGE). LDRNGE MAIN: EQU BSR : : LDHX JSR : $FF30 INITIALIZATION FILE_PTR LDRNGE Technical Data 176 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) ROM-Resident Routines 10.6.4 MON_PRGRNGE In monitor mode, MON_PRGRNGE is used to program a range of FLASH locations with data loaded into the data array. Table 10-14. MON_PRGRNGE Routine Routine Name MON_PRGRNGE Routine Description Program a range of locations, in monitor mode Calling Address $FC28 Stack Used 16 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed Data size Starting address (high byte) Starting address (low byte) Data 1 : Data N The MON_PRGRNGE routine is designed to be used in monitor mode. It performs the same function as the PRGRNGE routine (see 10.6.1 PRGRNGE), except that MON_PRGRNGE returns to the main program via an SWI instruction. After a MON_PRGRNGE call, the SWI instruction will return the control back to the monitor code. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 177 Monitor ROM (MON) 10.6.5 MON_ERARNGE In monitor mode, ERARNGE is used to erase a range of locations in FLASH. Table 10-15. MON_ERARNGE Routine Routine Name MON_ERARNGE Routine Description Erase a page or the entire array, in monitor mode Calling Address $FF2C Stack Used 11 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed Data size Starting address (high byte) Starting address (low byte) The MON_ERARNGE routine is designed to be used in monitor mode. It performs the same function as the ERARNGE routine (see 10.6.2 ERARNGE), except that MON_ERARNGE returns to the main program via an SWI instruction. After a MON_ERARNGE call, the SWI instruction will return the control back to the monitor code. Technical Data 178 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) ROM-Resident Routines 10.6.6 MON_LDRNGE In monitor mode, LDRNGE is used to load the data array in RAM with data from a range of FLASH locations. Table 10-16. ICP_LDRNGE Routine Routine Name MON_LDRNGE Routine Description Loads data from a range of locations, in monitor mode Calling Address $FF24 Stack Used 11 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed Data size Starting address (high byte) Starting address (low byte) Data 1 : Data N The MON_LDRNGE routine is designed to be used in monitor mode. It performs the same function as the LDRNGE routine (see 10.6.3 LDRNGE), except that MON_LDRNGE returns to the main program via an SWI instruction. After a MON_LDRNGE call, the SWI instruction will return the control back to the monitor code. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 179 Monitor ROM (MON) 10.6.7 EE_WRITE EE_WRITE is used to write a set of data from the data array to FLASH. Table 10-17. EE_WRITE Routine Routine Name EE_WRITE Routine Description Emulated EEPROM write. Data size ranges from 2 to 15 bytes at a time. Calling Address $FC00 Stack Used 17 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed (BUS_SPD) Data size (DATASIZE)(1) Starting address (ADDRH)(2) Starting address (ADDRL)(1) Data 1 : Data N Notes: 1. The minimum data size is 2 bytes. The maximum data size is 15 bytes. 2. The start address must be a page boundary start address, e.g. $xx00 or $xx80. The start location of the FLASH to be programmed is specified by the address ADDRH:ADDRL and the number of bytes in the data array is specified by DATASIZE. The minimum number of bytes that can be programmed in one routine call is 2 bytes, the maximum is 15 bytes. ADDRH:ADDRL must always be the start of boundary address (the page start address: $XX00 or $0080) and DATASIZE must be the same size when accessing the same page. In some applications, the user may want to repeatedly store and read a set of data from an area of non-volatile memory. This is easily possible when using an EEPROM array. As the write and erase operations can be executed on a byte basis. For FLASH memory, the minimum erase size is the page — 128 bytes per page for MC68HC908LJ12. If the data array size is less than the page size, writing and erasing to the same page cannot fully utilize the page. Unused locations in the page will be wasted. The EE_WRITE routine is designed to emulate the properties similar to the EEPROM. Allowing a more efficient use of the FLASH page for data storage. Technical Data 180 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) ROM-Resident Routines When the user dedicates a page of FLASH for data storage, and the size of the data array defined, each call of the EE_WRTIE routine will automatically transfer the data in the data array (in RAM) to the next blank block of locations in the FLASH page. Once a page is filled up, the EE_WRITE routine automatically erases the page, and starts reuse the page again. In the 128-byte page, an 8-byte control block is used by the routine to monitor the utilization of the page. In effect, only 120 bytes are used for data storage. (see Figure 10-10). The page control operations are transparent to the user. F L A S H PAGE BOUNDARY CONTROL: 8 BYTES $XX00 OR $XX80 DATA ARRAY DATA ARRAY DATA ARRAY ONE PAGE = 128 BYTES PAGE BOUNDARY Figure 10-10. EE_WRITE FLASH Memory Usage When using this routine to store a 2-byte data array, the FLASH page can be programmed 60 times before the an erase is required. In effect, the write/erase endurance is increased by 60 times. When a 15-byte data array is used, the write/erase endurance is increased by 8 times. Due to the FLASH page size limitation, the data array is limited from 2 bytes to 15 bytes. The coding example below uses the $EF00–$EE7F page for data storage. The data array size is 15 bytes, and the bus speed is 4.9152 MHz. The coding assumes the data block is already loaded in RAM, with the address pointer, FILE_PTR, pointing to the first byte of the data block. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 181 Monitor ROM (MON) ORG RAM : FILE_PTR: BUS_SPD DATASIZE START_ADDR DATAARRAY DS.B DS.B DS.W DS.B 1 1 1 15 EE_WRITE FLASH_START EQU EQU $FC00 $EF00 ; ; ; ; Indicates 4x bus frequency Data size to be programmed FLASH starting address Reserved data array ORG FLASH INITIALISATION: MOV #20, BUS_SPD MOV #15, DATASIZE LDHX #FLASH_START STHX START_ADDR RTS MAIN: BSR INITIALISATION : : LHDX FILE_PTR JSR EE_WRITE NOTE: The EE_WRITE routine is unable to check for incorrect data blocks, such as the FLASH page boundary address and data size. It is the responsibility of the user to ensure the starting address indicated in the data block is at the FLASH page boundary and the data size is 2 to 15. If the FLASH page is already programmed with a data array with a different size, the EE_WRITE call will be ignored. Technical Data 182 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Monitor ROM (MON) ROM-Resident Routines 10.6.8 EE_READ EE_READ is used to load the data array in RAM with a set of data from FLASH. Table 10-18. EE_READ Routine Routine Name EE_READ Routine Description Emulated EEPROM read. Data size ranges from 2 to 15 bytes at a time. Calling Address $FC03 Stack Used 15 bytes Data Block Format Bus speed (BUS_SPD) Data size (DATASIZE) Starting address (ADDRH)(1) Starting address (ADDRL)(1) Data 1 : Data N Notes: 1. The start address must be a page boundary start address, e.g. $xx00 or $xx80. The EE_READ routine reads data stored by the EE_WRITE routine. An EE_READ call will retrieve the last data written to a FLASH page and loaded into the data array in RAM. Same as EE_WRITE, the data size indicated by DATASIZE is 2 to 15, and the start address ADDRH:ADDRL must the FLASH page boundary address. The coding example below uses the data stored by the EE_WRITE coding example (see 10.6.7 EE_WRITE). It loads the 15-byte data set stored in the $EF00–$EE7F page to the data array in RAM. The initialization subroutine is the same as the coding example for EE_WRITE (see 10.6.7 EE_WRITE). EE_READ EQU $FC03 MAIN: BSR : : LDHX JSR : INITIALIZATION FILE_PTR EE_READ MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Monitor ROM (MON) 183 Monitor ROM (MON) NOTE: The EE_READ routine is unable to check for incorrect data blocks, such as the FLASH page boundary address and data size. It is the responsibility of the user to ensure the starting address indicated in the data block is at the FLASH page boundary and the data size is 2 to 15. If the FLASH page is programmed with a data array with a different size, the EE_READ call will be ignored. Technical Data 184 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Monitor ROM (MON) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.1 Contents 11.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 11.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 11.4 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 11.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 11.5.1 TIM Counter Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 11.5.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 11.5.3 Output Compare. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 11.5.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 11.5.3.2 Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 11.5.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 11.5.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 11.5.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 11.5.4.3 PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 11.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197 11.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197 11.7.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 11.7.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 11.8 TIM During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198 11.9 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 11.10 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 11.10.1 TIM Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 11.10.2 TIM Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 11.10.3 TIM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 11.10.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . .204 11.10.5 TIM Channel Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 185 Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.2 Introduction This section describes the timer interface (TIM) module. The TIM is a two-channel timer that provides a timing reference with input capture, output compare, and pulse-width-modulation functions. Figure 11-1 is a block diagram of the TIM. This particular MCU has two timer interface modules which are denoted as TIM1 and TIM2. 11.3 Features Features of the TIM include: • Two input capture/output compare channels: – Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger – Set, clear, or toggle output compare action • Buffered and unbuffered pulse-width-modulation (PWM) signal generation • Programmable TIM clock input with 7-frequency internal bus clock prescaler selection • Free-running or modulo up-count operation • Toggle any channel pin on overflow • TIM counter stop and reset bits Technical Data 186 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) Pin Name Conventions 11.4 Pin Name Conventions The text that follows describes both timers, TIM1 and TIM2. The TIM input/output (I/O) pin names are T[1,2]CH0 (timer channel 0) and T[1,2]CH1 (timer channel 1), where “1” is used to indicate TIM1 and “2” is used to indicate TIM2. The two TIMs share four I/O pins with four I/O port pins. The full names of the TIM I/O pins are listed in Table 11-1. The generic pin names appear in the text that follows. Table 11-1. Pin Name Conventions TIM Generic Pin Names: Full TIM Pin Names: NOTE: T[1,2]CH0 T[1,2]CH1 TIM1 PTB2/T1CH0 PTB3/T1CH1 TIM2 PTB4/T2CH0 PTB5/T2CH1 References to either timer 1 or timer 2 may be made in the following text by omitting the timer number. For example, TCH0 may refer generically to T1CH0 and T2CH0, and TCH1 may refer to T1CH1 and T2CH1. 11.5 Functional Description Figure 11-1 shows the structure of the TIM. The central component of the TIM is the 16-bit TIM counter that can operate as a free-running counter or a modulo up-counter. The TIM counter provides the timing reference for the input capture and output compare functions. The TIM counter modulo registers, TMODH:TMODL, control the modulo value of the TIM counter. Software can read the TIM counter value at any time without affecting the counting sequence. The two TIM channels (per timer) are programmable independently as input capture or output compare channels. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 187 Timer Interface Module (TIM) PRESCALER SELECT INTERNAL BUS CLOCK PRESCALER TSTOP PS2 TRST PS1 PS0 16-BIT COUNTER TOF TOIE INTERRUPT LOGIC 16-BIT COMPARATOR TMODH:TMODL TOV0 ELS0B CHANNEL 0 ELS0A CH0MAX 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH0H:TCH0L PORT LOGIC T[1,2]CH0 CH0F 16-BIT LATCH CH0IE MS0A INTERRUPT LOGIC MS0B INTERNAL BUS TOV1 ELS1B CHANNEL 1 ELS1A CH1MAX PORT LOGIC T[1,2]CH1 16-BIT COMPARATOR TCH1H:TCH1L CH1F 16-BIT LATCH MS1A CH1IE INTERRUPT LOGIC Figure 11-1. TIM Block Diagram Figure 11-2 summarizes the timer registers. NOTE: References to either timer 1 or timer 2 may be made in the following text by omitting the timer number. For example, TSC may generically refer to both T1SC and T2SC. Technical Data 188 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) Functional Description Addr. Register Name $0020 $0021 $0022 $0023 $0024 5 TOIE TSTOP 4 3 0 0 2 1 Bit 0 PS2 PS1 PS0 TOF 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 1 Counter Register High Write: (T1CNTH) Reset: Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 1 Counter Register Low Write: (T1CNTL) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 CH0IE MS0B MS0A ELS0B ELS0A TOV0 CH0MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 2 1 Bit 0 Read: Timer 1 Counter Modulo Register Low Write: (T1MODL) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Channel 0 Status $0025 and Control Register Write: (T1SC0) Reset: $0027 6 Read: Timer 1 Status and Control Register Write: (T1SC) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Counter Modulo Register High Write: (T1MODH) Reset: $0026 Bit 7 Read: Timer 1 Channel 0 Register High Write: (T1CH0H) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Channel 0 Register Low Write: (T1CH0L) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Channel 1 Status $0028 and Control Register Write: (T1SC1) Reset: 0 TRST CH0F 0 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Indeterminate after reset CH1F 0 CH1IE MS1A ELS1B ELS1A TOV1 CH1MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 189 Timer Interface Module (TIM) Addr. $0029 $002A $002B Register Name Read: Timer 1 Channel 1 Register High Write: (T1CH1H) Reset: Read: Timer 1 Channel 1 Register Low Write: (T1CH1L) Reset: 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 2 1 Bit 0 PS2 PS1 PS0 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Indeterminate after reset 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 2 Counter Register High Write: (T2CNTH) Reset: Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Timer 2 Counter Register Low Write: (T2CNTL) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 CH0IE MS0B MS0A ELS0B ELS0A TOV0 CH0MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 Read: Timer 2 Counter Modulo Register High Write: (T2MODH) Reset: Read: Timer 2 Counter Modulo Register Low Write: (T2MODL) Reset: Read: Timer 2 Channel 0 Status $0030 and Control Register Write: (T2SC0) Reset: $0031 5 TOF $002D $002F 6 Read: Timer 2 Status and Control Register Write: (T2SC) Reset: $002C $002E Bit 7 Read: Timer 2 Channel 0 Register High Write: (T2CH0H) Reset: 0 TOIE 0 TSTOP 0 TRST CH0F 0 Indeterminate after reset = Unimplemented Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3) Technical Data 190 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) Functional Description Addr. Register Name $0032 Read: Timer 2 Channel 0 Register Low Write: (T2CH0L) Reset: Read: Timer 2 Channel 1 Status $0033 and Control Register Write: (T2SC1) Reset: $0034 $0035 Read: Timer 2 Channel 1 Register High Write: (T2CH1H) Reset: Read: Timer 2 Channel 1 Register Low Write: (T2CH1L) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset CH1F 0 CH1IE MS1A ELS1B ELS1A TOV1 CH1MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 2 1 Bit 0 Indeterminate after reset Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Indeterminate after reset = Unimplemented Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3) 11.5.1 TIM Counter Prescaler The TIM clock source can be one of the seven prescaler outputs. The prescaler generates seven clock rates from the internal bus clock. The prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in the TIM status and control register select the TIM clock source. 11.5.2 Input Capture With the input capture function, the TIM can capture the time at which an external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel, the TIM latches the contents of the TIM counter into the TIM channel registers, TCHxH:TCHxL. The polarity of the active edge is programmable. Input captures can generate TIM CPU interrupt requests. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 191 Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.5.3 Output Compare With the output compare function, the TIM can generate a periodic pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the value in the registers of an output compare channel, the TIM can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. Output compares can generate TIM CPU interrupt requests. 11.5.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare pulses as described in 11.5.3 Output Compare. The pulses are unbuffered because changing the output compare value requires writing the new value over the old value currently in the TIM channel registers. An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change an output compare value could cause incorrect operation for up to two counter overflow periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that counter overflow period. Also, using a TIM overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIM may pass the new value before it is written. Use the following methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the output compare value on channel x: • When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current output compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the counter overflow period to write the new value. • When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIM overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIM overflow interrupt routine. The TIM overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current counter overflow period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the same counter overflow period. Technical Data 192 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) Functional Description 11.5.3.2 Buffered Output Compare Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare channel whose output appears on the TCH0 pin. The TIM channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output. Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The output compare value in the TIM channel 0 registers initially controls the output on the TCH0 pin. Writing to the TIM channel 1 registers enables the TIM channel 1 registers to synchronously control the output after the TIM overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1) that control the output are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the buffered output compare function, and TIM channel 1 status and control register (TSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, TCH1, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. NOTE: In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare values to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered output compares. 11.5.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel, the TIM can generate a PWM signal. The value in the TIM counter modulo registers determines the period of the PWM signal. The channel pin toggles when the counter reaches the value in the TIM counter modulo registers. The time between overflows is the period of the PWM signal. As Figure 11-3 shows, the output compare value in the TIM channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM signal. The time between overflow and output compare is the pulse width. Program the TIM to clear the channel pin on output compare if the state of the PWM pulse is logic 1. Program the TIM to set the pin if the state of the PWM pulse is logic 0. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 193 Timer Interface Module (TIM) The value in the TIM counter modulo registers and the selected prescaler output determines the frequency of the PWM output. The frequency of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $00FF (255) to the TIM counter modulo registers produces a PWM period of 256 times the internal bus clock period if the prescaler select value is $000. See 11.10.1 TIM Status and Control Register. OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW PERIOD PULSE WIDTH TCHx OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE Figure 11-3. PWM Period and Pulse Width The value in the TIM channel registers determines the pulse width of the PWM output. The pulse width of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing $0080 (128) to the TIM channel registers produces a duty cycle of 128/256 or 50%. 11.5.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as described in 11.5.4 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM). The pulses are unbuffered because changing the pulse width requires writing the new pulse width value over the old value currently in the TIM channel registers. An unsynchronized write to the TIM channel registers to change a pulse width value could cause incorrect operation for up to two PWM periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any compare during that PWM period. Also, using a TIM overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller pulse width value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIM may pass the new value before it is written. Technical Data 194 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) Functional Description Use the following methods to synchronize unbuffered changes in the PWM pulse width on channel x: NOTE: • When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel x output compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end of the current pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the PWM period to write the new value. • When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIM overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIM overflow interrupt routine. The TIM overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the current PWM period. Writing a larger value in an output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two output compares to occur in the same PWM period. In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0% duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to selfcorrect in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare also can cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value. 11.5.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose output appears on the TCH0 pin. The TIM channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output. Setting the MS0B bit in TIM channel 0 status and control register (TSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The TIM channel 0 registers initially control the pulse width on the TCH0 pin. Writing to the TIM channel 1 registers enables the TIM channel 1 registers to synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIM channel registers (0 or 1) that control the pulse width are the ones written to last. TSC0 controls and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIM channel 1 status and control register (TSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, TCH1, is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 195 Timer Interface Module (TIM) NOTE: In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as generating unbuffered PWM signals. 11.5.4.3 PWM Initialization To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered PWM signals, use the following initialization procedure: 1. In the TIM status and control register (TSC): a. Stop the TIM counter by setting the TIM stop bit, TSTOP. b. Reset the TIM counter and prescaler by setting the TIM reset bit, TRST. 2. In the TIM counter modulo registers (TMODH:TMODL), write the value for the required PWM period. 3. In the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH:TCHxL), write the value for the required pulse width. 4. In TIM channel x status and control register (TSCx): a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or 1:0 (for buffered output compare or PWM signals) to the mode select bits, MSxB:MSxA. (See Table 11-3.) b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx. c. Write 1:0 (to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (to set output on compare) to the edge/level select bits, ELSxB:ELSxA. The output action on compare must force the output to the complement of the pulse width level. (See Table 11-3.) NOTE: In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable 0% duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel to selfcorrect in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output compare can also cause incorrect PWM signal generation when changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value. 5. In the TIM status control register (TSC), clear the TIM stop bit, TSTOP. Technical Data 196 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) Interrupts Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered PWM operation. The TIM channel 0 registers (TCH0H:TCH0L) initially control the buffered PWM output. TIM status control register 0 (TSCR0) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked channels. Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on TIM overflows. Subsequent output compares try to force the output to a state it is already in and have no effect. The result is a 0% duty cycle output. Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the TOVx bit generates a 100% duty cycle output. (See 11.10.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers.) 11.6 Interrupts The following TIM sources can generate interrupt requests: • TIM overflow flag (TOF) — The TOF bit is set when the TIM counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIM counter modulo registers. The TIM overflow interrupt enable bit, TOIE, enables TIM overflow CPU interrupt requests. TOF and TOIE are in the TIM status and control register. • TIM channel flags (CH1F:CH0F) — The CHxF bit is set when an input capture or output compare occurs on channel x. Channel x TIM CPU interrupt requests are controlled by the channel x interrupt enable bit, CHxIE. Channel x TIM CPU interrupt requests are enabled when CHxIE = 1. CHxF and CHxIE are in the TIM channel x status and control register. 11.7 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 197 Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.7.1 Wait Mode The TIM remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode, the TIM registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the TIM can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If TIM functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by stopping the TIM before executing the WAIT instruction. 11.7.2 Stop Mode The TIM is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The STOP instruction does not affect register conditions or the state of the TIM counter. TIM operation resumes when the MCU exits stop mode after an external interrupt. 11.8 TIM During Break Interrupts A break interrupt stops the TIM counter. The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in other modules can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. (See 9.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register.) To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state. To protect status bits during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some status bits have a 2-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does the first step on such a bit before the break, the bit cannot change during the break state as long as BCFE is at logic 0. After the break, doing the second step clears the status bit. Technical Data 198 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) I/O Signals 11.9 I/O Signals Port B shares four of its pins with the TIM. The four TIM channel I/O pins are T1CH0, T1CH1, T2CH0, and T2CH1 as described in 11.4 Pin Name Conventions. Each channel I/O pin is programmable independently as an input capture pin or an output compare pin. T1CH0 and T2CH0 can be configured as buffered output compare or buffered PWM pins. 11.10 I/O Registers NOTE: References to either timer 1 or timer 2 may be made in the following text by omitting the timer number. For example, TSC may generically refer to both T1SC AND T2SC. These I/O registers control and monitor operation of the TIM: • TIM status and control register (TSC) • TIM counter registers (TCNTH:TCNTL) • TIM counter modulo registers (TMODH:TMODL) • TIM channel status and control registers (TSC0, TSC1) • TIM channel registers (TCH0H:TCH0L, TCH1H:TCH1L) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 199 Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.10.1 TIM Status and Control Register The TIM status and control register (TSC): • Enables TIM overflow interrupts • Flags TIM overflows • Stops the TIM counter • Resets the TIM counter • Prescales the TIM counter clock Address: T1SC, $0020 and T2SC, $002B Bit 7 Read: 6 5 TOIE TSTOP TOF Write: 0 Reset: 0 4 3 0 0 2 1 Bit 0 PS2 PS1 PS0 0 0 0 TRST 0 1 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 11-4. TIM Status and Control Register (TSC) TOF — TIM Overflow Flag Bit This read/write flag is set when the TIM counter reaches the modulo value programmed in the TIM counter modulo registers. Clear TOF by reading the TIM status and control register when TOF is set and then writing a logic 0 to TOF. If another TIM overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to TOF has no effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a logic 1 to TOF has no effect. 1 = TIM counter has reached modulo value 0 = TIM counter has not reached modulo value TOIE — TIM Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables TIM overflow interrupts when the TOF bit becomes set. Reset clears the TOIE bit. 1 = TIM overflow interrupts enabled 0 = TIM overflow interrupts disabled Technical Data 200 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) I/O Registers TSTOP — TIM Stop Bit This read/write bit stops the TIM counter. Counting resumes when TSTOP is cleared. Reset sets the TSTOP bit, stopping the TIM counter until software clears the TSTOP bit. 1 = TIM counter stopped 0 = TIM counter active NOTE: Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIM is required to exit wait mode. TRST — TIM Reset Bit Setting this write-only bit resets the TIM counter and the TIM prescaler. Setting TRST has no effect on any other registers. Counting resumes from $0000. TRST is cleared automatically after the TIM counter is reset and always reads as logic 0. Reset clears the TRST bit. 1 = Prescaler and TIM counter cleared 0 = No effect NOTE: Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIM counter at a value of $0000. PS[2:0] — Prescaler Select Bits These read/write bits select one of the seven prescaler outputs as the input to the TIM counter as Table 11-2 shows. Reset clears the PS[2:0] bits. Table 11-2. Prescaler Selection PS2 PS1 PS0 0 0 0 Internal bus clock ÷ 1 0 0 1 Internal bus clock ÷ 2 0 1 0 Internal bus clock ÷ 4 0 1 1 Internal bus clock ÷ 8 1 0 0 Internal bus clock ÷ 16 1 0 1 Internal bus clock ÷ 32 1 1 0 Internal bus clock ÷ 64 1 1 1 Not available MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA TIM Clock Source Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 201 Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.10.2 TIM Counter Registers The two read-only TIM counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value in the TIM counter. Reading the high byte (TCNTH) latches the contents of the low byte (TCNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent reads of TCNTH do not affect the latched TCNTL value until TCNTL is read. Reset clears the TIM counter registers. Setting the TIM reset bit (TRST) also clears the TIM counter registers. NOTE: If you read TCNTH during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TCNTL by reading TCNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise, TCNTL retains the value latched during the break. Address: T1CNTH, $0021 and T2CNTH, $002C Read: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: = Unimplemented Figure 11-5. TIM Counter Registers High (TCNTH) Address: T1CNTL, $0022 and T2CNTL, $002D Read: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: = Unimplemented Figure 11-6. TIM Counter Registers Low (TCNTL) Technical Data 202 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) I/O Registers 11.10.3 TIM Counter Modulo Registers The read/write TIM modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TIM counter. When the TIM counter reaches the modulo value, the overflow flag (TOF) becomes set, and the TIM counter resumes counting from $0000 at the next timer clock. Writing to the high byte (TMODH) inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until the low byte (TMODL) is written. Reset sets the TIM counter modulo registers. Address: T1MODH, $0023 and T2MODH, $002E Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 11-7. TIM Counter Modulo Register High (TMODH) Address: T1MODL, $0024 and T2MODL, $002F Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 11-8. TIM Counter Modulo Register Low (TMODL) NOTE: Reset the TIM counter before writing to the TIM counter modulo registers. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 203 Timer Interface Module (TIM) 11.10.4 TIM Channel Status and Control Registers Each of the TIM channel status and control registers: • Flags input captures and output compares • Enables input capture and output compare interrupts • Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation • Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare • Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input capture trigger • Selects output toggling on TIM overflow • Selects 0% and 100% PWM duty cycle • Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation Address: T1SC0, $0025 and T2SC0, $0030 Bit 7 Read: CH0F Write: 0 Reset: 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 CH0IE MS0B MS0A ELS0B ELS0A TOV0 CH0MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 11-9. TIM Channel 0 Status and Control Register (TSC0) Address: T1SC1, $0028 and T2SC1, $0033 Bit 7 Read: 6 CH1F 5 0 Reset: 0 3 2 1 Bit 0 MS1A ELS1B ELS1A TOV1 CH1MAX 0 0 0 0 0 0 CH1IE Write: 4 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 11-10. TIM Channel 1 Status and Control Register (TSC1) Technical Data 204 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) I/O Registers CHxF — Channel x Flag Bit When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set when an active edge occurs on the channel x pin. When channel x is an output compare channel, CHxF is set when the value in the TIM counter registers matches the value in the TIM channel x registers. When TIM CPU interrupt requests are enabled (CHxIE = 1), clear CHxF by reading TIM channel x status and control register with CHxF set and then writing a logic 0 to CHxF. If another interrupt request occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to CHxF has no effect. Therefore, an interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF. Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a logic 1 to CHxF has no effect. 1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x 0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables TIM CPU interrupt service requests on channel x. Reset clears the CHxIE bit. 1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled 0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled MSxB — Mode Select Bit B This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation. MSxB exists only in the TIM1 channel 0 and TIM2 channel 0 status and control registers. Setting MS0B disables the channel 1 status and control register and reverts TCH1 to general-purpose I/O. Reset clears the MSxB bit. 1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled 0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled MSxA — Mode Select Bit A When ELSxB:ELSxA ≠ 0:0, this read/write bit selects either input capture operation or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation. See Table 11-3. 1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation 0 = Input capture operation MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 205 Timer Interface Module (TIM) When ELSxB:ELSxA = 0:0, this read/write bit selects the initial output level of the TCHx pin. See Table 11-3. Reset clears the MSxA bit. 1 = Initial output level low 0 = Initial output level high NOTE: Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit, set the TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIM status and control register (TSC). ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits When channel x is an input capture channel, these read/write bits control the active edge-sensing logic on channel x. When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA control the channel x output behavior when an output compare occurs. When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected to an I/O port, and pin TCHx is available as a general-purpose I/O pin. Table 11-3 shows how ELSxB and ELSxA work. Reset clears the ELSxB and ELSxA bits. Table 11-3. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection MSxB:MSxA ELSxB:ELSxA X0 00 Mode Configuration Pin under port control; initial output level high Output preset X1 00 Pin under port control; initial output level low 00 01 Capture on rising edge only 00 10 00 11 01 01 01 10 01 11 1X 01 1X 10 1X 11 Input capture Capture on rising or falling edge Output compare or PWM Buffered output compare or buffered PWM Technical Data 206 Capture on falling edge only Toggle output on compare Clear output on compare Set output on compare Toggle output on compare Clear output on compare Set output on compare MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Timer Interface Module (TIM) I/O Registers NOTE: Before enabling a TIM channel register for input capture operation, make sure that the TCHx pin is stable for at least two bus clocks. User software should also clear CHxF before setting CHxIE to avoid any false interrupts. TOVx — Toggle On Overflow Bit When channel x is an output compare channel, this read/write bit controls the behavior of the channel x output when the TIM counter overflows. When channel x is an input capture channel, TOVx has no effect. Reset clears the TOVx bit. 1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIM counter overflow 0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIM counter overflow NOTE: When TOVx is set, a TIM counter overflow takes precedence over a channel x output compare if both occur at the same time. CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit When the TOVx bit is at logic 1, setting the CHxMAX bit forces the duty cycle of buffered and unbuffered PWM signals to 100%. As Figure 11-11 shows, the CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it is set or cleared. The output stays at the 100% duty cycle level until the cycle after CHxMAX is cleared. OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW PERIOD TCHx OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE CHxMAX Figure 11-11. CHxMAX Latency 11.10.5 TIM Channel Registers These read/write registers contain the captured TIM counter value of the input capture function or the output compare value of the output compare function. The state of the TIM channel registers after reset is unknown. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Timer Interface Module (TIM) 207 Timer Interface Module (TIM) In input capture mode (MSxB:MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH) inhibits input captures until the low byte (TCHxL) is read. In output compare mode (MSxB:MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of the TIM channel x registers (TCHxH) inhibits output compares until the low byte (TCHxL) is written. Address: T1CH0H, $0026 and T2CH0H, $0031 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 Read: Write: Reset: Indeterminate after reset Figure 11-12. TIM Channel 0 Register High (TCH0H) Address: T1CH0L, $0027 and T2CH0L $0032 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: Write: Reset: Indeterminate after reset Figure 11-13. TIM Channel 0 Register Low (TCH0L) Address: T1CH1H, $0029 and T2CH1H, $0034 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 Read: Write: Reset: Indeterminate after reset Figure 11-14. TIM Channel 1 Register High (TCH1H) Address: T1CH1L, $002A and T2CH1L, $0035 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: Write: Reset: Indeterminate after reset Figure 11-15. TIM Channel 1 Register Low (TCH1L) Technical Data 208 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Timer Interface Module (TIM) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 12. Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.1 Contents 12.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 12.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 12.4.1 Time Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.2 Calendar Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.3 Alarm Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.4 Timebase Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214 12.4.5 Chronograph Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215 12.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215 12.6 RTC Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 12.6.1 RTC Control Register 1 (RTCCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 12.6.2 RTC Control Register 2 (RTCCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218 12.6.3 RTC Status Register (RTCSR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219 12.6.4 Alarm Minute and Hour Registers (ALMR and ALHR) . . . . 222 12.6.5 Second Register (SECR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 12.6.6 Minute Register (MINR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 12.6.7 Hour Register (HRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 12.6.8 Day Register (DAYR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224 12.6.9 Month Register (MTHR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 12.6.10 Year Register (YRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 12.6.11 Day-Of-Week Register (DOWR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 12.6.12 Chronograph Data Register (CHRR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 209 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.2 Introduction This section describes the real time clock (RTC) module. The RTC provides real time clock and calendar functions with automatic leap year adjustments. Other functions include alarm interrupt, periodic interrupts, and a chronograph timer. 12.3 Features Features of the RTC module include: • Counter registers for: – Second – Minute – Hour – Day – Day-of-week – Month – Year Addr. $0042 $0043 • Day counter with automatic month and leap year adjustment • 1/100 seconds chronograph counter • Seven periodic interrupts • Alarm interrupt Register Name Read: RTC Control Register 1 Write: (RTCCR1) Reset: Read: RTC Control Register 2 Write: (RTCCR2) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 ALMIE CHRIE DAYIE HRIE MINIE SECIE TB1IE TB2IE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R CHRCLR CHRE RTCE XTL2 XTL1 XTL0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 0 R = Reserved Figure 12-1. RTC I/O Register Summary Technical Data 210 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) Features $0044 $0045 $0046 Read: RTC Status Register Write: (RTCSR) Reset: ALMF CHRF DAYF HRF MINF SECF TB1F TB2F 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Alarm Minute Register Write: (ALMR) Reset: 0 0 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Alarm Hour Register Write: (ALHR) Reset: 0 0 0 AH4 AH3 AH2 AH1 AH0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Second Register Write: (SECR) Reset: 0 0 SEC5 SEC4 SEC3 SEC2 SEC1 SEC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 MIN5 MIN4 MIN3 MIN2 MIN1 MIN0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 HR4 HR3 HR2 HR1 HR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DAY4 DAY3 DAY2 DAY1 DAY0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 MTH3 MTH2 MTH1 MTH0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 YR7 YR6 YR5 YR4 YR3 YR2 YR1 YR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DOW2 DOW1 DOW0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 CHR6 CHR5 CHR4 CHR3 CHR2 CHR1 CHR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 $0047 Read: Minute Register Write: (MINR) Reset: $0048 Read: Hour Register Write: (HRR) Reset: $0049 Read: Day Register Write: (DAYR) Reset: $004A Read: Month Register Write: (MTHR) Reset: $004B Read: Year Register Write: (YRR) Reset: $004C $004D Read: Day-Of-Week Register Write: (DOWR) Reset: $004E Read: Chronograph Data Register Write: (CHRR) Reset: = Unimplemented R = Reserved Figure 12-1. RTC I/O Register Summary MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 211 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.4 Functional Description The RTC module provides clock indications in seconds, minutes, and hours; calendar indications in day-of-week, day-of-month, month, and year; with automatic adjustment for month and leap year. Reading the clock and calendar registers return the current time and date. Writing to these registers set the time and date, and the counters will continue to count from the new settings. The alarm interrupt is set for the hour and minute. When the hour and minute counters matches the time set in the alarm hour and minute registers, the alarm flag is set. The alarm can be configured to generate a CPU interrupt request. A 1/100 seconds chronograph counter is provided for timing applications. This counter can be independently enabled or disabled, and cleared at any time. RTC module interrupts include the alarm interrupt and seven periodic interrupts from the clock counters. For proper RTC module operation, one of the following oscillator frequencies (CGMXCLK) must be used: • 32.768 kHz • 32.000 kHz • 38.400 kHz • 64.000 kHz • 76.800 kHz Configuring the XTL[2:0] bits in the RTC control register 2 selects the appropriate prescalers and dividers to divide CGMXCLK down to the basic 1Hz clock for driving the clock counters. Figure 12-2 shows the structure of the RTC module. Technical Data 212 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) Functional Description XTL[2:0] CGMXCLK ÷ 64 VALID CGMXCLK FREQUENCIES: ÷ 256 ÷4 ÷ 320 ÷5 ÷ 384 ÷6 XTL[2:0] = 000 => X = A XTL[2:0] = 000 => X = B 000 X ÷ 32 A ÷ 25 B SL 010 X ÷2 ÷2 011 2 Hz 32.768 kHz 32.000 kHz ÷2 38.400 kHz 64.000 kHz ÷2 ÷ 640 ÷ 768 TB1F 100/110 TB1IE 4 Hz TB2F 101/111 76.800 kHz TB2IE 25 × 32 100 Hz / 128 Hz RTCE CHRF CHRIE CHRONOGRAPH COUNTER ×1 CHRE CHRCLR CHRONOGRAPH DATA REGISTER 1 Hz SECF SECIE SECOND COUNTER REGISTER ALARM MINUTE REGISTER INTERRUPT LOGIC MINF MINIE COMPARATOR INTERNAL BUS MINUTE COUNTER REGISTER HRF ALARM HOUR REGISTER HRIE COMPARATOR ALMF ALMIE HOUR COUNTER REGISTER DAYF DAY-OF-WEEK COUNTER REGISTER DAYIE DAY COUNTER REGISTER MONTH COUNTER REGISTER YEAR COUNTER REGISTER Figure 12-2. RTC Block Diagram MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 213 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.4.1 Time Functions Real time clock functions are provided by the second, minute, and hour counter registers. All three clock counters are able to generate interrupts on every counter increment, providing periodic interrupts for the second (SECF), minute (MINF), and hour (HRF). A CPU interrupt request is generated if the corresponding enable bit (SECIE, MINIE, and HRIE) is also set. 12.4.2 Calendar Functions Calendar functions are provided by the day, day-of-week, month, and year counter registers. The roll over of the day counter is automatically adjusted for the month and leap years. The setting for the year counter ranges from 1901 to 2099. The day flag (DAYF) is set on every increment of the day counter. A CPU interrupt request is generated if the day interrupt enable bit (DAYIE) is also set. 12.4.3 Alarm Functions An alarm function is provided for the minute and hour counters. When minute counter matches the value stored in the alarm minute register, and the hour counter matches the value stored in the alarm hour register, the alarm flag (ALMF) will be set. A CPU interrupt request is generated if the alarm interrupt enable bit (ALMIE) is also set. 12.4.4 Timebase Interrupts In addition to the second, minute, hour, and day periodic interrupts generated by the clock functions, the divider circuits generates a 2Hz and a 4Hz periodic interrupt. These are indicated by the TB1F and TB2F flags. A CPU interrupt request is generated if the corresponding enable bits (TB1IE and TB2IE) is also set. Technical Data 214 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) Low-Power Modes 12.4.5 Chronograph Functions A 100Hz resolution chronograph counter can be enabled by setting the CHRE bit. The chronograph counter will automatically roll over to zero when the counter reaches 99. If 32.768kHz CGMXCLK is used, the chronograph counter resolution becomes 128Hz. With either 100Hz or 128Hz resolution, the counter value is converted to 100Hz, before it is saved in the chronograph data register. Therefore, each chronograph data register increment represents 10ms. 12.5 Low-Power Modes The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 12.5.1 Wait Mode The RTC module continues normal operation in wait mode. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the RTC can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If the RTC is not required to bring the MCU out of wait mode, power down the RTC by clearing the RTCE bit before executing the WAIT instruction. 12.5.2 Stop Mode For continuous RTC operation in stop mode, the oscillator stop mode enable bit (STOP_XCLKEN in CONFIG2 register) must be set before executing the STOP instruction. When STOP_XCLKEN is set, CGMXCLK continues to drive the RTC module, and any enabled CPU interrupt request from the RTC can bring the MCU out of stop mode. If STOP_XCLKEN bit is cleared, the RTC module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The STOP instruction does not affect RTC register states. RTC module operation resumes after an external interrupt. To further reduce power consumption, the RTC module should be powered-down by clearing the RTCE bit before executing the STOP instruction. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 215 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.6 RTC Registers The RTC module has thirteen memory-mapped registers: • RTC control register 1 (RTCCR1) • RTC control register 2 (RTCCR2) • RTC status register (RTCSR) • Alarm minute and hour registers (ALMR and ALHR) • Second register (SECR) • Minute register (MINR) • Hour register (HRR) • Day register (DAY) • Month register (MTHR) • Year register (YRR) • Day of the week register (DOWR) • Chronograph data register (CHRR) 12.6.1 RTC Control Register 1 (RTCCR1) The RTC control register 1 (RTCCR1) contains the eight interrupt enable bits for RTC interrupt functions. Address: $0042 Read: ALMIE CHRIE DAYIE HRIE MINIE SECIE TB1IE TB2IE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: Figure 12-3. RTC Control Register 1 (RTCCR1) ALMIE — Alarm Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the alarm flag, ALMF, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the ALMIE bit. 1 = ALMF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = ALMF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt Technical Data 216 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) RTC Registers CHRIE — Chronograph Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the chronograph flag, CHRF, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the CHRIE bit. 1 = CHRF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = CHRF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt DAYIE — Day Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the day flag, DAYF, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the DAYIE bit. 1 = DAYF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = DAYF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt HRIE — Hour Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the hour flag, HRF, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the HRIE bit. 1 = HRF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = HRF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt MINIE — Minute Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the minute flag, MINF, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the MINIE bit. 1 = MINF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = MINF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt SECIE — Second Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the second flag, SECF, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SECIE bit. 1 = SECF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = SECF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt TB1IE — Timebase 1 Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the timebase1 flag, TB1F, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the TB1IE bit. 1 = TB1F enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = TB1F not enabled to generate CPU interrupt TB2IE — Timebase 2 Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables the timebase2 flag, TB2F, to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the TB2IE bit. 1 = TB2F enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = TB2F not enabled to generate CPU interrupt MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 217 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.6.2 RTC Control Register 2 (RTCCR2) The RTC control register 2 (RTCCR2) contains control and clock selection bits for RTC operation. Address: Read: $0043 0 0 0 Write: R CHRCLR Reset: 0 0 CHRE RTCE 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 R XTL2 XTL1 XTL0 0 0 0 = Reserved Figure 12-4. RTC Control Register 2 (RTCCR2) CHRCLR — Chronograph counter clear Setting this write-only bit resets the chronograph counter. Setting CHRCLR has no effect on any other registers. Counting resumes from $00. CHRCLR is cleared automatically after the chronograph counter is reset and always reads as logic 0. Reset clears the CHRCLR bit. 1 = Chronograph counter cleared 0 = No effect CHRE — Chronograph Enable This read/write bit enables the chronograph counter, the value in the chronograph data register increments by 1 in every 1/100 seconds. When the chronograph counter is disabled (CHRE = 0), the value in the chronograph data register is held at the count value. Reset clears the CHRE bit. 1 = Chronograph counter enabled 0 = Chronograph counter disabled RTCE — Real Time Clock Enable This read/write bit enables the entire RTC module, allowing all RTC and chronograph operations. Disabling the RTC module does not affect the contents in the RTC registers. Reset clears the RTCE bit. 1 = RTC module enabled 0 = RTC module disabled Technical Data 218 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) RTC Registers XTL[2:0] — Crystal Frequency Select Bits These three bits set the prescalers/dividers for proper operation of the RTC module for various crystal (CGMXCLK) input frequencies. The XTL[2:0] bits can only be written once after reset, subsequent writes to these bits will have no effect on its content. Table 12-1 shows the XTL[2:0] settings for various CGMXCLK frequencies. Reset clear the XTL[2:0] bits. Table 12-1. CGMXCLK Frequency for RTC Input Reference CGMXCLK(1) XTL2 XTL1 XTL0 32.768 kHz 0 0 0 Reserved 0 0 1 32.000 kHz 0 1 0 38.400 kHz 0 1 1 64.000 kHz 1 X 0 76.800 kHz 1 X 1 Notes: 1. Using crystal frequencies other than these specified will cause incorrect timings in the RTC module. 12.6.3 RTC Status Register (RTCSR) The RTC status register contains eight status flags. When a flag is set and the corresponding interrupt enable bit is also set, a CPU interrupt request is generated. Address: $0044 Read: ALMF CHRF DAYF HRF MINF SECF TB1F TB2F 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: = Unimplemented Figure 12-5. RTC Status Register (RTCSR) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 219 Real Time Clock (RTC) ALMF — Alarm Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set when the value in the RTC hour and minute counters matches the value in the alarm hour and alarm minute registers. When the ALMIE bit in RTCCR1 is set, ALMF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the ALMF bit by reading RTCSR with ALMF set and then reading the alarm hour register (ALHR). Reset clears ALMF. 1 = RTC hour and minute counters matches the alarm hour and minute registers 0 = No matching between hour and minute counters and alarm hour and minute registers CHRF — Chronograph Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set on every tick of the chronograph counter (every counter count). The tick is on every 1/100 or 1/128 seconds (see 12.4.5 Chronograph Functions). When the CHRIE bit in RTCCR1 is set, CHRF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the CHRF bit by reading RTCSR with CHRF set and then reading the chronograph data register (CHRR). Reset clears CHRF. 1 = A chronograph counter tick has occurred 0 = No chronograph counter tick has occurred DAYF — Day Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set on every increment of the day counter. When the DAYIE bit in RTCCR1 is set, DAYF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the DAYF bit by reading RTCSR with DAYF set and then reading the day register (DAYR). Reset clears DAYF. 1 = Day counter incremented 0 = No day counter incremented HRF — Hour Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set on every increment of the hour counter. When the HRIE bit in RTCCR1 is set, HRF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the HRF bit by reading RTCSR with HRF set and then reading the hour register (HRR). Reset clears HRF. 1 = Hour counter incremented 0 = No hour counter incremented Technical Data 220 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) RTC Registers MINF — Minute Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set on every increment of the minute counter. When the MINIE bit in RTCCR1 is set, MINF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the MINF bit by reading RTCSR with MINF set and then reading the minute register (MINR). Reset clears MINF. 1 = Minute counter incremented 0 = No minute counter incremented SECF — Second Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set on every increment of the second counter. When the SECIE bit in RTCCR1 is set, SECF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the SECF bit by reading RTCSR with SECF set and then reading the second register (SECR). Reset clears SECF. 1 = Second counter incremented 0 = No second counter incremented TB1F — Timebase 1 Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set on every tick of the timebase 1 counter (every 0.5 seconds). When the TB1IE bit in RTCCR1 is set, TB1F generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the TB1F bit by reading RTCSR with TB1F set and then reading the chronograph register (CHRR). Reset clears TB1F. 1 = A timebase 1 tick (0.5s) has occurred 0 = No timebase 1 tick has occurred TB2F — Timebase 2 Flag This clearable, read-only bit is set on every tick of the timebase 2 counter (every 0.25 seconds). When the TB2IE bit in RTCCR1 is set, TB2F generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the TB2F bit by reading RTCSR with TB2F set and then reading the chronograph register (CHRR). Reset clears TB2F. 1 = A timebase 2 tick (0.25s) has occurred 0 = No timebase 2 tick has occurred MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 221 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.6.4 Alarm Minute and Hour Registers (ALMR and ALHR) These read/write registers contain the alarm minute and hour values for the hour and minute alarm function. When the hour counter matches the value in the alarm hour register (ALHR) and the minute counter matches the value in the alarm minute register (ALMR), the alarm flag, ALMF, is set. When ALMF is set and the alarm interrupt enable bit, ALMIE, is also set, a CPU interrupt request is generated. Address: Read: $0045 0 0 AM5 AM4 AM3 AM2 AM1 AM0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-6. Alarm Minute Register (ALMR) NOTE: Writing values other than 0 to 59, to ALMR is possible, but the alarm flag will never be set. Address: Read: $0046 0 0 0 AH4 AH3 AH2 AH1 AH0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-7. Alarm Hour Register (ALHR) NOTE: Writing values other than 0 to 23, to ALHR is possible, but the alarm flag will never be set. Technical Data 222 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) RTC Registers 12.6.5 Second Register (SECR) This read/write register contains the current value of the second counter. This register can be read at any time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the second counter and the counter continues to count from this new value. The second counter rolls over to 0 ($00) after reaching 59 ($4B). Writing a value other than 0 to 59 to this register has no effect. Address: $0047 Read: 0 0 SEC5 SEC4 SEC3 SEC2 SEC1 SEC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-8. Second Register (SECR) 12.6.6 Minute Register (MINR) This read/write register contains the current value of the minute counter. This register can be read at any time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the minute counter and the counter continues to count from this new value. The minute counter rolls over to 0 ($00) after reaching 59 ($4B). Writing a value other than 0 to 59 to this register has no effect. Address: Read: $0048 0 0 MIN5 MIN4 MIN3 MIN2 MIN1 MIN0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-9. Minute Register (MINR) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 223 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.6.7 Hour Register (HRR) This read/write register contains the current value of the hour counter. This register can be read at any time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the hour counter and the counter continues to count from this new value. The hour counter rolls over to 0 ($00) after reaching 23 ($17). Writing a value other than 0 to 23 to this register has no effect. Address: Read: $0049 0 0 0 HR4 HR3 HR2 HR1 HR0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-10. Hour Register (HRR) 12.6.8 Day Register (DAYR) This read/write register contains the current value of the day-of-month counter. This register can be read at any time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the day counter and the counter continues to count from this new value. The day counter rolls over to 1 ($01) after reaching 28 ($1B), 29 ($1C), 30 ($1D), or 31 ($1E), depending on the value in the month and year registers. Writing a value that is not valid for the month and year to this register has no effect. Address: Read: $004A 0 0 0 DAY4 DAY3 DAY2 DAY1 DAY0 0 0 0 0 1 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-11. Day Register (DAYR) Technical Data 224 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Real Time Clock (RTC) RTC Registers 12.6.9 Month Register (MTHR) This read/write register contains the current value of the month counter. This register can be read at any time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the month counter and the counter continues to count from this new value. The month counter rolls over to 1 ($01) after reaching 12 ($0B). Writing a value other than 1 to 12 to this register has no effect. Address: Read: $004B 0 0 0 0 MTH3 MTH2 MTH1 MTH0 0 0 0 1 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-12. Month Register (MTHR) 12.6.10 Year Register (YRR) This read/write register contains the current value of the year counter. This register can be read at any time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the year counter and the counter continues to count from this new value. The value stored in this register is a two’s complement representation of the year, relative to 2000. For example, the year 2008 is represented by 8 ($08), and the year 1979 is presented by –11 ($F5). The range of this register is only valid for –99 to +99. Writing a value other than –99 to +99 to this register has no effect. Address: $004C Read: YR7 YR6 YR5 YR4 YR3 YR2 YR1 YR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: Figure 12-13. Year Register (YRR) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Real Time Clock (RTC) 225 Real Time Clock (RTC) 12.6.11 Day-Of-Week Register (DOWR) This read/write register contains the current value of the day-of-week counter. This register can be read at any time without affecting the counter count. Writing to this register loads the value to the day-of-week counter and the counter continues to count from this new value. The day-of-week counter value rolls over to 0 ($00) after reaching 6 ($06). Writing a value other than 0 to 6 to this register has no effect. Address: Read: $004D 0 0 0 0 0 DOW2 DOW1 DOW0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 12-14. Day-Of-Week Register (DOWR) 12.6.12 Chronograph Data Register (CHRR) This read-only chronograph data register contains the value in the chronograph counter. Reset clears the chronograph data register. Setting the chronograph counter reset bit (CHRCLR) also clears the chronograph data register. The chronograph data register has a resolution of 1/100 seconds (10ms). The chronograph counter value rolls over to $00 after reaching $63. Address: Read: $004E 0 CHR6 CHR5 CHR4 CHR3 CHR2 CHR1 CHR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: = Unimplemented Figure 12-15. Chronograph Data Register (CHRR) Technical Data 226 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Real Time Clock (RTC) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 13. Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) 13.1 Contents 13.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 13.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 13.4 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 13.5 IRSCI Module Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231 13.6 Infrared Functional Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 13.6.1 Infrared Transmit Encoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 13.6.2 Infrared Receive Decoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233 13.7 SCI Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234 13.7.1 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235 13.7.2 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236 13.7.2.1 Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 13.7.2.2 Character Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 13.7.2.3 Break Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 13.7.2.4 Idle Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 13.7.2.5 Transmitter Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 13.7.3 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 13.7.3.1 Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 13.7.3.2 Character Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 13.7.3.3 Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 13.7.3.4 Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 13.7.3.5 Baud Rate Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 13.7.3.6 Receiver Wakeup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246 13.7.3.7 Receiver Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 13.7.3.8 Error Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 13.8 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248 13.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 13.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 227 Infrared Serial Communications 13.9 SCI During Break Module Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.10 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.10.1 PTB0/TxD (Transmit Data). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.10.2 PTB1/RxD (Receive Data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 13.11 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 13.11.1 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 13.11.2 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 13.11.3 SCI Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256 13.11.4 SCI Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258 13.11.5 SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262 13.11.6 SCI Data Register (SCDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 13.11.7 SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 13.11.8 SCI Infrared Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267 13.2 Introduction This section describes the infrared serial communications interface (IRSCI) module which allows high-speed asynchronous communications with peripheral devices and other MCUs. This IRSCI consists of an SCI module for conventional SCI functions and a software programmable infrared encoder/decoder sub-module for encoding/decoding the serial data for connection to infrared LEDs in remote control applications. NOTE: Technical Data 228 References to DMA (direct-memory access) and associated functions are only valid if the MCU has a DMA module. This MCU does not have the DMA function. Any DMA-related register bits should be left in their reset state for normal MCU operation. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Features 13.3 Features Features of the SCI module include the following: • Full duplex operation • Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format • Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit character length • Separately enabled transmitter and receiver • Separate receiver and transmitter CPU interrupt requests • Two receiver wakeup methods: – Idle line wakeup – Address mark wakeup • Interrupt-driven operation with eight interrupt flags: – Transmitter empty – Transmission complete – Receiver full – Idle receiver input – Receiver overrun – Noise error – Framing error – Parity error • Receiver framing error detection • Hardware parity checking • 1/16 bit-time noise detection Features of the infrared (IR) sub-module include the following: • IR sub-module enable/disable for infrared SCI or conventional SCI on TxD and RxD pins • Software selectable infrared modulation/demodulation (3/16, 1/16 or 1/32 width pulses) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 229 Infrared Serial Communications Addr. $0013 $0014 $0015 $0016 $0017 $0018 $0019 $001A Register Name Bit 7 Read: LOOPS SCI Control Register 1 Write: (SCC1) Reset: 0 Read: SCI Control Register 2 Write: (SCC2) Reset: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 M WAKE ILTY PEN PTY 0 ENSCI 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 SCTIE TCIE SCRIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 T8 DMARE DMATE ORIE NEIE FEIE PEIE Read: SCI Control Register 3 Write: (SCC3) Reset: R8 U U 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: SCI Status Register 1 Write: (SCS1) Reset: SCTE TC SCRF IDLE OR NF FE PE 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 BKF RPF Read: SCI Status Register 2 Write: (SCS2) Reset: Read: SCI Data Register Write: (SCDR) Reset: Read: SCI Baud Rate Register Write: (SCBR) Reset: Read: SCI Infrared Control Register Write: (SCIRCR) Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R7 R6 R5 R4 R3 R2 R1 R0 T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 Unaffected by reset 0 CKS 0 SCP1 SCP0 R SCR2 SCR1 SCR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R TNP1 TNP0 IREN 0 0 0 0 R 0 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 R = Reserved U = Unaffected Figure 13-1. IRSCI I/O Registers Summary Technical Data 230 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Pin Name Conventions 13.4 Pin Name Conventions The generic names of the IRSCI I/O pins are: • RxD (receive data) • TxD (transmit data) IRSCI I/O (input/output) lines are implemented by sharing parallel I/O port pins. The full name of an IRSCI input or output reflects the name of the shared port pin. Table 13-1 shows the full names and the generic names of the IRSCI I/O pins. The generic pin names appear in the text of this section. Table 13-1. Pin Name Conventions Generic Pin Names: RxD TxD Full Pin Names: PTB1/RxD PTB0/TxD 13.5 IRSCI Module Overview The IRSCI consists of a serial communications interface (SCI) and a infrared interface sub-module as shown in Figure 13-2. INTERNAL BUS SCI_TxD CGMXCLK BUS CLOCK SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE MODULE (SCI) TxD SCI_R32XCLK SCI_R16XCLK INFRARED SUB-MODULE SCI_RxD RxD Figure 13-2. IRSCI Block Diagram The SCI module provides serial data transmission and reception, with a programmable baud rate clock based on the bus clock or the CGMXCLK. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 231 Infrared Serial Communications The infrared sub-module receives two clock sources from the SCI module: SCI_R16XCLK and SCI_R32XCLK. Both reference clocks are used to generate the narrow pulses during data transmission. The SCI_R16XCLK and SCI_R32XCLK are internal clocks with frequencies that are 16 and 32 times the baud rate respectively. Both SCI_R16XCLK and SCI_R32XCLK clocks are used for transmitting data. The SCI_R16XCLK clock is used only for receiving data. NOTE: For proper SCI function (transmit or receive), the bus clock MUST be programmed to at least 32 times that of the selected baud rate. When the infrared sub-module is disabled, signals on the TxD and RxD pins pass through unchanged to the SCI module. 13.6 Infrared Functional Description Figure 13-3 shows the structure of the infrared sub-module. TNP[1:0] TRANSMIT ENCODER SCI_TxD IREN IR_TxD MUX TxD SCI_R32XCLK SCI_R16XCLK IR_RxD SCI_RxD RECEIVE DECODER RxD MUX Figure 13-3. Infrared Sub-Module Diagram The infrared sub-module provides the capability of transmitting narrow pulses to an infrared LED and receiving narrow pulses and transforming them to serial bits, which are sent to the SCI module. The infrared submodule receives two clocks from the SCI. One of these two clocks is selected as the base clock to generate the 3/16, 1/16, or 1/32 bit width narrow pulses during transmission. Technical Data 232 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Infrared Functional Description The sub-module consists of two main blocks: the transmit encoder and the receive decoder. When transmitting data, the SCI data stream is encoded by the infrared sub-module. For every "0" bit, a narrow "low" pulse is transmitted; no pulse is transmitted for "1" bits. When receiving data, the infrared pulses should be detected using an infrared photo diode for conversion to CMOS voltage levels before connecting to the RxD pin for the infrared decoder. The SCI data stream is reconstructed by stretching the "0" pulses. 13.6.1 Infrared Transmit Encoder The infrared transmit encoder converts the "0" bits in the serial data stream from the SCI module to narrow "low" pulses, to the TxD pin. The narrow pulse is sent with a duration of 1/32, 1/16, or 3/16 of a data bit width. When two consecutive zeros are sent, the two consecutive narrow pulses will be separated by a time equal to a data bit width. DATA BIT WIDTH DETERMINED BY BAUD RATE SCI DATA INFRARED SCI DATA PULSE WIDTH = 1/32, 1/16, OR 3/16 DATA BIT WIDTH Figure 13-4. Infrared SCI Data Example 13.6.2 Infrared Receive Decoder The infrared receive decoder converts low narrow pulses from the RxD pin to standard SCI data bits. The reference clock, SCI_R16XCLK, clocks a four bit internal counter which counts from 0 to 15. An incoming pulse starts the internal counter and a "0" is sent out to the IR_RxD output. Subsequent incoming pulses are ignored when the counter count is between 0 and 7; IR_RxD remains "0". Once the counter passes 7, an incoming pulse will reset the counter; IR_RxD remains "0". When the counter reaches 15, the IR_RxD output returns to "1", the counter stops and waits for further pulses. A pulse is interpreted as jitter if it arrives shortly after the counter reaches 15; IR_RxD remains "1". MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 233 Infrared Serial Communications 13.7 SCI Functional Description Figure 13-5 shows the structure of the SCI. INTERNAL BUS SCI DATA REGISTER ERROR INTERRUPT CONTROL RECEIVER INTERRUPT CONTROL DMA INTERRUPT CONTROL RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER SCI_RxD TRANSMITTER INTERRUPT CONTROL SCI DATA REGISTER TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER SCTIE SCI_TxD R8 TCIE T8 SCRIE ILIE DMARE TE SCTE RE DMATE TC RWU SBK SCRF OR ORIE IDLE NF NEIE FE FEIE PE PEIE LOOPS LOOPS CKS FLAG CONTROL RECEIVE CONTROL WAKEUP CONTROL ENSCI ENSCI TRANSMIT CONTROL BKF M RPF WAKE ILTY CGMXCLK BUS CLOCK A SL X B BAUD RATE GENERATOR PEN PTY SL = 0 => X = A SL = 1 => X = B SCI_R32XCLK SCI_R16XCLK ÷16 DATA SELECTION CONTROL Figure 13-5. SCI Module Block Diagram Technical Data 234 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI Functional Description The SCI allows full-duplex, asynchronous, NRZ serial communication between the MCU and remote devices, including other MCUs. The transmitter and receiver of the SCI operate independently, although they use the same baud rate generator. During normal operation, the CPU monitors the status of the SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes received data. NOTE: For SCI operations, the IR sub-module is transparent to the SCI module. Data at going out of the SCI transmitter and data going into the SCI receiver is always in SCI format. It makes no difference to the SCI module whether the IR sub-module is enabled or disabled. NOTE: This SCI module is a standard HC08 SCI module with the following modifications: • A control bit, CKS, is added to the SCI baud rate control register to select between two input clocks for baud rate clock generation • The TXINV bit is removed from the SCI control register 1 13.7.1 Data Format The SCI uses the standard non-return-to-zero mark/space data format illustrated in Figure 13-6. 8-BIT DATA FORMAT BIT M IN SCC1 CLEAR START BIT BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 5 PARITY BIT BIT 6 BIT 7 9-BIT DATA FORMAT BIT M IN SCC1 SET START BIT BIT 0 BIT 1 BIT 2 BIT 3 BIT 4 BIT 5 STOP BIT NEXT START BIT PARITY BIT BIT 6 BIT 7 BIT 8 STOP BIT NEXT START BIT Figure 13-6. SCI Data Formats MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 235 Infrared Serial Communications 13.7.2 Transmitter Figure 13-7 shows the structure of the SCI transmitter. The baud rate clock source for the SCI can be selected by the CKS bit, in the SCI baud rate register (see 13.11.7 SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR)). CKS ÷ 16 SCI DATA REGISTER SCP1 SCP0 11-BIT TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER SCR1 H SCR2 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 L SCI_TxD MSB PEN PTY PARITY GENERATION T8 DMATE DMATE SCTIE SCTE DMATE SCTE SCTIE TC TCIE BREAK ALL 0s M PREAMBLE ALL 1s TRANSMITTER DMA SERVICE REQUEST TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST SCR0 8 START BAUD DIVIDER LOAD FROM SCDR SL = 0 => X = A SL = 1 => X = B PRESCALER SHIFT ENABLE A SLX B STOP CGMXCLK BUS CLOCK INTERNAL BUS TRANSMITTER CONTROL LOGIC SCTE SBK LOOPS SCTIE ENSCI TC TE TCIE Figure 13-7. SCI Transmitter Technical Data 236 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI Functional Description 13.7.2.1 Character Length The transmitter can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length. When transmitting 9-bit data, bit T8 in SCI control register 3 (SCC3) is the ninth bit (bit 8). 13.7.2.2 Character Transmission During an SCI transmission, the transmit shift register shifts a character out to the TxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the write-only buffer between the internal data bus and the transmit shift register. To initiate an SCI transmission: 1. Enable the SCI by writing a logic 1 to the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) in SCI control register 1 (SCC1). 2. Enable the transmitter by writing a logic 1 to the transmitter enable bit (TE) in SCI control register 2 (SCC2). 3. Clear the SCI transmitter empty bit by first reading SCI status register 1 (SCS1) and then writing to the SCDR. 4. Repeat step 3 for each subsequent transmission. At the start of a transmission, transmitter control logic automatically loads the transmit shift register with a preamble of logic 1s. After the preamble shifts out, control logic transfers the SCDR data into the transmit shift register. A logic 0 start bit automatically goes into the least significant bit position of the transmit shift register. A logic 1 stop bit goes into the most significant bit position. The SCI transmitter empty bit, SCTE, in SCS1 becomes set when the SCDR transfers a byte to the transmit shift register. The SCTE bit indicates that the SCDR can accept new data from the internal data bus. If the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2 is also set, the SCTE bit generates a transmitter interrupt request. When the transmit shift register is not transmitting a character, the TxD pin goes to the idle condition, logic 1. If at any time software clears the ENSCI bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1), the transmitter and receiver relinquish control of the port pins. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 237 Infrared Serial Communications 13.7.2.3 Break Characters Writing a logic 1 to the send break bit, SBK, in SCC2 loads the transmit shift register with a break character. A break character contains all logic 0s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Break character length depends on the M bit in SCC1. As long as SBK is at logic 1, transmitter logic continuously loads break characters into the transmit shift register. After software clears the SBK bit, the shift register finishes transmitting the last break character and then transmits at least one logic 1. The automatic logic 1 at the end of a break character guarantees the recognition of the start bit of the next character. The SCI recognizes a break character when a start bit is followed by eight or nine logic 0 data bits and a logic 0 where the stop bit should be. Receiving a break character has the following effects on SCI registers: • Sets the framing error bit (FE) in SCS1 • Sets the SCI receiver full bit (SCRF) in SCS1 • Clears the SCI data register (SCDR) • Clears the R8 bit in SCC3 • Sets the break flag bit (BKF) in SCS2 • May set the overrun (OR), noise flag (NF), parity error (PE), or reception in progress flag (RPF) bits 13.7.2.4 Idle Characters An idle character contains all logic 1s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Idle character length depends on the M bit in SCC1. The preamble is a synchronizing idle character that begins every transmission. If the TE bit is cleared during a transmission, the TxD pin becomes idle after completion of the transmission in progress. Clearing and then setting the TE bit during a transmission queues an idle character to be sent after the character currently being transmitted. Technical Data 238 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI Functional Description NOTE: When queueing an idle character, return the TE bit to logic 1 before the stop bit of the current character shifts out to the TxD pin. Setting TE after the stop bit appears on TxD causes data previously written to the SCDR to be lost. Toggle the TE bit for a queued idle character when the SCTE bit becomes set and just before writing the next byte to the SCDR. 13.7.2.5 Transmitter Interrupts The following conditions can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI transmitter: • SCI transmitter empty (SCTE) — The SCTE bit in SCS1 indicates that the SCDR has transferred a character to the transmit shift register. SCTE can generate a transmitter CPU interrupt request. Setting the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2 enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests. • Transmission complete (TC) — The TC bit in SCS1 indicates that the transmit shift register and the SCDR are empty and that no break or idle character has been generated. The transmission complete interrupt enable bit, TCIE, in SCC2 enables the TC bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests. 13.7.3 Receiver Figure 13-8 shows the structure of the SCI receiver. 13.7.3.1 Character Length The receiver can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length. When receiving 9-bit data, bit R8 in SCI control register 2 (SCC2) is the ninth bit (bit 8). When receiving 8-bit data, bit R8 is a copy of the eighth bit (bit 7). MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 239 Infrared Serial Communications INTERNAL BUS SCR1 SCR0 PRESCALER SL = 0 => X = A SL = 1 => X = B BAUD DIVIDER ÷ 16 DATA RECOVERY SCI_RxD BKF CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST H 11-BIT RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER 8 7 6 5 M WAKE ILTY PEN PTY 4 3 2 1 0 L ALL 0s RPF ERROR CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST DMA SERVICE REQUEST SCI DATA REGISTER START SCP0 STOP A SL X B SCR2 ALL 1s CGMXCLK BUS CLOCK SCP1 MSB CKS SCRF WAKEUP LOGIC RWU IDLE R8 PARITY CHECKING IDLE ILIE DMARE ILIE SCRF SCRIE DMARE SCRIE SCRF SCRIE DMARE DMARE OR OR ORIE ORIE NF NF NEIE NEIE FE FE FEIE FEIE PE PE PEIE PEIE Figure 13-8. SCI Receiver Block Diagram Technical Data 240 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI Functional Description 13.7.3.2 Character Reception During an SCI reception, the receive shift register shifts characters in from the RxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the read-only buffer between the internal data bus and the receive shift register. After a complete character shifts into the receive shift register, the data portion of the character transfers to the SCDR. The SCI receiver full bit, SCRF, in SCI status register 1 (SCS1) becomes set, indicating that the received byte can be read. If the SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE, in SCC2 is also set, the SCRF bit generates a receiver CPU interrupt request. 13.7.3.3 Data Sampling The receiver samples the RxD pin at the RT clock rate. The RT clock is an internal signal with a frequency 16 times the baud rate. To adjust for baud rate mismatch, the RT clock is resynchronized at the following times (see Figure 13-9): • After every start bit • After the receiver detects a data bit change from logic 1 to logic 0 (after the majority of data bit samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10 returns a valid logic 1 and the majority of the next RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples returns a valid logic 0) START BIT LSB SCI_RxD START BIT QUALIFICATION SAMPLES START BIT VERIFICATION DATA SAMPLING RT4 RT3 RT2 RT1 RT16 RT15 RT14 RT13 RT12 RT11 RT10 RT9 RT8 RT7 RT6 RT5 RT4 RT3 RT2 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT1 RT CLOCK STATE RT1 RT CLOCK RT CLOCK RESET Figure 13-9. Receiver Data Sampling MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 241 Infrared Serial Communications To locate the start bit, data recovery logic does an asynchronous search for a logic 0 preceded by three logic 1s. When the falling edge of a possible start bit occurs, the RT clock begins to count to 16. To verify the start bit and to detect noise, data recovery logic takes samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7. Table 13-2 summarizes the results of the start bit verification samples. Table 13-2. Start Bit Verification RT3, RT5, and RT7 Samples Start Bit Verification Noise Flag 000 Yes 0 001 Yes 1 010 Yes 1 011 No 0 100 Yes 1 101 No 0 110 No 0 111 No 0 If start bit verification is not successful, the RT clock is reset and a new search for a start bit begins. To determine the value of a data bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 13-3 summarizes the results of the data bit samples. Table 13-3. Data Bit Recovery Technical Data 242 RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples Data Bit Determination Noise Flag 000 0 0 001 0 1 010 0 1 011 1 1 100 0 1 101 1 1 110 1 1 111 1 0 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI Functional Description NOTE: The RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples do not affect start bit verification. If any or all of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 start bit samples are logic 1s following a successful start bit verification, the noise flag (NF) is set and the receiver assumes that the bit is a start bit. To verify a stop bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 13-4 summarizes the results of the stop bit samples. Table 13-4. Stop Bit Recovery RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples Framing Error Flag Noise Flag 000 1 0 001 1 1 010 1 1 011 0 1 100 1 1 101 0 1 110 0 1 111 0 0 13.7.3.4 Framing Errors If the data recovery logic does not detect a logic 1 where the stop bit should be in an incoming character, it sets the framing error bit, FE, in SCS1. The FE flag is set at the same time that the SCRF bit is set. A break character that has no stop bit also sets the FE bit. 13.7.3.5 Baud Rate Tolerance A transmitting device may be operating at a baud rate below or above the receiver baud rate. Accumulated bit time misalignment can cause one of the three stop bit data samples to fall outside the actual stop bit. Then a noise error occurs. If more than one of the samples is outside the stop bit, a framing error occurs. In most applications, the baud rate tolerance is much more than the degree of misalignment that is likely to occur. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 243 Infrared Serial Communications As the receiver samples an incoming character, it resynchronizes the RT clock on any valid falling edge within the character. Resynchronization within characters corrects misalignments between transmitter bit times and receiver bit times. Slow Data Tolerance Figure 13-10 shows how much a slow received character can be misaligned without causing a noise error or a framing error. The slow stop bit begins at RT8 instead of RT1 but arrives in time for the stop bit data samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. RT16 RT15 RT14 RT13 RT12 RT11 RT10 RT9 RT8 RT7 RT6 STOP RT5 RT4 RT3 RT2 RECEIVER RT CLOCK RT1 MSB DATA SAMPLES Figure 13-10. Slow Data For an 8-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver 9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 154 RT cycles. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 13-10, the receiver counts 154 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 3 RT cycles = 147 RT cycles. The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a slow 8-bit character with no errors is 154 – 147 × 100 = 4.54% -------------------------154 For a 9-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver 10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 170 RT cycles. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 13-10, the receiver counts 170 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 3 RT cycles = 163 RT cycles. Technical Data 244 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI Functional Description The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a slow 9-bit character with no errors is 170 – 163 × 100 = 4.12% -------------------------170 Fast Data Tolerance Figure 13-11 shows how much a fast received character can be misaligned without causing a noise error or a framing error. The fast stop bit ends at RT10 instead of RT16 but is still there for the stop bit data samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. RT16 RT15 RT14 RT13 RT12 RT11 RT10 RT9 RT8 RT7 IDLE OR NEXT CHARACTER RT6 RT5 RT4 RT3 RT2 RECEIVER RT CLOCK RT1 STOP DATA SAMPLES Figure 13-11. Fast Data For an 8-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver 9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 154 RT cycles. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 13-11, the receiver counts 154 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 10 bit times × 16 RT cycles = 160 RT cycles. The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a fast 8-bit character with no errors is · 154 – 160 × 100 = 3.90% -------------------------154 For a 9-bit character, data sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver 10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 170 RT cycles. With the misaligned character shown in Figure 13-11, the receiver counts 170 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is 11 bit times × 16 RT cycles = 176 RT cycles. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 245 Infrared Serial Communications The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the transmitter count of a fast 9-bit character with no errors is 170 – 176 × 100 = 3.53% -------------------------170 13.7.3.6 Receiver Wakeup So that the MCU can ignore transmissions intended only for other receivers in multiple-receiver systems, the receiver can be put into a standby state. Setting the receiver wakeup bit, RWU, in SCC2 puts the receiver into a standby state during which receiver interrupts are disabled. Depending on the state of the WAKE bit in SCC1, either of two conditions on the RxD pin can bring the receiver out of the standby state: NOTE: Technical Data 246 • Address mark — An address mark is a logic 1 in the most significant bit position of a received character. When the WAKE bit is set, an address mark wakes the receiver from the standby state by clearing the RWU bit. The address mark also sets the SCI receiver full bit, SCRF. Software can then compare the character containing the address mark to the user-defined address of the receiver. If they are the same, the receiver remains awake and processes the characters that follow. If they are not the same, software can set the RWU bit and put the receiver back into the standby state. • Idle input line condition — When the WAKE bit is clear, an idle character on the RxD pin wakes the receiver from the standby state by clearing the RWU bit. The idle character that wakes the receiver does not set the receiver idle bit, IDLE, or the SCI receiver full bit, SCRF. The idle line type bit, ILTY, determines whether the receiver begins counting logic 1s as idle character bits after the start bit or after the stop bit. Clearing the WAKE bit after the RxD pin has been idle may cause the receiver to wake up immediately. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI Functional Description 13.7.3.7 Receiver Interrupts The following sources can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI receiver: • SCI receiver full (SCRF) — The SCRF bit in SCS1 indicates that the receive shift register has transferred a character to the SCDR. SCRF can generate a receiver interrupt request. Setting the SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE, in SCC2 enables the SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupts. • Idle input (IDLE) — The IDLE bit in SCS1 indicates that 10 or 11 consecutive logic 1s shifted in from the RxD pin. The idle line interrupt enable bit, ILIE, in SCC2 enables the IDLE bit to generate CPU interrupt requests. 13.7.3.8 Error Interrupts The following receiver error flags in SCS1 can generate CPU interrupt requests: • Receiver overrun (OR) — The OR bit indicates that the receive shift register shifted in a new character before the previous character was read from the SCDR. The previous character remains in the SCDR, and the new character is lost. The overrun interrupt enable bit, ORIE, in SCC3 enables OR to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. • Noise flag (NF) — The NF bit is set when the SCI detects noise on incoming data or break characters, including start, data, and stop bits. The noise error interrupt enable bit, NEIE, in SCC3 enables NF to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. • Framing error (FE) — The FE bit in SCS1 is set when a logic 0 occurs where the receiver expects a stop bit. The framing error interrupt enable bit, FEIE, in SCC3 enables FE to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. • Parity error (PE) — The PE bit in SCS1 is set when the SCI detects a parity error in incoming data. The parity error interrupt enable bit, PEIE, in SCC3 enables PE to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 247 Infrared Serial Communications 13.8 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 13.8.1 Wait Mode The SCI module remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode, the SCI module registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the SCI module can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If SCI module functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by disabling the module before executing the WAIT instruction. Refer to 9.7 Low-Power Modes for information on exiting wait mode. 13.8.2 Stop Mode The SCI module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The STOP instruction does not affect SCI register states. SCI module operation resumes after an external interrupt. Because the internal clock is inactive during stop mode, entering stop mode during an SCI transmission or reception results in invalid data. Refer to 9.7 Low-Power Modes for information on exiting stop mode. Technical Data 248 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) SCI During Break Module Interrupts 13.9 SCI During Break Module Interrupts The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in other modules can be cleared during interrupts generated by the break module. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state. To protect status bits during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some status bits have a two-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does the first step on such a bit before the break, the bit cannot change during the break state as long as BCFE is at logic 0. After the break, doing the second step clears the status bit. 13.10 I/O Signals The two IRSCI I/O pins are: • PTB0/TxD — Transmit data • PTB1/RxD — Receive data 13.10.1 PTB0/TxD (Transmit Data) The PTB0/TxD pin is the serial data (standard or infrared) output from the SCI transmitter. The IRSCI shares the PTB0/TxD pin with port B. When the IRSCI is enabled, the PTB0/TxD pin is an output regardless of the state of the DDRB0 bit in data direction register B (DDRB). TxD pin has high current (15mA) sink capability when the LEDB0 bit is set in the port B LED control register ($000C). 13.10.2 PTB1/RxD (Receive Data) The PTB1/RxD pin is the serial data input to the IRSCI receiver. The IRSCI shares the PTB1/RxD pin with port B. When the IRSCI is enabled, the PTB1/RxD pin is an input regardless of the state of the DDRB1 bit in data direction register B (DDRB). MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 249 Infrared Serial Communications Table 13-5 shows a summary of I/O pin functions when the SCI is enabled. Table 13-5. SCI Pin Functions (Standard and Infrared) SCC1 [ENSCI] SCIRCR [IREN] SCC2 [TE] SCC2 [RE] 1 0 0 0 Hi-Z(1) Input ignored (terminate externally) 1 0 0 1 Hi-Z(1) Input sampled, pin should idle high 1 0 1 0 Output SCI (idle high) Input ignored (terminate externally) 1 0 1 1 Output SCI (idle high) Input sampled, pin should idle high 1 1 0 0 Hi-Z(1) Input ignored (terminate externally) 1 1 0 1 Hi-Z(1) Input sampled, pin should idle high 1 1 1 0 Output IR SCI (idle high) Input ignored (terminate externally) 1 1 1 1 Output IR SCI (idle high) Input sampled, pin should idle high 0 X X X Pins under port control (standard I/O port) TxD Pin RxD Pin Notes: 1. After completion of transmission in progress. 13.11 I/O Registers The following I/O registers control and monitor SCI operation: Technical Data 250 • SCI control register 1 (SCC1) • SCI control register 2 (SCC2) • SCI control register 3 (SCC3) • SCI status register 1 (SCS1) • SCI status register 2 (SCS2) • SCI data register (SCDR) • SCI baud rate register (SCBR) • SCI infrared control register (SCIRCR) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers 13.11.1 SCI Control Register 1 SCI control register: • Enables loop mode operation • Enables the SCI • Controls output polarity • Controls character length • Controls SCI wakeup method • Controls idle character detection • Enables parity function • Controls parity type Address: $0013 Bit 7 6 LOOPS ENSCI 0 0 Read: 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 M WAKE ILTY PEN PTY 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 Figure 13-12. SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1) LOOPS — Loop Mode Select Bit This read/write bit enables loop mode operation for the SCI only. In loop mode the RxD pin is disconnected from the SCI, and the transmitter output goes into the receiver input. Both the transmitter and the receiver must be enabled to use loop mode. The infrared encoder/decoder is not in the loop. Reset clears the LOOPS bit. 1 = Loop mode enabled 0 = Normal operation enabled ENSCI — Enable SCI Bit This read/write bit enables the SCI and the SCI baud rate generator. Clearing ENSCI sets the SCTE and TC bits in SCI status register 1 and disables transmitter interrupts. Reset clears the ENSCI bit. 1 = SCI enabled 0 = SCI disabled MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 251 Infrared Serial Communications M — Mode (Character Length) Bit This read/write bit determines whether SCI characters are eight or nine bits long. (See Table 13-6.) The ninth bit can serve as an extra stop bit, as a receiver wakeup signal, or as a parity bit. Reset clears the M bit. 1 = 9-bit SCI characters 0 = 8-bit SCI characters WAKE — Wakeup Condition Bit This read/write bit determines which condition wakes up the SCI: a logic 1 (address mark) in the most significant bit position of a received character or an idle condition on the RxD pin. Reset clears the WAKE bit. 1 = Address mark wakeup 0 = Idle line wakeup ILTY — Idle Line Type Bit This read/write bit determines when the SCI starts counting logic 1s as idle character bits. The counting begins either after the start bit or after the stop bit. If the count begins after the start bit, then a string of logic 1s preceding the stop bit may cause false recognition of an idle character. Beginning the count after the stop bit avoids false idle character recognition, but requires properly synchronized transmissions. Reset clears the ILTY bit. 1 = Idle character bit count begins after stop bit 0 = Idle character bit count begins after start bit PEN — Parity Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the SCI parity function. (See Table 13-6.) When enabled, the parity function inserts a parity bit in the most significant bit position. (See Figure 13-6.) Reset clears the PEN bit. 1 = Parity function enabled 0 = Parity function disabled Technical Data 252 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers PTY — Parity Bit This read/write bit determines whether the SCI generates and checks for odd parity or even parity. (See Table 13-6.) Reset clears the PTY bit. 1 = Odd parity 0 = Even parity NOTE: Changing the PTY bit in the middle of a transmission or reception can generate a parity error. Table 13-6. Character Format Selection Control Bits Character Format M PEN:PTY Start Bits Data Bits Parity Stop Bits Character Length 0 0X 1 8 None 1 10 bits 1 0X 1 9 None 1 11 bits 0 10 1 7 Even 1 10 bits 0 11 1 7 Odd 1 10 bits 1 10 1 8 Even 1 11 bits 1 11 1 8 Odd 1 11 bits 13.11.2 SCI Control Register 2 SCI control register 2: • Enables the following CPU interrupt requests: – Enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests – Enables the TC bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests – Enables the SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt requests – Enables the IDLE bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt requests • Enables the transmitter • Enables the receiver • Enables SCI wakeup • Transmits SCI break characters MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 253 Infrared Serial Communications Address: $0014 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 SCTIE TCIE SCRIE ILIE TE RE RWU SBK 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 13-13. SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2) SCTIE — SCI Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the SCTE bit to generate SCI transmitter CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SCTIE bit. 1 = SCTE enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = SCTE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt TCIE — Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the TC bit to generate SCI transmitter CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the TCIE bit. 1 = TC enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests 0 = TC not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests SCRIE — SCI Receive Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the SCRF bit to generate SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SCRIE bit. 1 = SCRF enabled to generate CPU interrupt 0 = SCRF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt ILIE — Idle Line Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the IDLE bit to generate SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the ILIE bit. 1 = IDLE enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests 0 = IDLE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests TE — Transmitter Enable Bit Setting this read/write bit begins the transmission by sending a preamble of 10 or 11 logic 1s from the transmit shift register to the TxD pin. If software clears the TE bit, the transmitter completes any transmission in progress before the TxD returns to the idle condition Technical Data 254 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers (logic 1). Clearing and then setting TE during a transmission queues an idle character to be sent after the character currently being transmitted. Reset clears the TE bit. 1 = Transmitter enabled 0 = Transmitter disabled NOTE: Writing to the TE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1. RE — Receiver Enable Bit Setting this read/write bit enables the receiver. Clearing the RE bit disables the receiver but does not affect receiver interrupt flag bits. Reset clears the RE bit. 1 = Receiver enabled 0 = Receiver disabled NOTE: Writing to the RE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1. RWU — Receiver Wakeup Bit This read/write bit puts the receiver in a standby state during which receiver interrupts are disabled. The WAKE bit in SCC1 determines whether an idle input or an address mark brings the receiver out of the standby state and clears the RWU bit. Reset clears the RWU bit. 1 = Standby state 0 = Normal operation SBK — Send Break Bit Setting and then clearing this read/write bit transmits a break character followed by a logic 1. The logic 1 after the break character guarantees recognition of a valid start bit. If SBK remains set, the transmitter continuously transmits break characters with no logic 1s between them. Reset clears the SBK bit. 1 = Transmit break characters 0 = No break characters being transmitted NOTE: Do not toggle the SBK bit immediately after setting the SCTE bit. Toggling SBK before the preamble begins causes the SCI to send a break character instead of a preamble. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 255 Infrared Serial Communications 13.11.3 SCI Control Register 3 SCI control register 3: • Stores the ninth SCI data bit received and the ninth SCI data bit to be transmitted • Enables the following interrupts: – Receiver overrun interrupts – Noise error interrupts – Framing error interrupts – Parity error interrupts Address: $0015 Bit 7 Read: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 T8 DMARE DMATE ORIE NEIE FEIE PEIE U 0 0 0 0 0 0 R8 Write: Reset: U = Unimplemented U = Unaffected Figure 13-14. SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3) R8 — Received Bit 8 When the SCI is receiving 9-bit characters, R8 is the read-only ninth bit (bit 8) of the received character. R8 is received at the same time that the SCDR receives the other 8 bits. When the SCI is receiving 8-bit characters, R8 is a copy of the eighth bit (bit 7). Reset has no effect on the R8 bit. T8 — Transmitted Bit 8 When the SCI is transmitting 9-bit characters, T8 is the read/write ninth bit (bit 8) of the transmitted character. T8 is loaded into the transmit shift register at the same time that the SCDR is loaded into the transmit shift register. Reset has no effect on the T8 bit. Technical Data 256 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers DMARE — DMA Receive Enable Bit CAUTION: The DMA module is not included on this MCU. Writing a logic 1 to DMARE or DMATE may adversely affect MCU performance. 1 = DMA not enabled to service SCI receiver DMA service requests generated by the SCRF bit (SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests enabled) 0 = DMA not enabled to service SCI receiver DMA service requests generated by the SCRF bit (SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests enabled) DMATE — DMA Transfer Enable Bit CAUTION: The DMA module is not included on this MCU. Writing a logic 1 to DMARE or DMATE may adversely affect MCU performance. 1 = SCTE DMA service requests enabled; SCTE CPU interrupt requests disabled 0 = SCTE DMA service requests disabled; SCTE CPU interrupt requests enabled ORIE — Receiver Overrun Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests generated by the receiver overrun bit, OR. Reset clears ORIE. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit disabled NEIE — Receiver Noise Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests generated by the noise error bit, NE. Reset clears NEIE. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit disabled FEIE — Receiver Framing Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests generated by the framing error bit, FE. Reset clears FEIE. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit disabled MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 257 Infrared Serial Communications PEIE — Receiver Parity Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables SCI receiver CPU interrupt requests generated by the parity error bit, PE. (See 13.11.4 SCI Status Register 1.) Reset clears PEIE. 1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit enabled 0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit disabled 13.11.4 SCI Status Register 1 SCI status register 1 contains flags to signal these conditions: • Transfer of SCDR data to transmit shift register complete • Transmission complete • Transfer of receive shift register data to SCDR complete • Receiver input idle • Receiver overrun • Noisy data • Framing error • Parity error Address: Read: $0016 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 SCTE TC SCRF IDLE OR NF FE PE 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: = Unimplemented Figure 13-15. SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1) SCTE — SCI Transmitter Empty Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCDR transfers a character to the transmit shift register. SCTE can generate an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request. When the SCTIE bit in SCC2 is set, SCTE generates an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request. In normal Technical Data 258 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers operation, clear the SCTE bit by reading SCS1 with SCTE set and then writing to SCDR. Reset sets the SCTE bit. 1 = SCDR data transferred to transmit shift register 0 = SCDR data not transferred to transmit shift register TC — Transmission Complete Bit This read-only bit is set when the SCTE bit is set, and no data, preamble, or break character is being transmitted. TC generates an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request if the TCIE bit in SCC2 is also set. TC is automatically cleared when data, preamble or break is queued and ready to be sent. There may be up to 1.5 transmitter clocks of latency between queueing data, preamble, and break and the transmission actually starting. Reset sets the TC bit. 1 = No transmission in progress 0 = Transmission in progress SCRF — SCI Receiver Full Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the data in the receive shift register transfers to the SCI data register. SCRF can generate an SCI receiver CPU interrupt request. When the SCRIE bit in SCC2 is set, SCRF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear the SCRF bit by reading SCS1 with SCRF set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears SCRF. 1 = Received data available in SCDR 0 = Data not available in SCDR IDLE — Receiver Idle Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when 10 or 11 consecutive logic 1s appear on the receiver input. IDLE generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the ILIE bit in SCC2 is also set. Clear the IDLE bit by reading SCS1 with IDLE set and then reading the SCDR. After the receiver is enabled, it must receive a valid character that sets the SCRF bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Also, after the IDLE bit has been cleared, a valid character must again set the SCRF bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Reset clears the IDLE bit. 1 = Receiver input idle 0 = Receiver input active (or idle since the IDLE bit was cleared) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 259 Infrared Serial Communications OR — Receiver Overrun Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when software fails to read the SCDR before the receive shift register receives the next character. The OR bit generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the ORIE bit in SCC3 is also set. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data already in the SCDR is not affected. Clear the OR bit by reading SCS1 with OR set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the OR bit. 1 = Receive shift register full and SCRF = 1 0 = No receiver overrun Software latency may allow an overrun to occur between reads of SCS1 and SCDR in the flag-clearing sequence. Figure 13-16 shows the normal flag-clearing sequence and an example of an overrun caused by a delayed flag-clearing sequence. The delayed read of SCDR does not clear the OR bit because OR was not set when SCS1 was read. Byte 2 caused the overrun and is lost. The next flagclearing sequence reads byte 3 in the SCDR instead of byte 2. In applications that are subject to software latency or in which it is important to know which byte is lost due to an overrun, the flagclearing routine can check the OR bit in a second read of SCS1 after reading the data register. NF — Receiver Noise Flag Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects noise on the RxD pin. NF generates an NF CPU interrupt request if the NEIE bit in SCC3 is also set. Clear the NF bit by reading SCS1 and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the NF bit. 1 = Noise detected 0 = No noise detected FE — Receiver Framing Error Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when a logic 0 is accepted as the stop bit. FE generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the FEIE bit in SCC3 also is set. Clear the FE bit by reading SCS1 with FE set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the FE bit. 1 = Framing error detected 0 = No framing error detected Technical Data 260 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 SCRF = 0 SCRF = 1 SCRF = 0 SCRF = 1 SCRF = 0 SCRF = 1 NORMAL FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE BYTE 4 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCDR BYTE 1 READ SCDR BYTE 2 READ SCDR BYTE 3 BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 SCRF = 0 OR = 0 SCRF = 1 OR = 1 SCRF = 0 OR = 1 SCRF = 1 SCRF = 1 OR = 1 DELAYED FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE BYTE 4 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 0 READ SCS1 SCRF = 1 OR = 1 READ SCDR BYTE 1 READ SCDR BYTE 3 Figure 13-16. Flag Clearing Sequence PE — Receiver Parity Error Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a parity error in incoming data. PE generates a PE CPU interrupt request if the PEIE bit in SCC3 is also set. Clear the PE bit by reading SCS1 with PE set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the PE bit. 1 = Parity error detected 0 = No parity error detected MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 261 Infrared Serial Communications 13.11.5 SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) SCI status register 2 contains flags to signal the following conditions: • Break character detected • Incoming data Address: $0017 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 Read: 1 Bit 0 BKF RPF 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 13-17. SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) BKF — Break Flag Bit This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a break character on the RxD pin. In SCS1, the FE and SCRF bits are also set. In 9-bit character transmissions, the R8 bit in SCC3 is cleared. BKF does not generate a CPU interrupt request. Clear BKF by reading SCS2 with BKF set and then reading the SCDR. Once cleared, BKF can become set again only after logic 1s again appear on the RxD pin followed by another break character. Reset clears the BKF bit. 1 = Break character detected 0 = No break character detected RPF — Reception in Progress Flag Bit This read-only bit is set when the receiver detects a logic 0 during the RT1 time period of the start bit search. RPF does not generate an interrupt request. RPF is reset after the receiver detects false start bits (usually from noise or a baud rate mismatch) or when the receiver detects an idle character. Polling RPF before disabling the SCI module or entering stop mode can show whether a reception is in progress. 1 = Reception in progress 0 = No reception in progress Technical Data 262 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers 13.11.6 SCI Data Register (SCDR) The SCI data register is the buffer between the internal data bus and the receive and transmit shift registers. Reset has no effect on data in the SCI data register. Address: $0018 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: R7 R6 R5 R4 R3 R2 R1 R0 Write: T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 Reset: Unaffected by reset Figure 13-18. SCI Data Register (SCDR) R7/T7–R0/T0 — Receive/Transmit Data Bits Reading the SCDR accesses the read-only received data bits, R7–R0. Writing to the SCDR writes the data to be transmitted, T7–T0. Reset has no effect on SCDR. NOTE: Do not use read/modify/write instructions on the SCI data register. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 263 Infrared Serial Communications 13.11.7 SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) The baud rate register selects the baud rate for both the receiver and the transmitter. Address: $0019 Bit 7 Read: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 SCP1 SCP0 R SCR2 SCR1 SCR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R = Reserved 0 CKS Write: Reset: 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 13-19. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) CKS — Baud Clock Input Select This read/write bit selects the source clock for the baud rate generator. Reset clears the CKS bit, selecting CGMXCLK. 1 = Bus clock drives the baud rate generator 0 = CGMXCLK drives the baud rate generator SCP1 and SCP0 — SCI Baud Rate Prescaler Bits These read/write bits select the baud rate prescaler divisor as shown in Table 13-7. Reset clears SCP1 and SCP0. Table 13-7. SCI Baud Rate Prescaling SCP1 and SCP0 Prescaler Divisor (PD) 00 1 01 3 10 4 11 13 SCR2–SCR0 — SCI Baud Rate Select Bits These read/write bits select the SCI baud rate divisor as shown in Table 13-8. Reset clears SCR2–SCR0. Technical Data 264 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers Table 13-8. SCI Baud Rate Selection SCR2, SCR1, and SCR0 Baud Rate Divisor (BD) 000 1 001 2 010 4 011 8 100 16 101 32 110 64 111 128 Use this formula to calculate the SCI baud rate: SCI clock source baud rate = --------------------------------------------16 × PD × BD where: SCI clock source = fBUS or CGMXCLK (selected by CKS bit) PD = prescaler divisor BD = baud rate divisor Table 13-9 shows the SCI baud rates that can be generated with a 4.9152-MHz bus clock when fBUS is selected as SCI clock source. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 265 Infrared Serial Communications Table 13-9. SCI Baud Rate Selection Examples SCP1 and SCP0 Prescaler Divisor (PD) SCR2, SCR1, and SCR0 Baud Rate Divisor (BD) Baud Rate (fBUS = 4.9152 MHz) 00 1 000 1 — 00 1 001 2 — 00 1 010 4 76800 00 1 011 8 38400 00 1 100 16 19200 00 1 101 32 9600 00 1 110 64 4800 00 1 111 128 2400 01 3 000 1 — 01 3 001 2 51200 01 3 010 4 25600 01 3 011 8 12800 01 3 100 16 6400 01 3 101 32 3200 01 3 110 64 1600 01 3 111 128 800 10 4 000 1 76800 10 4 001 2 38400 10 4 010 4 19200 10 4 011 8 9600 10 4 100 16 4800 10 4 101 32 2400 10 4 110 64 1200 10 4 111 128 600 11 13 000 1 23632 11 13 001 2 11816 11 13 010 4 5908 11 13 011 8 2954 11 13 100 16 1477 11 13 101 32 739 11 13 110 64 369 11 13 111 128 185 Technical Data 266 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) I/O Registers 13.11.8 SCI Infrared Control Register The infrared control register contains the control bits for the infrared submodule. • Enables the infrared sub-module • Selects the infrared transmitter narrow pulse width Address: $001A Bit 7 Read: 6 5 4 0 0 0 R 3 2 1 Bit 0 R TNP1 TNP0 IREN 0 0 0 0 R = Reserved Write: Reset: 0 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 Figure 13-20. SCI Infrared Control Register (SCIRCR) TNP1 and TNP0 — Transmitter Narrow Pulse Bits These read/write bits select the infrared transmitter narrow pulse width as shown in Table 13-10. Reset clears TNP1 and TNP0. Table 13-10. Infrared Narrow Pulse Selection TNP1 and TNP0 Prescaler Divisor (PD) 00 SCI transmits a 3/16 narrow pulse 01 SCI transmits a 1/16 narrow pulse 10 SCI transmits a 1/32 narrow pulse 11 IREN — Infrared Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the infrared sub-module for encoding and decoding the SCI data stream. When this bit is clear, the infrared submodule is disabled. Reset clears the IREN bit. 1 = infrared sub-module enabled 0 = infrared sub-module disabled MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) Technical Data 267 Infrared Serial Communications Technical Data 268 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 14. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.1 Contents 14.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 14.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270 14.4 Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses . . . . . . . 271 14.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271 14.5.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 14.5.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274 14.6 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 14.6.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 14.6.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276 14.6.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 14.6.4 Transmission Initiation Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 14.7 Queuing Transmission Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 14.8 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 14.8.1 Overflow Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284 14.9 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286 14.10 Resetting the SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 14.11 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289 14.11.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 14.11.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 14.12 SPI During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290 14.13 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 14.13.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 14.13.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 269 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.13.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292 14.13.4 SS (Slave Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 14.13.5 CGND (Clock Ground) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 14.14 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 14.14.1 SPI Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 14.14.2 SPI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296 14.14.3 SPI Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299 14.2 Introduction This section describes the serial peripheral interface (SPI) module, which allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communications with peripheral devices. 14.3 Features Features of the SPI module include the following: • Full-duplex operation • Master and slave modes • Double-buffered operation with separate transmit and receive registers • Four master mode frequencies (maximum = bus frequency ÷ 2) • Maximum slave mode frequency = bus frequency • Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase • Two separately enabled interrupts: – SPRF (SPI receiver full) – SPTE (SPI transmitter empty) • Mode fault error flag with CPU interrupt capability • Overflow error flag with CPU interrupt capability • Programmable wired-OR mode • I2C (inter-integrated circuit) compatibility • I/O (input/output) port bit(s) software configurable with pullup device(s) if configured as input port bit(s) Technical Data 270 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses 14.4 Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses The text that follows describes the SPI. The SPI I/O pin names are SS (slave select), SPSCK (SPI serial clock), CGND (clock ground), MOSI (master out slave in), and MISO (master in/slave out). The SPI shares four I/O pins with four parallel I/O ports. The full names of the SPI I/O pins are shown in Table 14-1. The generic pin names appear in the text that follows. Table 14-1. Pin Name Conventions SPI Generic Pin Names: MISO MOSI SS Full SPI Pin Names: SPI PTD1/MISO PTD2/MOSI PTD0/SS SPSCK CGND PTD3/SPSCK VSS Figure 14-1 summarizes the SPI I/O registers. = Addr. Register Name $0010 Read: SPI Control Register Write: (SPCR) Reset: $0011 Read: SPI Status and Control Register Write: (SPSCR) Reset: $0012 Read: SPI Data Register Write: (SPDR) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 SPRIE R SPMSTR CPOL CPHA SPWOM SPE SPTIE 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 OVRF MODF SPTE MODFEN SPR1 SPR0 SPRF ERRIE 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 R7 R6 R5 R4 R3 R2 R1 R0 T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 Unaffected by reset = Unimplemented R = Reserved Figure 14-1. SPI I/O Register Summary 14.5 Functional Description Figure 14-2 shows the structure of the SPI module. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 271 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) INTERNAL BUS TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER CGMOUT ÷ 2 FROM SIM SHIFT REGISTER 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 MISO 0 ÷2 MOSI ÷8 CLOCK DIVIDER ÷ 32 RECEIVE DATA REGISTER PIN CONTROL LOGIC ÷ 128 SPMSTR SPE CLOCK SELECT SPR1 SPSCK M CLOCK LOGIC S SS SPR0 SPMSTR RESERVED MODFEN TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST RESERVED CPHA CPOL SPWOM ERRIE SPI CONTROL SPTIE SPRIE RECEIVER/ERROR CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST R SPE SPRF SPTE OVRF MODF Figure 14-2. SPI Module Block Diagram The SPI module allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communication between the MCU and peripheral devices, including other MCUs. Software can poll the SPI status flags or SPI operation can be interruptdriven. The following paragraphs describe the operation of the SPI module. Technical Data 272 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Functional Description 14.5.1 Master Mode The SPI operates in master mode when the SPI master bit, SPMSTR, is set. NOTE: Configure the SPI modules as master or slave before enabling them. Enable the master SPI before enabling the slave SPI. Disable the slave SPI before disabling the master SPI. (See 14.14.1 SPI Control Register.) Only a master SPI module can initiate transmissions. Software begins the transmission from a master SPI module by writing to the transmit data register. If the shift register is empty, the byte immediately transfers to the shift register, setting the SPI transmitter empty bit, SPTE. The byte begins shifting out on the MOSI pin under the control of the serial clock. (See Figure 14-3.) MASTER MCU SHIFT REGISTER SLAVE MCU MISO MISO MOSI MOSI SPSCK BAUD RATE GENERATOR SS SHIFT REGISTER SPSCK VDD SS Figure 14-3. Full-Duplex Master-Slave Connections MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 273 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) The SPR1 and SPR0 bits control the baud rate generator and determine the speed of the shift register. (See 14.14.2 SPI Status and Control Register.) Through the SPSCK pin, the baud rate generator of the master also controls the shift register of the slave peripheral. As the byte shifts out on the MOSI pin of the master, another byte shifts in from the slave on the master’s MISO pin. The transmission ends when the receiver full bit, SPRF, becomes set. At the same time that SPRF becomes set, the byte from the slave transfers to the receive data register. In normal operation, SPRF signals the end of a transmission. Software clears SPRF by reading the SPI status and control register with SPRF set and then reading the SPI data register. Writing to the SPI data register clears the SPTE bit. 14.5.2 Slave Mode The SPI operates in slave mode when the SPMSTR bit is clear. In slave mode, the SPSCK pin is the input for the serial clock from the master MCU. Before a data transmission occurs, the SS pin of the slave SPI must be at logic 0. SS must remain low until the transmission is complete. (See 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error.) In a slave SPI module, data enters the shift register under the control of the serial clock from the master SPI module. After a byte enters the shift register of a slave SPI, it transfers to the receive data register, and the SPRF bit is set. To prevent an overflow condition, slave software then must read the receive data register before another full byte enters the shift register. The maximum frequency of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave is the bus clock speed (which is twice as fast as the fastest master SPSCK clock that can be generated). The frequency of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave does not have to correspond to any SPI baud rate. The baud rate only controls the speed of the SPSCK generated by an SPI configured as a master. Therefore, the frequency of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave can be any frequency less than or equal to the bus speed. Technical Data 274 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Transmission Formats When the master SPI starts a transmission, the data in the slave shift register begins shifting out on the MISO pin. The slave can load its shift register with a new byte for the next transmission by writing to its transmit data register. The slave must write to its transmit data register at least one bus cycle before the master starts the next transmission. Otherwise, the byte already in the slave shift register shifts out on the MISO pin. Data written to the slave shift register during a transmission remains in a buffer until the end of the transmission. When the clock phase bit (CPHA) is set, the first edge of SPSCK starts a transmission. When CPHA is clear, the falling edge of SS starts a transmission. (See 14.6 Transmission Formats.) NOTE: SPSCK must be in the proper idle state before the slave is enabled to prevent SPSCK from appearing as a clock edge. 14.6 Transmission Formats During an SPI transmission, data is simultaneously transmitted (shifted out serially) and received (shifted in serially). A serial clock synchronizes shifting and sampling on the two serial data lines. A slave select line allows selection of an individual slave SPI device; slave devices that are not selected do not interfere with SPI bus activities. On a master SPI device, the slave select line can optionally be used to indicate multiplemaster bus contention. 14.6.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls Software can select any of four combinations of serial clock (SPSCK) phase and polarity using two bits in the SPI control register (SPCR). The clock polarity is specified by the CPOL control bit, which selects an active high or low clock and has no significant effect on the transmission format. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 275 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) The clock phase (CPHA) control bit selects one of two fundamentally different transmission formats. The clock phase and polarity should be identical for the master SPI device and the communicating slave device. In some cases, the phase and polarity are changed between transmissions to allow a master device to communicate with peripheral slaves having different requirements. NOTE: Before writing to the CPOL bit or the CPHA bit, disable the SPI by clearing the SPI enable bit (SPE). 14.6.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0 Figure 14-4 shows an SPI transmission in which CPHA is logic 0. The figure should not be used as a replacement for data sheet parametric information. Two waveforms are shown for SPSCK: one for CPOL = 0 and another for CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram since the serial clock (SPSCK), master in/slave out (MISO), and master out/slave in (MOSI) pins are directly connected between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS line is the slave select input to the slave. The slave SPI drives its MISO output only when its slave select input (SS) is at logic 0, so that only the selected slave drives to the master. The SS pin of the master is not shown but is assumed to be inactive. The SS pin of the master must be high or must be reconfigured as general-purpose I/O not affecting the SPI. (See 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error.) When CPHA = 0, the first SPSCK edge is the MSB capture strobe. Therefore, the slave must begin driving its data before the first SPSCK edge, and a falling edge on the SS pin is used to start the slave data transmission. The slave’s SS pin must be toggled back to high and then low again between each byte transmitted as shown in Figure 14-5. Technical Data 276 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Transmission Formats SPSCK CYCLE # FOR REFERENCE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 LSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 LSB SPSCK; CPOL = 0 SPSCK; CPOL =1 MOSI FROM MASTER MISO FROM SLAVE MSB SS; TO SLAVE CAPTURE STROBE Figure 14-4. Transmission Format (CPHA = 0) MISO/MOSI BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 MASTER SS SLAVE SS CPHA = 0 SLAVE SS CPHA = 1 Figure 14-5. CPHA/SS Timing When CPHA = 0 for a slave, the falling edge of SS indicates the beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle state and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data. Once the transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register from the transmit data register. Therefore, the SPI data register of the slave must be loaded with transmit data before the falling edge of SS. Any data written after the falling edge is stored in the transmit data register and transferred to the shift register after the current transmission. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 277 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.6.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1 Figure 14-6 shows an SPI transmission in which CPHA is logic 1. The figure should not be used as a replacement for data sheet parametric information. Two waveforms are shown for SPSCK: one for CPOL = 0 and another for CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master or slave timing diagram since the serial clock (SPSCK), master in/slave out (MISO), and master out/slave in (MOSI) pins are directly connected between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS line is the slave select input to the slave. The slave SPI drives its MISO output only when its slave select input (SS) is at logic 0, so that only the selected slave drives to the master. The SS pin of the master is not shown but is assumed to be inactive. The SS pin of the master must be high or must be reconfigured as general-purpose I/O not affecting the SPI. (See 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error.) When CPHA = 1, the master begins driving its MOSI pin on the first SPSCK edge. Therefore, the slave uses the first SPSCK edge as a start transmission signal. The SS pin can remain low between transmissions. This format may be preferable in systems having only one master and only one slave driving the MISO data line. SPSCK CYCLE # FOR REFERENCE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MOSI FROM MASTER MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 LSB MISO FROM SLAVE MSB BIT 6 BIT 5 BIT 4 BIT 3 BIT 2 BIT 1 SPSCK; CPOL = 0 SPSCK; CPOL =1 LSB SS; TO SLAVE CAPTURE STROBE Figure 14-6. Transmission Format (CPHA = 1) Technical Data 278 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Transmission Formats When CPHA = 1 for a slave, the first edge of the SPSCK indicates the beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle state and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data. Once the transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register from the transmit data register. Therefore, the SPI data register of the slave must be loaded with transmit data before the first edge of SPSCK. Any data written after the first edge is stored in the transmit data register and transferred to the shift register after the current transmission. 14.6.4 Transmission Initiation Latency When the SPI is configured as a master (SPMSTR = 1), writing to the SPDR starts a transmission. CPHA has no effect on the delay to the start of the transmission, but it does affect the initial state of the SPSCK signal. When CPHA = 0, the SPSCK signal remains inactive for the first half of the first SPSCK cycle. When CPHA = 1, the first SPSCK cycle begins with an edge on the SPSCK line from its inactive to its active level. The SPI clock rate (selected by SPR1:SPR0) affects the delay from the write to SPDR and the start of the SPI transmission. (See Figure 14-7.) The internal SPI clock in the master is a free-running derivative of the internal MCU clock. To conserve power, it is enabled only when both the SPE and SPMSTR bits are set. SPSCK edges occur halfway through the low time of the internal MCU clock. Since the SPI clock is free-running, it is uncertain where the write to the SPDR occurs relative to the slower SPSCK. This uncertainty causes the variation in the initiation delay shown in Figure 14-7. This delay is no longer than a single SPI bit time. That is, the maximum delay is two MCU bus cycles for DIV2, eight MCU bus cycles for DIV8, 32 MCU bus cycles for DIV32, and 128 MCU bus cycles for DIV128. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 279 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) WRITE TO SPDR INITIATION DELAY BUS CLOCK MOSI MSB BIT 6 1 2 BIT 5 SPSCK CPHA = 1 SPSCK CPHA = 0 SPSCK CYCLE NUMBER 3 INITIATION DELAY FROM WRITE SPDR TO TRANSFER BEGIN         WRITE TO SPDR BUS CLOCK EARLIEST LATEST WRITE TO SPDR SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 2; 2 POSSIBLE START POINTS BUS CLOCK EARLIEST WRITE TO SPDR SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 8; 8 POSSIBLE START POINTS LATEST SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 32; 32 POSSIBLE START POINTS LATEST SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 128; 128 POSSIBLE START POINTS LATEST BUS CLOCK EARLIEST WRITE TO SPDR BUS CLOCK EARLIEST Figure 14-7. Transmission Start Delay (Master) Technical Data 280 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Queuing Transmission Data 14.7 Queuing Transmission Data The double-buffered transmit data register allows a data byte to be queued and transmitted. For an SPI configured as a master, a queued data byte is transmitted immediately after the previous transmission has completed. The SPI transmitter empty flag (SPTE) indicates when the transmit data buffer is ready to accept new data. Write to the transmit data register only when the SPTE bit is high. Figure 14-8 shows the timing associated with doing back-to-back transmissions with the SPI (SPSCK has CPHA: CPOL = 1:0). WRITE TO SPDR SPTE 1 3 8 5 2 10 SPSCK CPHA:CPOL = 1:0 MOSI MSB BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT LSB MSB BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT LSB MSB BIT BIT BIT 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 9 4 SPRF 6 READ SPSCR 11 7 READ SPDR 12 1 CPU WRITES BYTE 1 TO SPDR, CLEARING SPTE BIT. 7 CPU READS SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. 2 BYTE 1 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT. 8 3 CPU WRITES BYTE 2 TO SPDR, QUEUEING BYTE 2 AND CLEARING SPTE BIT. FIRST INCOMING BYTE TRANSFERS FROM SHIFT REGISTER TO RECEIVE DATA REGISTER, SETTING SPRF BIT. 5 BYTE 2 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT. 6 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET. 4 CPU WRITES BYTE 3 TO SPDR, QUEUEING BYTE 3 AND CLEARING SPTE BIT. 9 SECOND INCOMING BYTE TRANSFERS FROM SHIFT REGISTER TO RECEIVE DATA REGISTER, SETTING SPRF BIT. 10 BYTE 3 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT. 11 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET. 12 CPU READS SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. Figure 14-8. SPRF/SPTE CPU Interrupt Timing The transmit data buffer allows back-to-back transmissions without the slave precisely timing its writes between transmissions as in a system with a single data buffer. Also, if no new data is written to the data buffer, the last value contained in the shift register is the next data word to be transmitted. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 281 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) For an idle master or idle slave that has no data loaded into its transmit buffer, the SPTE is set again no more than two bus cycles after the transmit buffer empties into the shift register. This allows the user to queue up a 16-bit value to send. For an already active slave, the load of the shift register cannot occur until the transmission is completed. This implies that a back-to-back write to the transmit data register is not possible. The SPTE indicates when the next write can occur. 14.8 Error Conditions The following flags signal SPI error conditions: • Overflow (OVRF) — Failing to read the SPI data register before the next full byte enters the shift register sets the OVRF bit. The new byte does not transfer to the receive data register, and the unread byte still can be read. OVRF is in the SPI status and control register. • Mode fault error (MODF) — The MODF bit indicates that the voltage on the slave select pin (SS) is inconsistent with the mode of the SPI. MODF is in the SPI status and control register. 14.8.1 Overflow Error The overflow flag (OVRF) becomes set if the receive data register still has unread data from a previous transmission when the capture strobe of bit 1 of the next transmission occurs. The bit 1 capture strobe occurs in the middle of SPSCK cycle 7. (See Figure 14-4 and Figure 14-6.) If an overflow occurs, all data received after the overflow and before the OVRF bit is cleared does not transfer to the receive data register and does not set the SPI receiver full bit (SPRF). The unread data that transferred to the receive data register before the overflow occurred can still be read. Therefore, an overflow error always indicates the loss of data. Clear the overflow flag by reading the SPI status and control register and then reading the SPI data register. OVRF generates a receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) is also set. The SPRF, MODF, and OVRF Technical Data 282 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Error Conditions interrupts share the same CPU interrupt vector. (See Figure 14-11.) It is not possible to enable MODF or OVRF individually to generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. However, leaving MODFEN low prevents MODF from being set. If the CPU SPRF interrupt is enabled and the OVRF interrupt is not, watch for an overflow condition. Figure 14-9 shows how it is possible to miss an overflow. The first part of Figure 14-9 shows how it is possible to read the SPSCR and SPDR to clear the SPRF without problems. However, as illustrated by the second transmission example, the OVRF bit can be set in between the time that SPSCR and SPDR are read. BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 BYTE 4 1 4 6 8 SPRF OVRF READ SPSCR 2 READ SPDR 5 3 1 BYTE 1 SETS SPRF BIT. 2 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. CPU READS BYTE 1 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. BYTE 2 SETS SPRF BIT. 3 4 7 5 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. 6 BYTE 3 SETS OVRF BIT. BYTE 3 IS LOST. 7 CPU READS BYTE 2 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT, BUT NOT OVRF BIT. 8 BYTE 4 FAILS TO SET SPRF BIT BECAUSE OVRF BIT IS NOT CLEARED. BYTE 4 IS LOST. Figure 14-9. Missed Read of Overflow Condition In this case, an overflow can be missed easily. Since no more SPRF interrupts can be generated until this OVRF is serviced, it is not obvious that bytes are being lost as more transmissions are completed. To prevent this, either enable the OVRF interrupt or do another read of the SPSCR following the read of the SPDR. This ensures that the OVRF was not set before the SPRF was cleared and that future transmissions can set the SPRF bit. Figure 14-10 illustrates this process. Generally, to avoid this second SPSCR read, enable the OVRF to the CPU by setting the ERRIE bit. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 283 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) BYTE 1 SPI RECEIVE COMPLETE BYTE 2 5 1 BYTE 3 7 BYTE 4 11 SPRF OVRF READ SPSCR 2 READ SPDR 4 6 3 1 BYTE 1 SETS SPRF BIT. 2 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. CPU READS BYTE 1 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. 3 9 8 12 14 10 13 8 CPU READS BYTE 2 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. 9 CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN TO CHECK OVRF BIT. 10 CPU READS BYTE 2 SPDR, CLEARING OVRF BIT. 4 CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN TO CHECK OVRF BIT. 11 BYTE 4 SETS SPRF BIT. 5 BYTE 2 SETS SPRF BIT. 12 CPU READS SPSCR. 6 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET AND OVRF BIT CLEAR. 13 CPU READS BYTE 4 IN SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT. 7 BYTE 3 SETS OVRF BIT. BYTE 3 IS LOST. 14 CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN TO CHECK OVRF BIT. Figure 14-10. Clearing SPRF When OVRF Interrupt Is Not Enabled 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error Setting the SPMSTR bit selects master mode and configures the SPSCK and MOSI pins as outputs and the MISO pin as an input. Clearing SPMSTR selects slave mode and configures the SPSCK and MOSI pins as inputs and the MISO pin as an output. The mode fault bit, MODF, becomes set any time the state of the slave select pin, SS, is inconsistent with the mode selected by SPMSTR. To prevent SPI pin contention and damage to the MCU, a mode fault error occurs if: • The SS pin of a slave SPI goes high during a transmission • The SS pin of a master SPI goes low at any time For the MODF flag to be set, the mode fault error enable bit (MODFEN) must be set. Clearing the MODFEN bit does not clear the MODF flag but does prevent MODF from being set again after MODF is cleared. Technical Data 284 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Error Conditions MODF generates a receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) is also set. The SPRF, MODF, and OVRF interrupts share the same CPU interrupt vector. (See Figure 14-11.) It is not possible to enable MODF or OVRF individually to generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. However, leaving MODFEN low prevents MODF from being set. In a master SPI with the mode fault enable bit (MODFEN) set, the mode fault flag (MODF) is set if SS goes to logic 0. A mode fault in a master SPI causes the following events to occur: NOTE: • If ERRIE = 1, the SPI generates an SPI receiver/error CPU interrupt request. • The SPE bit is cleared. • The SPTE bit is set. • The SPI state counter is cleared. • The data direction register of the shared I/O port regains control of port drivers. To prevent bus contention with another master SPI after a mode fault error, clear all SPI bits of the data direction register of the shared I/O port before enabling the SPI. When configured as a slave (SPMSTR = 0), the MODF flag is set if SS goes high during a transmission. When CPHA = 0, a transmission begins when SS goes low and ends once the incoming SPSCK goes back to its idle level following the shift of the eighth data bit. When CPHA = 1, the transmission begins when the SPSCK leaves its idle level and SS is already low. The transmission continues until the SPSCK returns to its idle level following the shift of the last data bit. (See 14.6 Transmission Formats.) NOTE: Setting the MODF flag does not clear the SPMSTR bit. The SPMSTR bit has no function when SPE = 0. Reading SPMSTR when MODF = 1 shows the difference between a MODF occurring when the SPI is a master and when it is a slave. When CPHA = 0, a MODF occurs if a slave is selected (SS is at logic 0) and later unselected (SS is at logic 1) even if no SPSCK is sent to that MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 285 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) slave. This happens because SS at logic 0 indicates the start of the transmission (MISO driven out with the value of MSB) for CPHA = 0. When CPHA = 1, a slave can be selected and then later unselected with no transmission occurring. Therefore, MODF does not occur since a transmission was never begun. In a slave SPI (MSTR = 0), the MODF bit generates an SPI receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the ERRIE bit is set. The MODF bit does not clear the SPE bit or reset the SPI in any way. Software can abort the SPI transmission by clearing the SPE bit of the slave. NOTE: A logic 1 voltage on the SS pin of a slave SPI puts the MISO pin in a high impedance state. Also, the slave SPI ignores all incoming SPSCK clocks, even if it was already in the middle of a transmission. To clear the MODF flag, read the SPSCR with the MODF bit set and then write to the SPCR register. This entire clearing mechanism must occur with no MODF condition existing or else the flag is not cleared. 14.9 Interrupts Four SPI status flags can be enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests. Table 14-2. SPI Interrupts Flag Request SPTE Transmitter empty SPI transmitter CPU interrupt request (SPTIE = 1, SPE = 1) SPRF Receiver full SPI receiver CPU interrupt request (SPRIE = 1) OVRF Overflow SPI receiver/error interrupt request (ERRIE = 1) MODF Mode fault SPI receiver/error interrupt request (ERRIE = 1) Technical Data 286 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Interrupts Reading the SPI status and control register with SPRF set and then reading the receive data register clears SPRF. The clearing mechanism for the SPTE flag is always just a write to the transmit data register. The SPI transmitter interrupt enable bit (SPTIE) enables the SPTE flag to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests, provided that the SPI is enabled (SPE = 1). The SPI receiver interrupt enable bit (SPRIE) enables the SPRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt requests, regardless of the state of the SPE bit. (See Figure 14-11.) The error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) enables both the MODF and OVRF bits to generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. The mode fault enable bit (MODFEN) can prevent the MODF flag from being set so that only the OVRF bit is enabled by the ERRIE bit to generate receiver/error CPU interrupt requests. NOT AVAILABLE SPTE SPTIE SPE SPI TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST R NOT AVAILABLE SPRIE SPRF SPI RECEIVER/ERROR CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST ERRIE MODF OVRF Figure 14-11. SPI Interrupt Request Generation MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 287 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) The following sources in the SPI status and control register can generate CPU interrupt requests: • SPI receiver full bit (SPRF) — The SPRF bit becomes set every time a byte transfers from the shift register to the receive data register. If the SPI receiver interrupt enable bit, SPRIE, is also set, SPRF generates an SPI receiver/error CPU interrupt request. • SPI transmitter empty (SPTE) — The SPTE bit becomes set every time a byte transfers from the transmit data register to the shift register. If the SPI transmit interrupt enable bit, SPTIE, is also set, SPTE generates an SPTE CPU interrupt request. 14.10 Resetting the SPI Any system reset completely resets the SPI. Partial resets occur whenever the SPI enable bit (SPE) is low. Whenever SPE is low, the following occurs: • The SPTE flag is set. • Any transmission currently in progress is aborted. • The shift register is cleared. • The SPI state counter is cleared, making it ready for a new complete transmission. • All the SPI port logic is defaulted back to being general-purpose I/O. These items are reset only by a system reset: • All control bits in the SPCR register • All control bits in the SPSCR register (MODFEN, ERRIE, SPR1, and SPR0) • The status flags SPRF, OVRF, and MODF By not resetting the control bits when SPE is low, the user can clear SPE between transmissions without having to set all control bits again when SPE is set back high for the next transmission. Technical Data 288 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Low-Power Modes By not resetting the SPRF, OVRF, and MODF flags, the user can still service these interrupts after the SPI has been disabled. The user can disable the SPI by writing 0 to the SPE bit. The SPI can also be disabled by a mode fault occurring in an SPI that was configured as a master with the MODFEN bit set. 14.11 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 14.11.1 Wait Mode The SPI module remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In wait mode the SPI module registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the SPI module can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If SPI module functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power consumption by disabling the SPI module before executing the WAIT instruction. To exit wait mode when an overflow condition occurs, enable the OVRF bit to generate CPU interrupt requests by setting the error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE). (See 14.9 Interrupts.) 14.11.2 Stop Mode The SPI module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The STOP instruction does not affect register conditions. SPI operation resumes after an external interrupt. If stop mode is exited by reset, any transfer in progress is aborted, and the SPI is reset. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 289 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.12 SPI During Break Interrupts The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in other modules can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. (See Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM).) To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state. To protect status bits during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some status bits have a 2-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does the first step on such a bit before the break, the bit cannot change during the break state as long as BCFE is at logic 0. After the break, doing the second step clears the status bit. Since the SPTE bit cannot be cleared during a break with the BCFE bit cleared, a write to the transmit data register in break mode does not initiate a transmission nor is this data transferred into the shift register. Therefore, a write to the SPDR in break mode with the BCFE bit cleared has no effect. 14.13 I/O Signals The SPI module has five I/O pins and shares four of them with a parallel I/O port. They are: • MISO — Data received • MOSI — Data transmitted • SPSCK — Serial clock • SS — Slave select • CGND — Clock ground (internally connected to VSS) Technical Data 290 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) I/O Signals The SPI has limited inter-integrated circuit (I2C) capability (requiring software support) as a master in a single-master environment. To communicate with I2C peripherals, MOSI becomes an open-drain output when the SPWOM bit in the SPI control register is set. In I2C communication, the MOSI and MISO pins are connected to a bidirectional pin from the I2C peripheral and through a pullup resistor to VDD. 14.13.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) MISO is one of the two SPI module pins that transmits serial data. In full duplex operation, the MISO pin of the master SPI module is connected to the MISO pin of the slave SPI module. The master SPI simultaneously receives data on its MISO pin and transmits data from its MOSI pin. Slave output data on the MISO pin is enabled only when the SPI is configured as a slave. The SPI is configured as a slave when its SPMSTR bit is logic 0 and its SS pin is at logic 0. To support a multipleslave system, a logic 1 on the SS pin puts the MISO pin in a highimpedance state. When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the MISO pin regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. 14.13.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) MOSI is one of the two SPI module pins that transmits serial data. In fullduplex operation, the MOSI pin of the master SPI module is connected to the MOSI pin of the slave SPI module. The master SPI simultaneously transmits data from its MOSI pin and receives data on its MISO pin. When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the MOSI pin regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 291 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.13.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock) The serial clock synchronizes data transmission between master and slave devices. In a master MCU, the SPSCK pin is the clock output. In a slave MCU, the SPSCK pin is the clock input. In full-duplex operation, the master and slave MCUs exchange a byte of data in eight serial clock cycles. When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the SPSCK pin regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. 14.13.4 SS (Slave Select) The SS pin has various functions depending on the current state of the SPI. For an SPI configured as a slave, the SS is used to select a slave. For CPHA = 0, the SS is used to define the start of a transmission. (See 14.6 Transmission Formats.) Since it is used to indicate the start of a transmission, the SS must be toggled high and low between each byte transmitted for the CPHA = 0 format. However, it can remain low between transmissions for the CPHA = 1 format. See Figure 14-12. MISO/MOSI BYTE 1 BYTE 2 BYTE 3 MASTER SS SLAVE SS CPHA = 0 SLAVE SS CPHA = 1 Figure 14-12. CPHA/SS Timing When an SPI is configured as a slave, the SS pin is always configured as an input. It cannot be used as a general-purpose I/O regardless of the state of the MODFEN control bit. However, the MODFEN bit can still prevent the state of the SS from creating a MODF error. (See 14.14.2 SPI Status and Control Register.) NOTE: A logic 1 voltage on the SS pin of a slave SPI puts the MISO pin in a highimpedance state. The slave SPI ignores all incoming SPSCK clocks, even if it was already in the middle of a transmission. Technical Data 292 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) I/O Signals When an SPI is configured as a master, the SS input can be used in conjunction with the MODF flag to prevent multiple masters from driving MOSI and SPSCK. (See 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error.) For the state of the SS pin to set the MODF flag, the MODFEN bit in the SPSCK register must be set. If the MODFEN bit is low for an SPI master, the SS pin can be used as a general-purpose I/O under the control of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. With MODFEN high, it is an input-only pin to the SPI regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared I/O port. The CPU can always read the state of the SS pin by configuring the appropriate pin as an input and reading the port data register. (See Table 14-3.) Table 14-3. SPI Configuration SPE SPMSTR MODFEN SPI Configuration State of SS Logic 0 X(1) X Not enabled General-purpose I/O; SS ignored by SPI 1 0 X Slave Input-only to SPI 1 1 0 Master without MODF General-purpose I/O; SS ignored by SPI 1 1 1 Master with MODF Input-only to SPI Note 1. X = Don’t care 14.13.5 CGND (Clock Ground) CGND is the ground return for the serial clock pin, SPSCK, and the ground for the port output buffers. It is internally connected to VSS as shown in Table 14-1. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 293 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.14 I/O Registers Three registers control and monitor SPI operation: • SPI control register (SPCR) • SPI status and control register (SPSCR) • SPI data register (SPDR) 14.14.1 SPI Control Register The SPI control register: • Enables SPI module interrupt requests • Configures the SPI module as master or slave • Selects serial clock polarity and phase • Configures the SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins as open-drain outputs • Enables the SPI module Address: $0010 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 SPRIE R SPMSTR CPOL CPHA SPWOM SPE SPTIE 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: = Unimplemented R = Reserved Figure 14-13. SPI Control Register (SPCR) SPRIE — SPI Receiver Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables CPU interrupt requests generated by the SPRF bit. The SPRF bit is set when a byte transfers from the shift register to the receive data register. Reset clears the SPRIE bit. 1 = SPRF CPU interrupt requests enabled 0 = SPRF CPU interrupt requests disabled Technical Data 294 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) I/O Registers SPMSTR — SPI Master Bit This read/write bit selects master mode operation or slave mode operation. Reset sets the SPMSTR bit. 1 = Master mode 0 = Slave mode CPOL — Clock Polarity Bit This read/write bit determines the logic state of the SPSCK pin between transmissions. (See Figure 14-4 and Figure 14-6.) To transmit data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have identical CPOL values. Reset clears the CPOL bit. CPHA — Clock Phase Bit This read/write bit controls the timing relationship between the serial clock and SPI data. (See Figure 14-4 and Figure 14-6.) To transmit data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have identical CPHA values. When CPHA = 0, the SS pin of the slave SPI module must be set to logic 1 between bytes. (See Figure 14-12.) Reset sets the CPHA bit. SPWOM — SPI Wired-OR Mode Bit This read/write bit disables the pullup devices on pins SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO so that those pins become open-drain outputs. 1 = Wired-OR SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins 0 = Normal push-pull SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins SPE — SPI Enable This read/write bit enables the SPI module. Clearing SPE causes a partial reset of the SPI. (See 14.10 Resetting the SPI.) Reset clears the SPE bit. 1 = SPI module enabled 0 = SPI module disabled SPTIE— SPI Transmit Interrupt Enable This read/write bit enables CPU interrupt requests generated by the SPTE bit. SPTE is set when a byte transfers from the transmit data register to the shift register. Reset clears the SPTIE bit. 1 = SPTE CPU interrupt requests enabled 0 = SPTE CPU interrupt requests disabled MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 295 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 14.14.2 SPI Status and Control Register The SPI status and control register contains flags to signal these conditions: • Receive data register full • Failure to clear SPRF bit before next byte is received (overflow error) • Inconsistent logic level on SS pin (mode fault error) • Transmit data register empty The SPI status and control register also contains bits that perform these functions: • Enable error interrupts • Enable mode fault error detection • Select master SPI baud rate Address: $0011 Bit 7 Read: 6 SPRF 5 4 3 OVRF MODF SPTE ERRIE 2 1 Bit 0 MODFEN SPR1 SPR0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 0 0 1 = Unimplemented Figure 14-14. SPI Status and Control Register (SPSCR) SPRF — SPI Receiver Full Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set each time a byte transfers from the shift register to the receive data register. SPRF generates a CPU interrupt request if the SPRIE bit in the SPI control register is set also. During an SPRF CPU interrupt, the CPU clears SPRF by reading the SPI status and control register with SPRF set and then reading the SPI data register. Reset clears the SPRF bit. 1 = Receive data register full 0 = Receive data register not full Technical Data 296 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) I/O Registers ERRIE — Error Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the MODF and OVRF bits to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the ERRIE bit. 1 = MODF and OVRF can generate CPU interrupt requests 0 = MODF and OVRF cannot generate CPU interrupt requests OVRF — Overflow Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set if software does not read the byte in the receive data register before the next full byte enters the shift register. In an overflow condition, the byte already in the receive data register is unaffected, and the byte that shifted in last is lost. Clear the OVRF bit by reading the SPI status and control register with OVRF set and then reading the receive data register. Reset clears the OVRF bit. 1 = Overflow 0 = No overflow MODF — Mode Fault Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set in a slave SPI if the SS pin goes high during a transmission with the MODFEN bit set. In a master SPI, the MODF flag is set if the SS pin goes low at any time with the MODFEN bit set. Clear the MODF bit by reading the SPI status and control register (SPSCR) with MODF set and then writing to the SPI control register (SPCR). Reset clears the MODF bit. 1 = SS pin at inappropriate logic level 0 = SS pin at appropriate logic level SPTE — SPI Transmitter Empty Bit This clearable, read-only flag is set each time the transmit data register transfers a byte into the shift register. SPTE generates an SPTE CPU interrupt request if the SPTIE bit in the SPI control register is set also. NOTE: Do not write to the SPI data register unless the SPTE bit is high. During an SPTE CPU interrupt, the CPU clears the SPTE bit by writing to the transmit data register. Reset sets the SPTE bit. 1 = Transmit data register empty 0 = Transmit data register not empty MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 297 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MODFEN — Mode Fault Enable Bit This read/write bit, when set to 1, allows the MODF flag to be set. If the MODF flag is set, clearing the MODFEN does not clear the MODF flag. If the SPI is enabled as a master and the MODFEN bit is low, then the SS pin is available as a general-purpose I/O. If the MODFEN bit is set, then this pin is not available as a generalpurpose I/O. When the SPI is enabled as a slave, the SS pin is not available as a general-purpose I/O regardless of the value of MODFEN. (See 14.13.4 SS (Slave Select).) If the MODFEN bit is low, the level of the SS pin does not affect the operation of an enabled SPI configured as a master. For an enabled SPI configured as a slave, having MODFEN low only prevents the MODF flag from being set. It does not affect any other part of SPI operation. (See 14.8.2 Mode Fault Error.) SPR1 and SPR0 — SPI Baud Rate Select Bits In master mode, these read/write bits select one of four baud rates as shown in Table 14-4. SPR1 and SPR0 have no effect in slave mode. Reset clears SPR1 and SPR0. Table 14-4. SPI Master Baud Rate Selection SPR1 and SPR0 Baud Rate Divisor (BD) 00 2 01 8 10 32 11 128 Use this formula to calculate the SPI baud rate: CGMOUT Baud rate = -------------------------2 × BD where: CGMOUT = base clock output of the clock generator module (CGM) BD = baud rate divisor Technical Data 298 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) I/O Registers 14.14.3 SPI Data Register The SPI data register consists of the read-only receive data register and the write-only transmit data register. Writing to the SPI data register writes data into the transmit data register. Reading the SPI data register reads data from the receive data register. The transmit data and receive data registers are separate registers that can contain different values. (See Figure 14-2.) Address: $0012 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: R7 R6 R5 R4 R3 R2 R1 R0 Write: T7 T6 T5 T4 T3 T2 T1 T0 Reset: Unaffected by reset Figure 14-15. SPI Data Register (SPDR) R7–R0/T7–T0 — Receive/Transmit Data Bits NOTE: Do not use read-modify-write instructions on the SPI data register since the register read is not the same as the register written. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) 299 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) Technical Data 300 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.1 Contents 15.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 15.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302 15.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 15.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303 15.4.2 Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 15.4.3 Conversion Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305 15.4.4 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 15.4.5 Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306 15.4.6 Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307 15.5 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308 15.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308 15.7.1 ADC Voltage In (VADIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.7.2 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.7.3 ADC Voltage Reference High Pin (VREFH). . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309 15.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 15.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310 15.8.2 ADC Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312 15.8.3 ADC Clock Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 301 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.2 Introduction This section describes the analog-to-digital convert (ADC). The ADC is a 6-channel 10-bit linear successive approximation ADC. 15.3 Features Features of the ADC module include: • Six Channels with Multiplexed Input • High impedance buffered input • Linear Successive Approximation with monotonicity • 10-Bit Resolution • Single or Continuous Conversion • Conversion Complete Flag Or Conversion Complete Interrupt • Selectable ADC Clock • Conversion result justification – 8-bit truncated mode – Right justified mode – Left justified mode – Left justified sign mode Technical Data 302 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Functional Description Addr. $003C $003D $003E Register Name Bit 7 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 AIEN ADCO ADCH4 ADCH3 ADCH2 ADCH1 ADCH0 Read: ADC Status and Control Register Write: (ADSCR) Reset: COCO 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 Read: ADC Data Register High Write: (ADRH) Reset: ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: ADC Data Register Low (ADRL) Write: ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx ADx R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADIV2 ADIV1 ADIV0 ADICLK MODE1 MODE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 Reset: $003F 6 Read: ADC Clock Register (ADCLK) Write: Reset: = Unimplemented R R 0 0 = Reserved Figure 15-1. ADC I/O Register Summary 15.4 Functional Description The ADC provides six pins for sampling external sources at pins PTA4/ADC0–PTA7/ADC3 and PTB6/ADC4–PTB7/ADC5. An analog multiplexer allows the single ADC converter to select one of nine ADC channels as ADC voltage in (VADIN). VADIN is converted by the successive approximation register-based analog-to-digital converter. When the conversion is completed, ADC places the result in the ADC data register, high and low byte (ADRH and ADRL), and sets a flag or generates an interrupt. Figure 15-2 shows the structure of the ADC module. 15.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins PTA4–PTA7 and PTB6–PTB7 are general-purpose I/O pins that are shared with the ADC channels. The channel select bits, ADCH[4:0], define which ADC channel/port pin will be used as the input signal. The ADC overrides the port I/O logic by forcing that pin as input to the ADC. The remaining ADC channels/port pins are controlled by the port I/O MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 303 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) logic and can be used as general-purpose I/O pins. Writes to the port data register or data direction register will not have any affect on the port pin that is selected by the ADC. Read of a port pin which is in use by the ADC will return the pin condition if the corresponding DDR bit is at logic 0. If the DDR bit is at logic 1, the value in the port data latch is read. INTERNAL DATA BUS READ DDRAx/DDRBx WRITE DDRAx/DDRBx RESET WRITE PTAx/PTBx DISABLE DDRAx/DDRBx PTAx/PTBx PTAx/PTBx READ PTAx/PTBx ADC0–ADC5 (6 CHANNELS) DISABLE ADC DATA REGISTERS ADRH ADRL VREFH VREFL INTERRUPT LOGIC AIEN ADC VOLTAGE IN (VADIN) CONVERSION COMPLETE ADC ADC CLOCK COCO CGMXCLK BUS CLOCK 1.2V BANDGAP REFERENCE CHANNEL SELECT ADCH[4:0] CLOCK GENERATOR ADIV[2:0] ADICLK Figure 15-2. ADC Block Diagram Technical Data 304 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Functional Description 15.4.2 Voltage Conversion When the input voltage to the ADC equals VREFH, the ADC converts the signal to $3FF (full scale). If the input voltage equals VREFL, the ADC converts it to $000. Input voltages between VREFH and VREFL are straight-line linear conversions. All other input voltages will result in $3FF if greater than VREFH and $000 if less than VREFL. NOTE: Input voltage should not exceed the analog supply voltages. 15.4.3 Conversion Time Conversion starts after a write to the ADSCR. A conversion is between 16 and 17 ADC clock cycles, therefore: Conversion time = 16 to17 ADC cycles ADC frequency Number of bus cycles = conversion time × bus frequency The ADC conversion time is determined by the clock source chosen and the divide ratio selected. The clock source is either the bus clock or CGMXCLK and is selectable by the ADICLK bit located in the ADC clock register. The divide ratio is selected by the ADIV[2:0] bits. For example, if a 4MHz CGMXCLK is selected as the ADC input clock source, with a divide-by-2 prescale, and the bus speed is set at 8MHz: Conversion time = 16 to 17 ADC cycles = 8 to 8.5 µs 4MHz ÷ 2 Number of bus cycles = 8µs x 8MHz = 64 to 68 cycles NOTE: The ADC frequency must be between fADIC minimum and fADIC maximum to meet ADC specifications. See 23.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics. Since an ADC cycle may be comprised of several bus cycles (eight in the previous example) and the start of a conversion is initiated by a bus cycle write to the ADSCR, from zero to four additional bus cycles may occur before the start of the initial ADC cycle. This results in a fractional ADC cycle and is represented as the 17th cycle. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 305 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.4.4 Continuous Conversion In the continuous conversion mode, the ADC continuously converts the selected channel, filling the ADC data register (ADRH:ADRL) with new data after each conversion. Data from the previous conversion will be overwritten whether that data has been read or not. Conversions will continue until the ADCO bit is cleared. The COCO bit is set after each conversion and can be cleared by writing to the ADC status and control register or reading of the ADRL data register. 15.4.5 Result Justification The conversion result may be formatted in four different ways. • Left justified • Right justified • Left justified sign data mode • 8-bit truncation All four of these modes are controlled using MODE0 and MODE1 bits located in the ADC clock control register (ADCLK). Left justification will place the eight most significant bits (MSB) in the ADC data register high (ADRH). This may be useful if the result is to be treated as an 8-bit result where the least significant two bits, located in the ADC data register low (ADRL) can be ignored. However, ADRL must be read after ADRH or else the interlocking will prevent all new conversions from being stored. Right justification will place only the two MSBs in the corresponding ADC data register high (ADRH) and the eight LSB bits in ADC data register low (ADRL). This mode of operation typically is used when a 10-bit unsigned result is desired. Left justified sign data mode is similar to left justified mode with one exception. The MSB of the 10-bit result, AD9 located in ADRH is complemented. This mode of operation is useful when a result, represented as a signed magnitude from mid-scale, is needed. Technical Data 306 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Functional Description Finally, 8-bit truncation mode will place the eight MSBs in ADC data register low (ADRL). The two LSBs are dropped. This mode of operation is used when compatibility with 8-bit ADC designs are required. No interlocking between ADRH and ADRL is present. NOTE: Quantization error is affected when only the most significant eight bits are used as a result. See Figure 15-3. 8-BIT 10-BIT RESULT RESULT IDEAL 8-BIT CHARACTERISTIC WITH QUANTIZATION = ±1/2 10-BIT TRUNCATED TO 8-BIT RESULT 003 00B 00A 009 002 IDEAL 10-BIT CHARACTERISTIC WITH QUANTIZATION = ±1/2 008 007 006 005 001 004 WHEN TRUNCATION IS USED, ERROR FROM IDEAL 8-BIT = 3/8 LSB DUE TO NON-IDEAL QUANTIZATION. 003 002 001 000 000 1/2 2 1/2 1 1/2 1/2 4 1/2 3 1/2 6 1/2 5 1/2 8 1/2 7 1/2 1 1/2 9 1/2 2 1/2 INPUT VOLTAGE REPRESENTED AS 10-BIT INPUT VOLTAGE REPRESENTED AS 8-BIT Figure 15-3. 8-Bit Truncation Mode Error 15.4.6 Monotonicity The conversion process is monotonic and has no missing codes. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 307 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.5 Interrupts When the AIEN bit is set, the ADC module is capable of generating a CPU interrupt after each ADC conversion. A CPU interrupt is generated if the COCO bit is at logic 0. The COCO bit is not used as a conversion complete flag when interrupts are enabled. The interrupt vector is defined in Table 2-1 . Vector Addresses. 15.6 Low-Power Modes The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 15.6.1 Wait Mode The ADC continues normal operation in wait mode. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the ADC can bring the MCU out of wait mode. If the ADC is not required to bring the MCU out of wait mode, power down the ADC by setting the ADCH[4:0] bits to logic 1’s before executing the WAIT instruction. 15.6.2 Stop Mode The ADC module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. Any pending conversion is aborted. ADC conversions resume when the MCU exits stop mode. Allow one conversion cycle to stabilize the analog circuitry before attempting a new ADC conversion after exiting stop mode. 15.7 I/O Signals The ADC module has nine channels, six channels are shared with port A and port C I/O pins; two channels are the ADC voltage reference inputs, VREFH and VREFL; and one channel is the 1.2V bandgap reference voltage. Technical Data 308 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) I/O Signals 15.7.1 ADC Voltage In (VADIN) VADIN is the input voltage signal from one of the nine channels to the ADC module. 15.7.2 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDA) The ADC analog portion uses VDDA as its power pin. Connect the VDDA pin to the same voltage potential as VDD. External filtering may be necessary to ensure clean VDDA for good results. NOTE: Route VDDA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. 15.7.3 ADC Voltage Reference High Pin (VREFH) VREFH is the power supply for setting the reference voltage VREFH. Connect the VREFH pin to the same voltage potential as VDDA. There will be a finite current associated with VREFH (see Section 23. Electrical Specifications). NOTE: Route VREFH carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass capacitors as close as possible to the package. 15.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) VREFL is the lower reference supply for the ADC. Connect the VREFL pin to the same voltage potential as VSSA. There will be a finite current associated with VREFL (see Section 23. Electrical Specifications). MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 309 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.8 I/O Registers These I/O registers control and monitor operation of the ADC: • ADC status and control register, ADSCR • ADC data register, ADRH:ADRL • ADC clock register, ADCLK 15.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register This section describes the function of the ADC status and control register (ADSCR). Writing ADSCR aborts the current conversion and initiates a new conversion. Address: $003C Read: COCO AIEN ADCO ADCH4 ADCH3 ADCH2 ADCH1 ADCH0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 Write: Reset: 0 = Unimplemented Figure 15-4. ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR) COCO — Conversions Complete Bit When the AIEN bit is a logic 0, the COCO is a read-only bit which is set each time a conversion is completed. This bit is cleared whenever the ADSCR is written, or whenever the ADC clock control register is written, or whenever the ADC data register low, ADRL, is read. If the AIEN bit is logic 1, the COCO bit always read as logic 0, CPU to service the ADC interrupt will be generated at the end if an ADC conversion. Reset clears the COCO bit. 1 = Conversion completed (AIEN = 0) 0 = Conversion not completed (AIEN = 0)/CPU interrupt (AIEN=1) AIEN — ADC Interrupt Enable Bit When this bit is set, an interrupt is generated at the end of an ADC conversion. The interrupt signal is cleared when the data register, ADR0, is read or the ADSCR is written. Reset clears the AIEN bit. 1 = ADC interrupt enabled 0 = ADC interrupt disabled Technical Data 310 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) I/O Registers ADCO — ADC Continuous Conversion Bit When set, the ADC will convert samples continuously and update the ADC data register at the end of each conversion. Only one conversion is allowed when this bit is cleared. Reset clears the ADCO bit. 1 = Continuous ADC conversion 0 = One ADC conversion ADCH[4:0] — ADC Channel Select Bits ADCH[4:0] form a 5-bit field which is used to select one of the ADC channels when not in auto-scan mode. The five channel select bits are detailed in Table 15-1. NOTE: Care should be taken when using a port pin as both an analog and a digital input simultaneously to prevent switching noise from corrupting the analog signal. NOTE: Recovery from the disabled state requires one conversion cycle to stabilize. Table 15-1. MUX Channel Select ADCH4 ADCH3 ADCH2 ADCH1 ADCH0 ADC Channel Input Select 0 0 0 0 0 ADC0 PTA4 0 0 0 0 1 ADC1 PTA5 0 0 0 1 0 ADC2 PTA6 0 0 0 1 1 ADC3 PTA7 0 0 1 0 0 ADC4 PTB6 0 0 1 0 1 ADC5 PTB7 0 0 1 1 0 ADC6 1.2V Bandgap reference 0 0 1 1 1 ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ Reserved 1 1 1 0 0 ADC7 ↓ ADC28 1 1 1 0 1 ADC29 VREFH (see Note 2) 1 1 1 1 0 ADC30 VREFL (see Note 2) 1 1 1 1 1 ADC powered-off NOTES: 1. If any reserved channels are selected, the resulting ADC conversion will be unknown. 2. The voltage levels supplied from internal reference nodes as specified in the table are used to verify the operation of the ADC converter both in production test and for user applications. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 311 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.8.2 ADC Data Register The ADC data register consist of a pair of 8-bit registers: high byte (ADRH), and low byte (ADRL). This pair form a 16-bit register to store the 10-bit ADC result for the selected ADC result justification mode. In 8-bit truncated mode, the ADRL holds the eight most significant bits (MSBs) of the 10-bit result. The ADRL is updated each time an ADC conversion completes. In 8-bit truncated mode, ADRL contains no interlocking with ADRH. (See Figure 15-5 . ADRH and ADRL in 8-Bit Truncated Mode.) Addr. $003D $003E Register Name Read: ADC Data Register High Write: (ADRH) Reset: Read: ADC Data Register Low Write: (ADRL) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 15-5. ADRH and ADRL in 8-Bit Truncated Mode In right justified mode the ADRH holds the two MSBs, and the ADRL holds the eight least significant bits (LSBs), of the 10-bit result. ADRH and ADRL are updated each time a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL. Until ADRL is read all subsequent ADC results will be lost. (See Figure 15-6 . ADRH and ADRL in Right Justified Mode.) Addr. $003D $003E Register Name Read: ADC Data Register High Write: (ADRH) Reset: Read: ADC Data Register Low Write: (ADRL) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AD9 AD8 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 15-6. ADRH and ADRL in Right Justified Mode Technical Data 312 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) I/O Registers In left justified mode the ADRH holds the eight most significant bits (MSBs), and the ADRL holds the two least significant bits (LSBs), of the 10-bit result. The ADRH and ADRL are updated each time a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL. Until ADRL is read all subsequent ADC results will be lost. (See Figure 15-7 . ADRH and ADRL in Left Justified Mode.) Addr. $003D $003E Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: ADC Data Register High Write: (ADRH) Reset: AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: ADC Data Register Low Write: (ADRL) Reset: AD1 AD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 15-7. ADRH and ADRL in Left Justified Mode In left justified sign mode the ADRH holds the eight MSBs with the MSB complemented, and the ADRL holds the two least significant bits (LSBs), of the 10-bit result. The ADRH and ADRL are updated each time a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL. Until ADRL is read all subsequent ADC results will be lost. (See Figure 15-8 . ADRH and ADRL in Left Justified Sign Data Mode.) Addr. $003D $003E Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Read: ADC Data Register High Write: (ADRH) Reset: AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: ADC Data Register Low Write: (ADRL) Reset: AD1 AD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R R R R R R R R 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 15-8. ADRH and ADRL in Left Justified Sign Data Mode MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 313 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 15.8.3 ADC Clock Control Register The ADC clock control register (ADCLK) selects the clock frequency for the ADC. Address: $003F Read: 0 ADIV2 ADIV1 ADIV0 ADICLK MODE1 0 MODE0 Write: Reset: R 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented 0 R 1 0 0 = Reserved Figure 15-9. ADC Clock Control Register (ADICLK) ADIV[2:0] — ADC Clock Prescaler Bits ADIV2, ADIV1, and ADIV0 form a 3-bit field which selects the divide ratio used by the ADC to generate the internal ADC clock. Table 15-2 shows the available clock configurations. The ADC clock should be set to between 32kHz and 2MHz. Table 15-2. ADC Clock Divide Ratio ADIV2 ADIV1 ADIV0 ADC Clock Rate 0 0 0 ADC input clock ÷ 1 0 0 1 ADC input clock ÷ 2 0 1 0 ADC input clock ÷ 4 0 1 1 ADC input clock ÷ 8 1 X X ADC input clock ÷ 16 X = don’t care ADICLK — ADC Input Clock Select Bit ADICLK selects either bus clock or CGMXCLK as the input clock source to generate the internal ADC clock. Reset selects CGMXCLK as the ADC clock source. Technical Data 314 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) I/O Registers If the external clock (CGMXCLK) is equal to or greater than 1MHz, CGMXCLK can be used as the clock source for the ADC. If CGMXCLK is less than 1MHz, use the PLL-generated bus clock as the clock source. As long as the internal ADC clock is at fADIC, correct operation can be guaranteed. 1 = Internal bus clock 0 = External clock, CGMXCLK fADIC = CGMXCLK or bus frequency ADIV[2:0] MODE1 and MODE0 — Modes of Result Justification MODE1 and MODE0 selects between four modes of operation. The manner in which the ADC conversion results will be placed in the ADC data registers is controlled by these modes of operation. Reset returns right-justified mode. Table 15-3. ADC Mode Select MODE1 MODE0 ADC Clock Rate 0 0 8-bit truncated mode 0 1 Right justified mode 1 0 Left justified mode 1 1 Left justified sign data mode MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) 315 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Technical Data 316 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 16. Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 16.1 Contents 16.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 16.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318 16.4 Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses . . . . . . . 318 16.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320 16.5.1 LCD Duty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321 16.5.2 LCD Voltages (VLCD, VLCD1, VLCD2, VLCD3) . . . . . . . . . . . 323 16.5.3 LCD Cycle Frame. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323 16.5.4 Fast Charge and Low Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324 16.5.5 Contrast Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 16.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .325 16.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 16.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325 16.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326 16.7.1 BP0–BP3 (Backplane Drivers) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .326 16.7.2 FP0–FP26 (Frontplane Drivers) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328 16.8 Seven Segment Display Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332 16.9 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 16.9.1 LCD Control Register (LCDCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335 16.9.2 LCD Clock Register (LCDCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337 16.9.3 LCD Data Registers (LDAT1–LDAT14) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 317 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 16.2 Introduction This section describes the liquid crystal display (LCD) driver module. The LCD driver module can drive a maximum of 27 frontplanes and 4 backplanes, depending on the LCD duty selected. 16.3 Features Features of the LCD driver module include the following: • Software programmable driver segment configurations: – 26 frontplanes × 4 backplanes (104 segments) – 27 frontplanes × 3 backplanes (81 segments) – 27 frontplanes × 1 backplane (27 segments) • LCD bias voltages generated by internal resistor ladder • Software programmable contrast control 16.4 Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses Three dedicated I/O pins are for the backplanes, BP0–BP2, eighteen dedicated I/O pins are for the frontplanes, FP1–FP18, and the eight frontplanes, FP19–FP26, are shared with port C pins. FP0 and BP3 shares the same pin and configured by the DUTY[1:0] bits in the LCD clock register. The full names of the LCD output pins are shown in Table 16-1. The generic pin names appear in the text that follows. Table 16-1. Pin Name Conventions LCD Generic Pin Name Full MCU Pin Name Pin Selected for LCD Function by: FP0/BP3 FP0/BP3 — BP0–BP2 BP0–BP2 — FP1–FP18 FP1–FP18 — FP19–FP22 PTC0/FP19–PTC3/FP22 PCEL in CONFIG2 FP23–FP26 PTC4/FP23–PTC7/FP26 PCEH in CONFIG2 Technical Data 318 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) Pin Name Conventions and I/O Register Addresses Addr. $004F $0051 $0052 $0053 $0054 $0055 $0056 $0057 $0058 $0059 Register Name Bit 7 Read: LCD Clock Register Write: (LCDCLK) Reset: Read: LCD Control Register Write: (LCDCR) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 1 Write: (LDAT1) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 2 Write: (LDAT2) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 3 Write: (LDAT3) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 4 Write: (LDAT4) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 5 Write: (LDAT5) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 6 Write: (LDAT6) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 7 Write: (LDAT7) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 8 Write: (LDAT8) Reset: 0 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 FCCTL1 FCCTL0 DUTY1 DUTY0 LCLK2 LCLK1 LCLK0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 FC LC LCCON3 LCCON2 LCCON1 LCCON0 0 0 LCDE 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 F1B3 F1B2 F1B1 F1B0 F0B3 F0B2 F0B1 F0B0 U U U U U U U U F3B3 F3B2 F3B1 F3B0 F2B3 F2B2 F2B1 F2B0 U U U U U U U U F5B3 F5B2 F5B1 F5B0 F4B3 F4B2 F4B1 F4B0 U U U U U U U U F7B3 F7B2 F7B1 F7B0 F6B3 F6B2 F6B1 F6B0 U U U U U U U U F9B3 F9B2 F9B1 F9B0 F8B3 F8B2 F8B1 F8B0 U U U U U U U U F11B3 F11B2 F11B1 F11B0 F10B3 F10B2 F10B1 F10B0 U U U U U U U U F13B3 F13B2 F13B1 F13B0 F12B3 F12B2 F12B1 F12B0 U U U U U U U U F15B3 F15B2 F15B1 F15B0 F14B3 F14B2 F14B1 F14B0 U U U U U U U U U = Unaffected = Unimplemented Figure 16-1. LCD I/O Register Summary MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 319 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) $005A $005B $005C $005D $005E $005F Read: LCD Data Register 9 Write: (LDAT9) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 10 Write: (LDAT10) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 11 Write: (LDAT11) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 12 Write: (LDAT12) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 13 Write: (LDAT13) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 14 Write: (LDAT14) Reset: F17B3 F17B2 F17B1 F17B0 F16B3 F16B2 F16B1 F16B0 U U U U U U U U F19B3 F19B2 F19B1 F19B0 F18B3 F18B2 F18B1 F18B0 U U U U U U U U F21B3 F21B2 F21B1 F21B0 F20B3 F20B2 F20B1 F20B0 U U U U U U U U F23B3 F23B2 F23B1 F23B0 F22B3 F22B2 F22B1 F22B0 U U U U U U U U F25B3 F25B2 F25B1 F25B0 F24B3 F24B2 F24B1 F24B0 U U U U U U U U F26B3 F26B2 F26B1 F26B0 U U U U U U = Unaffected U U U = Unimplemented Figure 16-1. LCD I/O Register Summary 16.5 Functional Description Figure 16-2 shows a block diagram of the LCD driver module, and Figure 16-3 shows a simplified schematic of the LCD system. The LCD driver module uses a 1/3 biasing method. The LCD power is supplied by MCU power supply VDD. Voltages VLCD1, VLCD2, and VLCD3 are generated by an internal resistor ladder. The LCD data registers, LDAT1–LDAT14, control the LCD segments’ ON/OFF, with each data register controlling two frontplanes. When a logic 1 is written to a FxBx bit in the data register, the corresponding frontplane-backplane segment will turn ON. When a logic 0 is written, the the segment will turn OFF. Technical Data 320 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) Functional Description FP18 FP17 FP16 FP15 FP14 FP13 FP12 FP11 FP10 FP9 FP8 FP7 FP6 FP5 When the LCD driver module is disabled (LCDE = 0), the LCD display will be OFF, all backplane and frontplane drivers have the same potential as VDD. The resistor ladder is disconnected from VDD to reduce power consumption. LCD FRONTPLANE DRIVER AND DATA LATCH FP4 PTC0/FP19 FP2 PTC1/FP20 FP1 1/3 LCDE (LCDC) BACKPLANE BP2 BP1 BP0 DRIVER 1/4 STATE CONTROL 1/1 1/3 1/4 INTERNAL BUS FP0/BP3 PORT-C LOGIC FP3 PTC2/FP21 PTC3/FP22 PTC4/FP23 PTC5/FP24 PTC6/FP25 PTC7/FP26 Figure 16-2. LCD Block Diagram 16.5.1 LCD Duty The setting of the LCD output waveform duty is dependent on the number of backplane drivers required. Three LCD duties are available: • Static duty — BP0 is used only • 1/3 duty — BP0, BP1, and BP3 are used • 1/4 duty — BP0, BP1, BP2, and BP3 are used When the LCD driver module is enabled the backplane waveforms for the selected duty are driven out of the backplane pins. The backplane waveforms are periodic and are shown are shown in Figure 16-6, Figure 16-5, and Figure 16-7. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 321 FP0 FP1 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) RFP RFP FP24 RFP BP0 RBP BP1 RBP VLCD (from VDD) VLCD RLCD RLCD RLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 Vbias MOTOROLA MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 VR BIAS CONTROL LCCON[3:0] Figure 16-3. Simplified LCD Schematic (1/3 Duty, 1/3 Bias) BP2 RBP Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) Technical Data 322 LCD Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) Functional Description 16.5.2 LCD Voltages (VLCD, VLCD1, VLCD2, VLCD3) The voltage VLCD is connected directly to VDD. VLCD1, VLCD2, and VLCD3 are internal bias voltages for the LCD driver waveforms. They are derived from VLCD using a resistor ladder (see Figure 16-3). The relative potential of the LCD voltages are: • VLCD = VDD • VLCD1 = 2/3 × (VLCD – Vbias) • VLCD2 = 1/3 × (VLCD – Vbias) • VLCD3 = Vbias The VLCD3 bias voltage, Vbias, is controlled by the LCD contrast control bits, LCCON[2:0]. 16.5.3 LCD Cycle Frame The LCD driver module uses the CGMXCLK (see Section 7. Oscillator (OSC)) as the input reference clock. This clock is divided to produce the LCD waveform base clock, LCDCLK, by configuring the LCLK[2:0] bits in the LCD clock register. The LCDCLK clocks the backplane and the frontplane output waveforms. The LCD cycle frame is determined by the equation: LCD CYCLE FRAME = 1 LCD WAVEFORM BASE CLOCK × DUTY For example, for 1/3 duty and 256Hz waveform base clock: LCD CYCLE FRAME = 1 256 × (1/3) = 11.72 ms MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 323 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 16.5.4 Fast Charge and Low Current The default value for each of the bias resistors (see Figure 16-3), RLCD, in the resistor ladder is approximately 37kΩ at VLCD = 3V. The relatively high current drain through the 37kΩ resistor ladder may not be suitable for some LCD panel connections. Lowering this current is possible by setting the LC bit in the LCD control register, switching the RLCD value to 146kΩ. Although the lower current drain is desirable, but in some LCD panel connections, the higher current is required to drive the capacitive load of the LCD panel. In most cases, the higher current is only required when the LCD waveforms change state (the rising and falling edges in the LCD output waveforms). The fast charge option is designed to have the high current for the switching and the low current for the steady state. Setting the FC bit in the LCD control register selects the fast charge option. The RLCD value is set to 37kΩ (for high current) for a fraction of time for each LCD waveform switching edge, and then back to 146kΩ for the steady state period. The duration of the fast charge time is set by configuring the FCCTL[1:0] bits in the LCD clock register, and can be LCDCLK/32, LCDCLK/64, or LCDCLK/128. Figure 16-4 shows the fast charge clock relative to the BP0 waveform. LCDCLK LCD WAVEFORM EXAMPLE: BP0 FAST CHARGE CLOCK HIGH CURRENT SELECTED BEFORE SWITCHING EDGE, PERIOD IS DEFINED BY FCCTL[1:0] Figure 16-4. Fast Charge Timing Technical Data 324 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) Low-Power Modes 16.5.5 Contrast Control The contrast of the connected LCD panel can be adjusted by configuring the LCCON[3:0] bits in the LCD control register. The LCCON[3:0] bits provide a 16-step contrast control, which adjusts the bias voltage in the resistor ladder for LCD voltage VLCD3. The relative voltages, VLCD1 and VLCD2, are altered according. For example, setting LCCON[3:0] = $F, the relative panel potential voltage (VLCD – VLCD3) is reduced from maximum 3.3V to approximate 2.45V. 16.6 Low-Power Modes The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 16.6.1 Wait Mode The LCD driver module continues normal operation in wait mode. If the LCD is not required in wait mode, power down the LCD module by clearing the LCDE bit before executing the WAIT instruction. 16.6.2 Stop Mode For continuous LCD module operation in stop mode, the oscillator stop mode enable bit (STOP_XCLKEN in CONFIG2 register) must be set before executing the STOP instruction. When STOP_XCLKEN is set, CGMXCLK continues to drive the LCD module. If STOP_XCLKEN bit is cleared, the LCD module is inactive after the execution of a STOP instruction. The STOP instruction does not affect LCD register states. LCD module operation resumes after an external interrupt. To further reduce power consumption, the LCD module should be powered-down by clearing the LCDE bit before executing the STOP instruction. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 325 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 16.7 I/O Signals The LCD driver module has thirty (30) output pins and shares eight of them with port C I/O pins. • FP0/BP3 (multiplexed; selected as FP0 or BP3 by DUTY[1:0]) • BP0–BP2 • FP1–FP26 (FP19–FP26 shared with port C) 16.7.1 BP0–BP3 (Backplane Drivers) BP0–BP3 are the backplane driver output pins. These are connected to the backplane of the LCD panel. Depending on the LCD duty selected, the voltage waveforms in Figure 16-6, Figure 16-5, and Figure 16-7 appear on the backplane pins. BP3 pin is only used when 1/4 duty is selected. The pin becomes FP0 for static and 1/3 duty operations. DUTY = 1/3 1FRAME VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 BP0 VLCD3 BP1 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 BP2 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 NOTES: 1. BP3 is not used. 2. At 1/3 duty, 1FRAME has three times the cycle of LCD waveform base clock. Figure 16-5. 1/3 Duty LCD Backplane Driver Waveforms Technical Data 326 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) I/O Signals DUTY = STATIC 1FRAME VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 BP0 VLCD3 NOTES: 1. BP1, BP2, and BP3 are not used. 2. At static duty, 1FRAME is equal to the cycle of LCD waveform base clock. Figure 16-6. Static LCD Backplane Driver Waveform DUTY = 1/4 1FRAME VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 BP0 VLCD3 BP1 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 BP2 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 BP3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 Figure 16-7. 1/4 Duty LCD Backplane Driver Waveforms MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 327 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 16.7.2 FP0–FP26 (Frontplane Drivers) FP0–FP26 are the frontplane driver output pins. These are connected to the frontplane of the LCD panel. Depending on LCD duty selected and the contents in the LCD data registers, the voltage waveforms in Figure 16-8, Figure 16-9, and Figure 16-10 appear on the frontplane pins. FP19–FP26 are shared with port C I/O pins. These pins are configured for standard I/O or LCD use by the PCEL and PCEH bits in CONFIG2 register. DUTY = STATIC FPx OUTPUT 1FRAME DATA LATCH: 1 = ON, 0 = OFF VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 FxB0 — — — 0 VLCD3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 FxB0 — — — 1 Figure 16-8. Static LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms Technical Data 328 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) I/O Signals DUTY = 1/3 DATA LATCH: 1 = ON, 0 = OFF FPx OUTPUT 1FRAME — FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 0 0 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 — — — — — — — FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 0 1 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 1 0 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 0 0 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 1 1 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 1 0 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 0 1 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 1 1 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 . Figure 16-9. 1/3 Duty LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 329 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) FPx OUTPUT DUTY = 1/4 1FRAME DATA LATCH: 1 = ON, 0 = OFF FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 0 0 0 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 0 0 1 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 0 1 0 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 0 1 1 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 1 0 0 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 1 0 1 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 1 1 0 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 0 1 1 1 Figure 16-10. 1/4 Duty LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms Technical Data 330 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) I/O Signals FPx OUTPUT DUTY = 1/4 1FRAME DATA LATCH: 1 = ON, 0 = OFF FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 0 0 0 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 0 0 1 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 0 1 0 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 0 1 1 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 1 0 0 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 1 0 1 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 1 1 0 FxB3 FxB2 FxB1 FxB0 1 1 1 1 Figure 16-11. 1/4 Duty LCD Frontplane Driver Waveforms (continued) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 331 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 16.8 Seven Segment Display Connection The following shows an example for connecting a 7-segment LCD display to the LCD driver. The example uses 1/3 duty cycle, with pins BP0, BP1, BP2, FP0, FP1, and FP2 connected as shown in Figure 16-12. The output waveforms are shown in Figure 16-13. FP CONNECTION a f e g d BP CONNECTION a b f c e BP0 (a, b COMMONED) b g BP1 (c, f, g COMMONED) c d BP2 (d, e COMMONED) FP2 (b, c COMMONED) FP1 (a, d, g COMMONED) FP0 (e, f COMMONED) The segment assignments for each bit in the data registers are: LDAT1 $0052 F1B3 F1B2 F1B1 F1B0 F0B3 F0B2 F0B1 F0B0 — d g a — e f — FP0 FP1 LDAT2 $0053 F3B3 F3B2 F3B1 F3B0 F2B3 F2B2 F2B1 F2B0 — — — — — — c b FP2 To display the character "4": LDAT1 = X010X01X, LDAT2 = XXXXXX11 a LDAT1 $0052 X 0 1 0 X 0 1 X LDAT2 $0053 X X X X X X 1 1 f e g d b c X = don’t care Figure 16-12. 7-Segment Display Example Technical Data 332 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) Seven Segment Display Connection DUTY = 1/3 1FRAME VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 BP0 VLCD3 — — — F0B2 F0B1 F0B0 0 1 0 F1B2 F1B1 F1B0 0 1 0 F2B2 F2B1 F2B0 0 1 1 BP1 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 BP2 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 FP0 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 FP1 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 FP2 VLCD VLCD1 VLCD2 VLCD3 Figure 16-13. BP0–BP2 and FP0–FP2 Output Waveforms for 7-Segment Display Example MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 333 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) The voltage waveform across the "f" segment of the LCD (between BP1 and FP0) is illustrated in Figure 16-14. As shown in the waveform, the voltage peaks reach the LCD-ON voltage, VLCD, therefore, the segment will be ON. +VLCD +VLCD1 +VLCD2 BP1–FP0 0 –VLCD2 –VLCD1 –VLCD Figure 16-14. "f" Segment Voltage Waveform The voltage waveform across the "e" segment of the LCD (between BP2 and FP0) is illustrated in Figure 16-15. As shown in the waveform, the voltage peaks do not reach the LCD-ON voltage, VLCD, therefore, the segment will be OFF. +VLCD +VLCD1 +VLCD2 0 –VLCD2 –VLCD1 –VLCD BP2–FP0 Figure 16-15. "e" Segment Voltage Waveform Technical Data 334 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) I/O Registers 16.9 I/O Registers Sixteen (16) registers control LCD driver module operation: • LCD control register (LCDCR) • LCD clock register (LCDCLK) • LCD data registers (LDAT1–LDAT14) 16.9.1 LCD Control Register (LCDCR) The LCD control register (LCDCR): • Enables the LCD driver module • Selects bias resistor value and fast-charge control • Selects LCD contrast Address: $0051 Bit 7 Read: Write: Reset: LCDE 0 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 FC LC LCCON3 LCCON2 LCCON1 LCCON0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 16-16. LCD Control Register (LCDCR) LCDE — LCD Enable This read/write bit enables the LCD driver module; the backplane and frontplane drive LCD waveforms out of BPx and FPx pins. Reset clears the LCDE bit. 1 = LCD driver module enabled 0 = LCD driver module disabled FC — Fast Charge LC — Low Current These read/write bits are used to select the value of the resistors in resistor ladder for LCD voltages. Reset clears the FC and LC bits. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 335 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) Table 16-2. Resistor Ladder Selection FC LC Action X 0 Each resistor is approximately 37 kΩ (default) 0 1 Each resistor is approximately 146 kΩ 1 1 Fast charge mode LCCON[3:0] — LCD Contrast Control These read/write bits select the bias voltage, Vbias. This voltage controls the contrast of the LCD. Maximum contrast is set when LCCON[3:0] = 0000; minimum contrast is when LCCON[3:0] = 1111. Table 16-3. LCD Bias Voltage Control LCCON3 LCCON2 LCCON1 LCCON0 Bias Voltage (% of VDD) 0 0 0 0 0.6% 0 0 0 1 2.9% 0 0 1 0 5.2% 0 0 1 1 7.4% 0 1 0 0 9.6% 0 1 0 1 11.6% 0 1 1 0 13.5% 0 1 1 1 15.3% 1 0 0 0 17.2% 1 0 0 1 18.8% 1 0 1 0 20.5% 1 0 1 1 22.0% 1 1 0 0 23.6% 1 1 0 1 25.0% 1 1 1 0 26.4% 1 1 1 1 27.7% Technical Data 336 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) I/O Registers 16.9.2 LCD Clock Register (LCDCLK) The LCD clock register (LCDCLK): • Selects the fast charge duty cycle • Selects LCD driver duty cycle • Selects LCD waveform base clock Address: $004F Bit 7 Read: 0 Write: Reset: 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 FCCTL1 FCCTL0 DUTY1 DUTY0 LCLK2 LCLK1 LCLK0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 16-17. LCD Clock Register (LCDCLK) FCCTL[1:0] — Fast Charge Duty Cycle Select These read/write bits select the duty cycle of the fast charge duration. Reset clears these bits. (See 16.5.4 Fast Charge and Low Current) Table 16-4. Fast Charge Duty Cycle Selection FCCTL1:FCCTL0 Fast Charge Duty Cycle 00 In each LCDCLK/2 period, each bias resistor is reduced to 37 kΩ for a duration of LCDCLK/32. 01 In each LCDCLK/2 period, each bias resistor is reduced to 37 kΩ for a duration of LCDCLK/64. 10 In each LCDCLK/2 period, each bias resistor is reduced to 37 kΩ for a duration of LCDCLK/128. 11 Not used MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 337 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) DUTY[1:0] — Duty Cycle Select These read/write bits select the duty cycle of the LCD driver output waveforms. The multiplexed FP0/BP3 pin is controlled by the duty cycle selected. Reset clears these bits. Table 16-5. LCD Duty Cycle Selection DUTY1:DUTY0 Description 00 Static selected; FP0/BP3 pin function as FP0. 01 1/3 duty cycle selected; FP0/BP3 pin functions as FP0. 10 1/4 duty cycle selected; FP0/BP3 pin functions as BP3. 11 Not used LCLK[2:0] — LCD Waveform Base Clock Select These read/write bits selects the LCD waveform base clock. Reset clears these bits. Table 16-6. LCD Waveform Base Clock Selection LCLK2 LCLK1 LCLK0 Divide Ratio LCD Waveform Base Clock Frequency LCDCLK (Hz) LCD Frame Rate fXTAL(1) = 32.768kHz LCD Frame Rate fXTAL = 4.9152MHz fXTAL = 32.768kHz fXTAL = 4.9152MHz 1/3 duty 1/4 duty 1/3 duty 1/4 duty 0 0 0 128 256 — 85.3 64 — — 0 0 1 256 128 — 42.7 32 — — 0 1 0 512 64 — 21.3 16 — — 0 1 1 1024 32 — 10.7 8 — — 1 0 0 16384 — 300 — — 100 75 1 0 1 32768 — 150 — — 50 37.5 1 1 0 65536 — 75 — — 25 18.75 1 1 1 Reserved Notes: 1. fXTAL is the same as CGMXCLK (see Section 7. Oscillator (OSC)). Technical Data 338 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) I/O Registers 16.9.3 LCD Data Registers (LDAT1–LDAT14) The fourteen (14) LCD data registers enable and disable the drive to the corresponding LCD segments. Addr. Register Name $0052 Read: LCD Data Register 1 Write: (LDAT1) Reset: $0053 $0054 $0055 $0056 $0057 $0058 $0059 $005A Read: LCD Data Register 2 Write: (LDAT2) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 3 Write: (LDAT3) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 4 Write: (LDAT4) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 5 Write: (LDAT5) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 6 Write: (LDAT6) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 7 Write: (LDAT7) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 8 Write: (LDAT8) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 9 Write: (LDAT9) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 F1B3 F1B2 F1B1 F1B0 F0B3 F0B2 F0B1 F0B0 U U U U U U U U F3B3 F3B2 F3B1 F3B0 F2B3 F2B2 F2B1 F2B0 U U U U U U U U F5B3 F5B2 F5B1 F5B0 F4B3 F4B2 F4B1 F4B0 U U U U U U U U F7B3 F7B2 F7B1 F7B0 F6B3 F6B2 F6B1 F6B0 U U U U U U U U F9B3 F9B2 F9B1 F9B0 F8B3 F8B2 F8B1 F8B0 U U U U U U U U F11B3 F11B2 F11B1 F11B0 F10B3 F10B2 F10B1 F10B0 U U U U U U U U F13B3 F13B2 F13B1 F13B0 F12B3 F12B2 F12B1 F12B0 U U U U U U U U F15B3 F15B2 F15B1 F15B0 F14B3 F14B2 F14B1 F14B0 U U U U U U U U F17B3 F17B2 F17B1 F17B0 F16B3 F16B2 F16B1 F16B0 U U U U U U U U U = Unaffected = Unimplemented Figure 16-18. LCD Data Registers 1–14 (LDAT1–LDAT14) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) 339 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) $005B $005C $005D $005E $005F Read: LCD Data Register 10 Write: (LDAT10) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 11 Write: (LDAT11) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 12 Write: (LDAT12) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 13 Write: (LDAT13) Reset: Read: LCD Data Register 14 Write: (LDAT14) Reset: F19B3 F19B2 F19B1 F19B0 F18B3 F18B2 F18B1 F18B0 U U U U U U U U F21B3 F21B2 F21B1 F21B0 F20B3 F20B2 F20B1 F20B0 U U U U U U U U F23B3 F23B2 F23B1 F23B0 F22B3 F22B2 F22B1 F22B0 U U U U U U U U F25B3 F25B2 F25B1 F25B0 F24B3 F24B2 F24B1 F24B0 U U U U U U U U F26B3 F26B2 F26B1 F26B0 U U U U U U = Unaffected U U U = Unimplemented Figure 16-18. LCD Data Registers 1–14 (LDAT1–LDAT14) Technical Data 340 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 17. Input/Output (I/O) Ports 17.1 Contents 17.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341 17.3 Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 17.3.1 Port A Data Register (PTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344 17.3.2 Data Direction Register A (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345 17.4 Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347 17.4.1 Port B Data Register (PTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347 17.4.2 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348 17.4.3 Port B LED Control Register (LEDB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350 17.5 Port C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351 17.5.1 Port C Data Register (PTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351 17.5.2 Data Direction Register C (DDRC). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352 17.6 Port D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354 17.6.1 Port D Data Register (PTD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354 17.6.2 Data Direction Register D (DDRD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355 17.2 Introduction Thirty-two (32) bidirectional input-output (I/O) pins form four parallel ports. All I/O pins are programmable as inputs or outputs. NOTE: Connect any unused I/O pins to an appropriate logic level, either VDD or VSS. Although the I/O ports do not require termination for proper operation, termination reduces excess current consumption and the possibility of electrostatic damage. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 341 Input/Output (I/O) Ports Addr. Register Name $0000 Read: Port A Data Register Write: (PTA) Reset: $0001 $0002 $0003 Read: Port B Data Register Write: (PTB) Reset: Read: Port C Data Register Write: (PTC) Reset: Read: Port D Data Register Write: (PTD) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PTA7 PTA6 PTA5 PTA4 PTA3 PTA2 PTA1 PTA0 PTB2 PTB1 PTB0 PTC2 PTC1 PTC0 PTD2 PTD1 PTD0 Unaffected by reset PTB7 PTC7 PTB4 PTB3 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 Unaffected by reset PTD7 PTD6 PTD5 PTD4 PTD3 Unaffected by reset Read: DDRB7 Data Direction Register B $0005 Write: (DDRB) Reset: 0 Read: DDRC7 Data Direction Register C $0006 Write: (DDRC) Reset: 0 Read: DDRD7 Data Direction Register D $0007 Write: (DDRD) Reset: 0 $000C PTB5 Unaffected by reset Read: DDRA7 Data Direction Register A $0004 Write: (DDRA) Reset: 0 Read: Port-B LED Control Register Write: (LEDB) Reset: PTB6 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 LEDB5 LEDB4 LEDB3 LEDB2 LEDB1 LEDB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 17-1. I/O Port Register Summary Technical Data 342 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports Introduction Table 17-1. Port Control Register Bits Summary Port Bit DDR 0 DDRA0 1 DDRA1 Module Control Module KBI Register Control Bit Pin KBIE0 PTA0/KBI0 KBIE1 PTA1/KBI1 KBIER ($001C) 2 DDRA2 KBIE2 PTA2/KBI2 3 DDRA3 KBIE3 PTA3/KBI3 4 DDRA4 5 DDRA5 A PTA4/ATD0 PTA5/ATD1 ADC ADSCR ($003C) ADCH[4:0] 6 DDRA6 PTA6/ATD2 7 DDRA7 PTA7/ATD3 0 DDRB0 PTB0/TxD SCI 1 DDRB1 2 DDRB2 SCC1 ($0013) ENSCI PTB1/RxD T1SC0 ($0025) ELS0B:ELS0A PTB2/T1CH0 T1SC1 ($0028) ELS1B:ELS1A PTB3/T1CH1 T2SC0 ($0030) ELS0B:ELS0A PTB4/T2CH0 T2SC1 ($0033) ELS1B:ELS1A PTB5/T2CH1 ADSCR ($003C) ADCH[4:0] TIM1 3 DDRB3 4 DDRB4 B TIM2 5 DDRB5 6 DDRB6 PTB6/ATD4 ADC 7 DDRB7 PTB7/ATD5 0 DDRC0 PTC0/FP19 1 DDRC1 PTC1/FP20 PCEL 2 DDRC2 3 DDRC3 C PTC2/FP21 PTC3/FP22 LCD 4 DDRC4 5 DDRC5 CONFIG2 ($001D) PTC4/FP23 PTC5/FP24 PCEH 6 DDRC6 PTC6/FP25 7 DDRC7 PTC7/FP26 0 DDRD0 PTD0/SS 1 DDRD1 PTD1/MISO SPI SPCR ($0010) SPE 2 DDRD2 PTD2/MOSI 3 DDRD3 PTD3/SPSCK 4 DDRD4 5 DDRD5 D KBI PTD4/KBI4 KBIE5 PTD5/KBI5 KBIER ($001C) 6 DDRD6 KBIE6 PTD6/KBI6 7 DDRD7 KBIE7 PTD7/KBI7 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA KBIE4 Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 343 Input/Output (I/O) Ports 17.3 Port A Port A is an 8-bit special function port that shares four of its port pins with the analog-to-digital converter (ADC) module and four of its port pins with the keyboard interrupt module (KBI). 17.3.1 Port A Data Register (PTA) The port A data register contains a data latch for each of the eight port A pins. Address: $0000 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PTA7 PTA6 PTA5 PTA4 PTA3 PTA2 PTA1 PTA0 KBI2 KBI1 KBI0 Read: Write: Reset: Alternative Function: Unaffected by Reset ADC3 ADC2 ADC1 ADC0 KBI3 Figure 17-2. Port A Data Register (PTA) PTA[7:0] — Port A Data Bits These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port A pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register A. Reset has no effect on port A data. KBI[3:0] — Keyboard interrupt channels 0 to 3 KBI[3:0] are input pins to the keyboard interrupt module. The corresponding control bits, KBIE[3:0], in the keyboard interrupt enable register, KBIER, select which port pins will be used as a keyboard interrupt input and overrides any control from the port I/O logic. See Section 19. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI). Technical Data 344 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports Port A ADC[3:0] — ADC channels 3 to 0 ADC[3:0] are pins used for the input channels to the analog-to-digital converter module. The channel select bits, ADCH[4:0], in the ADC status and control register define which port pin will be used as an ADC input and overrides any control from the port I/O logic. See Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). NOTE: Care must be taken when reading port A while applying analog voltages to ADC[3:0] pins. If the appropriate ADC channel is not enabled, excessive current drain may occur if analog voltages are applied to the PTAx/ADCx pin, while PTA is read as a digital input. Those ports not selected as analog input channels are considered digital I/O ports. 17.3.2 Data Direction Register A (DDRA) Data direction register A determines whether each port A pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRA bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port A pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Address: $0004 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 DDRA7 DDRA6 DDRA5 DDRA4 DDRA3 DDRA2 DDRA1 DDRA0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 17-3. Data Direction Register A (DDRA) DDRA[7:0] — Data Direction Register A Bits These read/write bits control port A data direction. Reset clears DDRA[7:0], configuring all port A pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port A pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port A pin configured as input NOTE: Avoid glitches on port A pins by writing to the port A data register before changing data direction register A bits from 0 to 1. Figure 17-4 shows the port A I/O logic. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 345 Input/Output (I/O) Ports READ DDRA ($0004) INTERNAL DATA BUS WRITE DDRA ($0004) RESET DDRAx WRITE PTA ($0000) PTAx PTAx READ PTA ($0000) Figure 17-4. Port A I/O Circuit When DDRAx is a logic 1, reading address $0000 reads the PTAx data latch. When DDRAx is a logic 0, reading address $0000 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 17-2 summarizes the operation of the port A pins. Table 17-2. Port A Pin Functions Accesses to DDRA DDRA Bit PTA Bit 0 X(1) 1 X Accesses to PTA I/O Pin Mode Read/Write Read Write Input, Hi-Z(2) DDRA[7:0] Pin PTA[7:0](3) Output DDRA[7:0] PTA[7:0] PTA[7:0] Notes: 1. X = don’t care. 2. Hi-Z = high impedance. 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. Technical Data 346 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports Port B 17.4 Port B Port B is a 8-bit special function port that shares two of its port pins with the infrared serial communication interface (IRSCI) module, two of its port pins with the timer interface module 1 (TIM1) module, two of its port pins with the timer interface module 2 (TIM2), and two of its port pins with the ADC module. Port pins PTB0–PTB5 can be configured for direct LED drive. 17.4.1 Port B Data Register (PTB) The port B data register contains a data latch for each of the eight port B pins. NOTE: Bit 4–bit 7 of PTB are not available in a 52-pin LQFP. Address: $0001 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PTB7 PTB6 PTB5 PTB4 PTB3 PTB2 PTB1 PTB0 T1CH0 RxD TxD Read: Write: Reset: Alternative Function: Additional Function: Unaffected by reset ADC5 ADC4 T2CH1 T2CH0 T1CH1 LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive LED drive Figure 17-5. Port B Data Register (PTB) PTB[7:0] — Port B Data Bits These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port B pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register B. Reset has no effect on port B data. TxD, RxD — SCI Data I/O Pins The TxD and RxD pins are the transmit data output and receive data input for the IRSCI module. The enable SCI bit, ENSCI, in the SCI control register 1 enables the PTB0/TxD and PTB1/RxD pins as SCI TxD and RxD pins and overrides any control from the port I/O. See Section 13. Infrared Serial Communications Interface Module (IRSCI). MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 347 Input/Output (I/O) Ports T1CH[1:0] — Timer 1 Channel I/O Bits The T1CH1 and T1CH0 pins are the TIM1 input capture/output compare pins. The edge/level select bits, ELSxB:ELSxA, determine whether the PTB2/T1CH0 and PTB3/T1CH1 pins are timer channel I/O pins or general-purpose I/O pins. See Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM). T2CH[1:0] — Timer 2 Channel I/O Bits The T2CH1 and T2CH0 pins are the TIM1 input capture/output compare pins. The edge/level select bits, ELSxB:ELSxA, determine whether the PTB4/T2CH0 and PTB5/T2CH1 pins are timer channel I/O pins or general-purpose I/O pins. See Section 11. Timer Interface Module (TIM). ADC[5:4] — ADC channels 5 and 4 ADC[5:4] are pins used for the input channels to the analog-to-digital converter module. The channel select bits, ADCH[4:0], in the ADC status and control register define which port pin will be used as an ADC input and overrides any control from the port I/O logic. See Section 15. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC). NOTE: Care must be taken when reading port B while applying analog voltages to ADC[5:4] pins. If the appropriate ADC channel is not enabled, excessive current drain may occur if analog voltages are applied to the PTBx/ADCx pin, while PTB is read as a digital input. Those ports not selected as analog input channels are considered digital I/O ports. LED drive — Direct LED Drive Pins PTB0–PTB5 pins can be configured for direct LED drive. See 17.4.3 Port B LED Control Register (LEDB). 17.4.2 Data Direction Register B (DDRB) Data direction register B determines whether each port B pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRB bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port B pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Technical Data 348 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports Port B NOTE: For those devices packaged in a 52-pin LQFP, PTB4–PTB7 are not connected. DDRB4–DDRB7 should be set to a 1 to configure PTB4–PTB7 as outputs. Address: $0005 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 DDRB7 DDRB6 DDRB5 DDRB4 DDRB3 DDRB2 DDRB1 DDRB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 17-6. Data Direction Register B (DDRB) DDRB[7:0] — Data Direction Register B Bits These read/write bits control port B data direction. Reset clears DDRB[7:0], configuring all port B pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port B pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port B pin configured as input NOTE: Avoid glitches on port B pins by writing to the port B data register before changing data direction register B bits from 0 to 1. Figure 17-7 shows the port B I/O logic. READ DDRB ($0005) INTERNAL DATA BUS WRITE DDRB ($0005) RESET DDRBx WRITE PTB ($0001) PTBx PTBx READ PTB ($0001) Figure 17-7. Port B I/O Circuit When DDRBx is a logic 1, reading address $0001 reads the PTBx data latch. When DDRBx is a logic 0, reading address $0001 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 349 Input/Output (I/O) Ports Table 17-3 summarizes the operation of the port B pins. Table 17-3. Port B Pin Functions Accesses to DDRB DDRB Bit PTB Bit 0 X(1) 1 X Accesses to PTB I/O Pin Mode Read/Write Read Write Input, Hi-Z(2) DDRB[7:0] Pin PTB[7:0](3) Output DDRB[7:0] PTB[7:0] PTB[7:0] Notes: 1. X = don’t care. 2. Hi-Z = high impedance. 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. 17.4.3 Port B LED Control Register (LEDB) The port-B LED control register (LEDB) controls the direct LED drive capability on PTB5–PTB0 pins. Each bit is individually configurable and requires that the data direction register, DDRB, bit be configured as an output. When the IRSCI is enabled, setting the LEDB0 bit also enables high current (15mA) sink capability for the TxD pin. Address: Read: $000C Bit 7 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 LEDB5 LEDB4 LEDB3 LEDB2 LEDB1 LEDB0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: 0 0 Figure 17-8. Port B LED Control Register (LEDB) LEDB[5:0] — Port B LED Drive Enable Bits These read/write bits are software programmable to enable the direct LED drive on an output port pin. 1 = Corresponding port B pin configured for direct LED drive: 15mA current sinking capability on PTB[1:0], and 8mA current sinking capability on PTB[5:2] 0 = Corresponding port B pin configured for standard drive Technical Data 350 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports Port C 17.5 Port C Port C is an 8-bit special function port that shares all of its port pins with the liquid crystal display (LCD) driver module. 17.5.1 Port C Data Register (PTC) The port C data register contains a data latch for each of the eight port C pins. Address: $0002 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PTC7 PTC6 PTC5 PTC4 PTC3 PTC2 PTC1 PTC0 FP21 FP20 FP19 Read: Write: Reset: Alternative Function: Unaffected by reset FP26 FP25 FP24 FP23 FP22 Figure 17-9. Port C Data Register (PTC) PTC[7:0] — Port C Data Bits These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port C pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register C. Reset has no effect on port C data. FP[26:19] — LCD Driver Frontplanes 26–19 FP[26:19] are pins used for the frontplane output of the LCD driver module. The enable bits, PCEH and PCEL, in the CONFIG2 register, determine whether the PTC7/FP26–PTC4/FP23 and PTC3/FP22–PTC0/FP19 pins are LCD frontplane driver pins or general-purpose I/O pins. See Section 16. Liquid Crystal Display Driver (LCD). MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 351 Input/Output (I/O) Ports 17.5.2 Data Direction Register C (DDRC) Data direction register C determines whether each port C pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRC bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port C pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. Address: $0006 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 DDRC7 DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 17-10. Data Direction Register B (DDRB) DDRC[7:0] — Data Direction Register C Bits These read/write bits control port C data direction. Reset clears DDRC[7:0], configuring all port C pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port C pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port C pin configured as input NOTE: Avoid glitches on port C pins by writing to the port C data register before changing data direction register C bits from 0 to 1. Figure 17-11 shows the port C I/O logic. READ DDRC ($0006) INTERNAL DATA BUS WRITE DDRC ($0006) RESET DDRCx WRITE PTC ($0002) PTCx PTCx READ PTC ($0002) Figure 17-11. Port C I/O Circuit Technical Data 352 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports Port C When DDRCx is a logic 1, reading address $0002 reads the PTCx data latch. When DDRCx is a logic 0, reading address $0002 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 17-4 summarizes the operation of the port C pins. Table 17-4. Port C Pin Functions DDRC Bit 0 1 Accesses to DDRC PTC Bit X (1) X Accesses to PTC I/O Pin Mode Input, Hi-Z (2) Output Read/Write Read Write DDRC[7:0] Pin PTC[7:0](3) DDRC[7:0] PTC[7:0] PTC[7:0] Notes: 1. X = don’t care; except PTC2. 2. Hi-Z = high impedance. 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 353 Input/Output (I/O) Ports 17.6 Port D Port D is an 8-bit special function port that shares four of its pins with serial peripheral interface (SPI) module and four of its pins with the keyboard interrupt module (KBI). NOTE: Port D is not available in a 52-pin LQFP. 17.6.1 Port D Data Register (PTD) The port D data register contains a data latch for each of the eight port D pins. NOTE: Bit 0–bit 7 of PTD are not available in a 52-pin LQFP. Address: $0003 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 PTD7 PTD6 PTD5 PTD4 PTD3 PTD2 PTD1 PTD0 MOSI MISO SS Read: Write: Reset: Alternative Function: Unaffected by reset KBI7 KBI6 KBI5 KBI4 SPSCK Figure 17-12. Port D Data Register (PTD) PTD[7:0] — Port D Data Bits These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of each port D pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data direction register D. Reset has no effect on port D data. SS, MISO, MOSI, and SPSCK — SPI functional pins These are the chip select, master-input-slave-output, master-outputslave-input and clock pins for the SPI module. The SPI enable bit, SPE, in the SPI control register, SPCR, enables these pins as the SPI functional pins and overrides any control from port I/O logic. See Section 14. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI). Technical Data 354 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Input/Output (I/O) Ports Port D KBI[7:4] — Keyboard Interrupt Pins KBI[7:4] are input pins to the keyboard interrupt module. The corresponding control bits, KBIE[7:4], in the keyboard interrupt enable register, KBIER, select which port pins will be used as a keyboard interrupt input and overrides any control from the port I/O logic. See Section 19. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 17.6.2 Data Direction Register D (DDRD) Data direction register D determines whether each port D pin is an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRD bit enables the output buffer for the corresponding port D pin; a logic 0 disables the output buffer. NOTE: For those devices packaged in a 52-pin LQFP, PTD0–PTD7 are not connected. DDRD0–DDRD7 should be set to a 1 to configure PTD0–PTD7 as outputs. Address: $0007 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 DDRD7 DDRD6 DDRD5 DDRD4 DDRD3 DDRD2 DDRD1 DDRD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 17-13. Data Direction Register D (DDRD) DDRD[7:0] — Data Direction Register D Bits These read/write bits control port D data direction. Reset clears DDRD[7:0], configuring all port D pins as inputs. 1 = Corresponding port D pin configured as output 0 = Corresponding port D pin configured as input NOTE: Avoid glitches on port D pins by writing to the port D data register before changing data direction register D bits from 0 to 1. Figure 17-14 shows the port D I/O logic. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Input/Output (I/O) Ports 355 Input/Output (I/O) Ports READ DDRD ($0007) INTERNAL DATA BUS WRITE DDRD ($0007) DDRDx RESET WRITE PTD ($0003) PTDx PTDx READ PTD ($0003) Figure 17-14. Port D I/O Circuit When DDRDx is a logic 1, reading address $0003 reads the PTDx data latch. When DDRDx is a logic 0, reading address $0003 reads the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written, regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 17-5 summarizes the operation of the port D pins. Table 17-5. Port D Pin Functions DDRD Bit PTD Bit I/O Pin Mode Accesses to DDRD Accesses to PTD Read/Write Read Write 0 X(1) Input, Hi-Z(2) DDRD[7:0] Pin PTD[7:0](3) 1 X Output DDRD[7:0] PTD[7:0] PTD[7:0] Notes: 1. X = don’t care. 2. Hi-Z = high impedance. 3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect the input. Technical Data 356 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Input/Output (I/O) Ports MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 18. External Interrupt (IRQ) 18.1 Contents 18.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 18.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357 18.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358 18.4.1 IRQ Pin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360 18.5 IRQ Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361 18.6 IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361 18.2 Introduction The external interrupt (IRQ) module provides a maskable interrupt input. 18.3 Features Features of the IRQ module include the following: • A dedicated external interrupt pin (IRQ) • IRQ interrupt control bits • Hysteresis buffer • Programmable edge-only or edge and level interrupt sensitivity • Automatic interrupt acknowledge • Internal pullup resistor MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data External Interrupt (IRQ) 357 External Interrupt (IRQ) 18.4 Functional Description A logic 0 applied to the external interrupt pin can latch a CPU interrupt request. Figure 18-1 shows the structure of the IRQ module. Interrupt signals on the IRQ pin are latched into the IRQ latch. An interrupt latch remains set until one of the following actions occurs: • Vector fetch — A vector fetch automatically generates an interrupt acknowledge signal that clears the IRQ latch. • Software clear — Software can clear the interrupt latch by writing to the acknowledge bit in the interrupt status and control register (INTSCR). Writing a logic 1 to the ACK bit clears the IRQ latch. • Reset — A reset automatically clears the interrupt latch. The external interrupt pin is falling-edge-triggered and is softwareconfigurable to be either falling-edge or low-level-triggered. The MODE bit in the INTSCR controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin. When the interrupt pin is edge-triggered only, the CPU interrupt request remains set until a vector fetch, software clear, or reset occurs. When the interrupt pin is both falling-edge and low-level-triggered, the CPU interrupt request remains set until both of the following occur: • Vector fetch or software clear • Return of the interrupt pin to logic 1 The vector fetch or software clear may occur before or after the interrupt pin returns to logic 1. As long as the pin is low, the interrupt request remains pending. A reset will clear the latch and the MODE control bit, thereby clearing the interrupt even if the pin stays low. When set, the IMASK bit in the INTSCR mask all external interrupt requests. A latched interrupt request is not presented to the interrupt priority logic unless the IMASK bit is clear. NOTE: The interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register (CCR) masks all interrupt requests, including external interrupt requests. Technical Data 358 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 External Interrupt (IRQ) MOTOROLA External Interrupt (IRQ) Functional Description RESET ACK TO CPU FOR BIL/BIH INSTRUCTIONS INTERNAL ADDRESS BUS VECTOR FETCH DECODER VDD VDD INTERNAL PULLUP DEVICE IRQF D CLR Q IRQ INTERRUPT REQUEST SYNCHRONIZER CK IRQ IMASK MODE TO MODE SELECT LOGIC HIGH VOLTAGE DETECT Figure 18-1. IRQ Module Block Diagram Addr. $001E Register Name IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR) Read: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 0 0 0 0 IRQF 0 Bit 0 IMASK MODE 0 0 ACK Write: Reset: 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Table 18-1. IRQ I/O Port Register Summary MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data External Interrupt (IRQ) 359 External Interrupt (IRQ) 18.4.1 IRQ Pin A logic 0 on the IRQ pin can latch an interrupt request into the IRQ latch. A vector fetch, software clear, or reset clears the IRQ latch. If the MODE bit is set, the IRQ pin is both falling-edge-sensitive and lowlevel-sensitive. With MODE set, both of the following actions must occur to clear IRQ: • Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an interrupt acknowledge signal to clear the latch. Software may generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a logic 1 to the ACK bit in the interrupt status and control register (INTSCR). The ACK bit is useful in applications that poll the IRQ pin and require software to clear the IRQ latch. Writing to the ACK bit prior to leaving an interrupt service routine can also prevent spurious interrupts due to noise. Setting ACK does not affect subsequent transitions on the IRQ pin. A falling edge that occurs after writing to the ACK bit latches another interrupt request. If the IRQ mask bit, IMASK, is clear, the CPU loads the program counter with the vector address at locations $FFFA and $FFFB. • Return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 — As long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0, IRQ remains active. The vector fetch or software clear and the return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 may occur in any order. The interrupt request remains pending as long as the IRQ pin is at logic 0. A reset will clear the latch and the MODE control bit, thereby clearing the interrupt even if the pin stays low. If the MODE bit is clear, the IRQ pin is falling-edge-sensitive only. With MODE clear, a vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the IRQ latch. The IRQF bit in the INTSCR register can be used to check for pending interrupts. The IRQF bit is not affected by the IMASK bit, which makes it useful in applications where polling is preferred. Use the BIH of BIL instruction to read the logic level on the IRQ pin. NOTE: When using the level-sensitive interrupt trigger, avoid false interrupts by masking interrupt requests in the interrupt routine. Technical Data 360 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 External Interrupt (IRQ) MOTOROLA External Interrupt (IRQ) IRQ Module During Break Interrupts 18.5 IRQ Module During Break Interrupts The system integration module (SIM) controls whether the IRQ latch can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the break flag control register (BFCR) enables software to clear the latches during the break state. (See Section 22. Break Module (BRK).) To allow software to clear the IRQ latch during a break interrupt, write a logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a latch is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state. To protect the latches during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), writing to the ACK bit in the IRQ status and control register during the break state has no effect on the IRQ latch. 18.6 IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR) The IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR) controls and monitors operation of the IRQ module. The INTSCR has the following functions: • Shows the state of the IRQ flag • Clears the IRQ latch • Masks IRQ and interrupt request • Controls triggering sensitivity of the IRQ interrupt pin MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data External Interrupt (IRQ) 361 External Interrupt (IRQ) Address: Read: $001E Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 0 0 0 0 IRQF 0 Write: Reset: 1 Bit 0 IMASK MODE 0 0 ACK 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 18-2. IRQ Status and Control Register (INTSCR) IRQF — IRQ Flag Bit This read-only status bit is high when the IRQ interrupt is pending. 1 = IRQ interrupt pending 0 = IRQ interrupt not pending ACK — IRQ Interrupt Request Acknowledge Bit Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the IRQ latch. ACK always reads as logic 0. Reset clears ACK. IMASK — IRQ Interrupt Mask Bit Writing a logic 1 to this read/write bit disables IRQ interrupt requests. Reset clears IMASK. 1 = IRQ interrupt requests disabled 0 = IRQ interrupt requests enabled MODE — IRQ Edge/Level Select Bit This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin. Reset clears MODE. 1 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels 0 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges only Technical Data 362 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 External Interrupt (IRQ) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 19. Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 19.1 Contents 19.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363 19.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 19.4 I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364 19.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365 19.5.1 Keyboard Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367 19.6 Keyboard Interrupt Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367 19.6.1 Keyboard Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368 19.6.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 19.7 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369 19.8 Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369 19.9 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370 19.10 Keyboard Module During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .370 19.2 Introduction The keyboard interrupt module (KBI) provides eight independently maskable external interrupts which are accessible via PTA0–PTA3 and PTD4–PTD7. When a port pin is enabled for keyboard interrupt function, an internal 30kΩ pullup device is also enabled on the pin. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 363 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 19.3 Features Features of the keyboard interrupt module include the following: • Eight keyboard interrupt pins with pullup devices • Separate keyboard interrupt enable bits and one keyboard interrupt mask • Programmable edge-only or edge- and level- interrupt sensitivity • Exit from low-lower modes Addr. Register Name $001B Read: Keyboard Status and Control Register Write: (KBSCR) Reset: $001C Read: Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register Write: (KBIER) Reset: Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 0 0 0 0 KEYF 0 1 Bit 0 IMASKK MODEK ACKK 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KBIE7 KBIE6 KBIE5 KBIE4 KBIE3 KBIE2 KBIE1 KBIE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 19-1. KBI I/O Register Summary 19.4 I/O Pins The eight keyboard interrupt pins are shared with standard port I/O pins. The full name of the KBI pins are listed in Table 19-1. The generic pin name appear in the text that follows. Table 19-1. Pin Name Conventions KBI Generic Pin Name Full MCU Pin Name Pin Selected for KBI Function by KBIEx Bit in KBIER KBI0–KBI3 PTA0/KBI0–PTA3/KBI3 KBIE0–KBIE3 KBI4–KBI7 PTD4/KBI4–PTD7/KBI7 KBIE4–KBIE7 Technical Data 364 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) MOTOROLA Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) Functional Description 19.5 Functional Description INTERNAL BUS KBI0 ACKK VDD VECTOR FETCH DECODER KEYF RESET . KBIE0 D CLR Q SYNCHRONIZER . CK TO PULLUP ENABLE . KEYBOARD INTERRUPT FF KBI7 KEYBOARD INTERRUPT REQUEST IMASKK MODEK KBIE7 TO PULLUP ENABLE Figure 19-2. Keyboard Interrupt Block Diagram Writing to the KBIE7–KBIE0 bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register independently enables or disables a port A or port D pin as a keyboard interrupt pin. Enabling a keyboard interrupt pin in port A or port D also enables its internal pull-up device. A logic 0 applied to an enabled keyboard interrupt pin latches a keyboard interrupt request. A keyboard interrupt is latched when one or more keyboard pins goes low after all were high. The MODEK bit in the keyboard status and control register controls the triggering mode of the keyboard interrupt. • If the keyboard interrupt is edge-sensitive only, a falling edge on a keyboard pin does not latch an interrupt request if another keyboard pin is already low. To prevent losing an interrupt request on one pin because another pin is still low, software can disable the latter pin while it is low. • If the keyboard interrupt is falling edge- and low level-sensitive, an interrupt request is present as long as any keyboard pin is low. If the MODEK bit is set, the keyboard interrupt pins are both falling edgeand low level-sensitive, and both of the following actions must occur to clear a keyboard interrupt request: MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 365 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) • Vector fetch or software clear — A vector fetch generates an interrupt acknowledge signal to clear the interrupt request. Software may generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a logic 1 to the ACKK bit in the keyboard status and control register KBSCR. The ACKK bit is useful in applications that poll the keyboard interrupt pins and require software to clear the keyboard interrupt request. Writing to the ACKK bit prior to leaving an interrupt service routine can also prevent spurious interrupts due to noise. Setting ACKK does not affect subsequent transitions on the keyboard interrupt pins. A falling edge that occurs after writing to the ACKK bit latches another interrupt request. If the keyboard interrupt mask bit, IMASKK, is clear, the CPU loads the program counter with the vector address at locations $FFDF and $FFDE. • Return of all enabled keyboard interrupt pins to logic 1 — As long as any enabled keyboard interrupt pin is at logic 0, the keyboard interrupt remains set. The vector fetch or software clear and the return of all enabled keyboard interrupt pins to logic 1 may occur in any order. If the MODEK bit is clear, the keyboard interrupt pin is falling-edgesensitive only. With MODEK clear, a vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the keyboard interrupt request. Reset clears the keyboard interrupt request and the MODEK bit, clearing the interrupt request even if a keyboard interrupt pin stays at logic 0. The keyboard flag bit (KEYF) in the keyboard status and control register can be used to see if a pending interrupt exists. The KEYF bit is not affected by the keyboard interrupt mask bit (IMASKK) which makes it useful in applications where polling is preferred. To determine the logic level on a keyboard interrupt pin, use the data direction register to configure the pin as an input and read the data register. NOTE: Setting a keyboard interrupt enable bit (KBIEx) forces the corresponding keyboard interrupt pin to be an input, overriding the data direction register. However, the data direction register bit must be a logic 0 for software to read the pin. Technical Data 366 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) MOTOROLA Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) Keyboard Interrupt Registers 19.5.1 Keyboard Initialization When a keyboard interrupt pin is enabled, it takes time for the internal pull-up to reach a logic 1. Therefore a false interrupt can occur as soon as the pin is enabled. To prevent a false interrupt on keyboard initialization: 1. Mask keyboard interrupts by setting the IMASKK bit in the keyboard status and control register. 2. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register. 3. Write to the ACKK bit in the keyboard status and control register to clear any false interrupts. 4. Clear the IMASKK bit. An interrupt signal on an edge-triggered pin can be acknowledged immediately after enabling the pin. An interrupt signal on an edge- and level-triggered interrupt pin must be acknowledged after a delay that depends on the external load. Another way to avoid a false interrupt: 1. Configure the keyboard pins as outputs by setting the appropriate DDR bits in data direction register. 2. Write logic 1s to the appropriate data register bits. 3. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIEx bits in the keyboard interrupt enable register. 19.6 Keyboard Interrupt Registers Two registers control the operation of the keyboard interrupt module: • Keyboard status and control register • Keyboard interrupt enable register MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 367 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 19.6.1 Keyboard Status and Control Register • Flags keyboard interrupt requests • Acknowledges keyboard interrupt requests • Masks keyboard interrupt requests • Controls keyboard interrupt triggering sensitivity Address: Read: $001B Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 0 0 0 0 KEYF 0 Write: Reset: 1 Bit 0 IMASKK MODEK 0 0 ACKK 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 19-3. Keyboard Status and Control Register (KBSCR) KEYF — Keyboard Flag Bit This read-only bit is set when a keyboard interrupt is pending. Reset clears the KEYF bit. 1 = Keyboard interrupt pending 0 = No keyboard interrupt pending ACKK — Keyboard Acknowledge Bit Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the keyboard interrupt request. ACKK always reads as logic 0. Reset clears ACKK. IMASKK — Keyboard Interrupt Mask Bit Writing a logic 1 to this read/write bit prevents the output of the keyboard interrupt mask from generating interrupt requests. Reset clears the IMASKK bit. 1 = Keyboard interrupt requests masked 0 = Keyboard interrupt requests not masked MODEK — Keyboard Triggering Sensitivity Bit This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the keyboard interrupt pins. Reset clears MODEK. 1 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels 0 = Keyboard interrupt requests on falling edges only Technical Data 368 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) MOTOROLA Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) Low-Power Modes 19.6.2 Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register The keyboard interrupt enable register individually enables or disables the PTA0/KBI0–PTA3/KBI3 and PTD4/KBI4–PTD7/KBI7 pins to operate as a keyboard interrupt pin. Address: $001C Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 KBIE7 KBIE6 KBIE5 KBIE4 KBIE3 KBIE2 KBIE1 KBIE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 19-4. Keyboard Interrupt Enable Register (KBIER) KBIE7–KBIE0 — Keyboard Interrupt Enable Bits Each of these read/write bits enables the corresponding keyboard interrupt pin to latch interrupt requests. Reset clears the keyboard interrupt enable register. 1 = KBIx pin enabled as keyboard interrupt pin 0 = KBIx pin not enabled as keyboard interrupt pin 19.7 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 19.8 Wait Mode The keyboard interrupt module remains active in wait mode. Clearing the IMASKK bit in the keyboard status and control register enables keyboard interrupt requests to bring the MCU out of wait mode. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 369 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) 19.9 Stop Mode The keyboard interrupt module remains active in stop mode. Clearing the IMASKK bit in the keyboard status and control register enables keyboard interrupt requests to bring the MCU out of stop mode. 19.10 Keyboard Module During Break Interrupts The system integration module (SIM) controls whether the keyboard interrupt latch can be cleared during the break state. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (BFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. To allow software to clear the keyboard interrupt latch during a break interrupt, write a logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a latch is cleared during the break state, it remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state. To protect the latch during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), writing to the keyboard acknowledge bit (ACKK) in the keyboard status and control register during the break state has no effect. Technical Data 370 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Keyboard Interrupt Module (KBI) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 20. Computer Operating Properly (COP) 20.1 Contents 20.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371 20.3 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372 20.4 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.1 ICLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.2 STOP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.3 COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.4 Power-On Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373 20.4.5 Internal Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 20.4.6 Reset Vector Fetch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 20.4.7 COPD (COP Disable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .374 20.4.8 COPRS (COP Rate Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374 20.5 COP Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 20.6 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 20.7 Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375 20.8 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .375 20.8.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 20.8.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376 20.9 COP Module During Break Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .376 20.2 Introduction The computer operating properly (COP) module contains a free-running counter that generates a reset if allowed to overflow. The COP module helps software recover from runaway code. Prevent a COP reset by clearing the COP counter periodically. The COP module can be disabled through the COPD bit in the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1). MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Computer Operating Properly (COP) 371 Computer Operating Properly (COP) 20.3 Functional Description Figure 20-1 shows the structure of the COP module. RESET STATUS REGISTER COP TIMEOUT CLEAR STAGES 5–12 STOP INSTRUCTION INTERNAL RESET SOURCES RESET VECTOR FETCH RESET CIRCUIT 12-BIT COP PRESCALER CLEAR ALL STAGES ICLK COPCTL WRITE COP CLOCK 6-BIT COP COUNTER COPEN (FROM SIM) COP DISABLE (COPD FROM CONFIG1) RESET COPCTL WRITE CLEAR COP COUNTER COP RATE SEL (COPRS FROM CONFIG1) Figure 20-1. COP Block Diagram The COP counter is a free-running 6-bit counter preceded by a 12-bit prescaler counter. If not cleared by software, the COP counter overflows and generates an asynchronous reset after 218 – 24 or 213 – 24 ICLK cycles, depending on the state of the COP rate select bit, COPRS, in the CONFIG1 register. With a 213 – 24 ICLK cycle overflow option, a 47-kHz ICLK gives a COP timeout period of 174ms. Writing any value to location $FFFF before an overflow occurs prevents a COP reset by clearing the COP counter and stages 12 through 5 of the prescaler. NOTE: Service the COP immediately after reset and before entering or after exiting STOP Mode to guarantee the maximum time before the first COP counter overflow. Technical Data 372 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Computer Operating Properly (COP) MOTOROLA Computer Operating Properly (COP) I/O Signals A COP reset pulls the RST pin low for 32 ICLK cycles and sets the COP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). In monitor mode, the COP is disabled if the RST pin or the IRQ1 is held at VTST. During the break state, VTST on the RST pin disables the COP. NOTE: Place COP clearing instructions in the main program and not in an interrupt subroutine. Such an interrupt subroutine could keep the COP from generating a reset even while the main program is not working properly. 20.4 I/O Signals The following paragraphs describe the signals shown in Figure 20-1. 20.4.1 ICLK ICLK is the internal oscillator output signal. ICLK frequency is approximately equal to 47-kHz. See Section 23. Electrical Specifications for ICLK parameters. 20.4.2 STOP Instruction The STOP instruction clears the COP prescaler. 20.4.3 COPCTL Write Writing any value to the COP control register (COPCTL) (see 20.5 COP Control Register) clears the COP counter and clears bits 12 through 5 of the prescaler. Reading the COP control register returns the low byte of the reset vector. 20.4.4 Power-On Reset The power-on reset (POR) circuit clears the COP prescaler 4096 ICLK cycles after power-up. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Computer Operating Properly (COP) 373 Computer Operating Properly (COP) 20.4.5 Internal Reset An internal reset clears the COP prescaler and the COP counter. 20.4.6 Reset Vector Fetch A reset vector fetch occurs when the vector address appears on the data bus. A reset vector fetch clears the COP prescaler. 20.4.7 COPD (COP Disable) The COPD signal reflects the state of the COP disable bit (COPD) in the CONFIG1 register. (See Figure 20-2 and Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG).) 20.4.8 COPRS (COP Rate Select) The COPRS signal reflects the state of the COP rate select bit (COPRS) in the CONFIG1 register. Address: $001F Bit 7 6 5 4 Read: 3 2 1 Bit 0 SSREC STOP COPD 0 0 0 0 COPRS LVISTOP LVIRSTD LVIPWRD Write: Reset: 0 0 0 1 0 = Unimplemented Figure 20-2. Configuration Register 1 (CONFIG1) COPRS — COP Rate Select COPRS selects the COP time-out period. Reset clears COPRS. 1 = COP time out period = 213 – 24 ICLK cycles 0 = COP time out period = 218 – 24 ICLK cycles COPD — COP Disable Bit COPD disables the COP module. 1 = COP module disabled 0 = COP module enabled Technical Data 374 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Computer Operating Properly (COP) MOTOROLA Computer Operating Properly (COP) COP Control Register 20.5 COP Control Register The COP control register is located at address $FFFF and overlaps the reset vector. Writing any value to $FFFF clears the COP counter and starts a new timeout period. Reading location $FFFF returns the low byte of the reset vector. Address: $FFFF Bit 7 6 5 4 3 Read: Low byte of reset vector Write: Clear COP counter Reset: Unaffected by reset 2 1 Bit 0 Figure 20-3. COP Control Register (COPCTL) 20.6 Interrupts The COP does not generate CPU interrupt requests. 20.7 Monitor Mode When monitor mode is entered with VTST on the IRQ pin, the COP is disabled as long as VTST remains on the IRQ pin or the RST pin. When monitor mode is entered by having blank reset vectors and not having VTST on the IRQ pin, the COP is automatically disabled until a POR occurs. 20.8 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption standby modes. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Computer Operating Properly (COP) 375 Computer Operating Properly (COP) 20.8.1 Wait Mode The COP remains active during wait mode. To prevent a COP reset during wait mode, periodically clear the COP counter in a CPU interrupt routine. 20.8.2 Stop Mode Stop mode turns off the ICLK input to the COP and clears the COP prescaler. Service the COP immediately before entering or after exiting stop mode to ensure a full COP timeout period after entering or exiting stop mode. To prevent inadvertently turning off the COP with a STOP instruction, a configuration option is available that disables the STOP instruction. When the STOP bit in the configuration register has the STOP instruction is disabled, execution of a STOP instruction results in an illegal opcode reset. 20.9 COP Module During Break Mode The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VTST is present on the RST pin. Technical Data 376 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Computer Operating Properly (COP) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 21. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 21.1 Contents 21.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 21.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377 21.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378 21.4.1 Interrupt LVI Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 21.4.2 Forced Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 21.4.3 Voltage Hysteresis Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380 21.4.4 LVI Trip Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 21.5 LVI Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381 21.6 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382 21.6.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382 21.6.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382 21.2 Introduction This section describes the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module, which monitors the voltage on the VDD pin and can force a reset when the VDD voltage falls below the LVI trip falling voltage, VTRIPF. 21.3 Features Features of the LVI module include: • Programmable LVI interrupt and reset • Selectable LVI trip voltage • Programmable stop mode operation MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 377 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Addr. Register Name Bit 7 6 Read: LVIOUT Low-Voltage Inhibit Status $FE0F Register Write: (LVISR) Reset: 0 LVIIE 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 LVIIF 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 LVIIAK 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 21-1. LVI I/O Register Summary 21.4 Functional Description Figure 21-2 shows the structure of the LVI module. VDD STOP INSTRUCTION LVISTOP FROM CONFIG1 DEFAULT DISABLED FROM CONFIG1 LVIRSTD LVIPWRD FROM CONFIG1 LOW VDD DETECTOR VDD > VTRIPR = 0 LVI RESET VDD ≤ VTRIPF = 1 FROM LVISR LVIIE LVISEL[1:0] FROM CONFIG2 LVI INTERRUPT REQUEST EDGE DETECT LATCH CLR LVIOUT LVIIACK LVIIF TO LVISR FROM LVISR TO LVISR Figure 21-2. LVI Module Block Diagram The LVI is disabled out of reset. The LVI module contains a bandgap reference circuit and comparator. Clearing the LVI power disable bit, LVIPWRD, enables the LVI to monitor VDD voltage. Clearing the LVI reset disable bit, LVIRSTD, enables the LVI module to generate a reset when VDD falls below a voltage, VTRIPF. Setting the LVI enable in stop mode bit, LVISTOP, enables the LVI to operate in stop mode. Technical Data 378 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) MOTOROLA Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Functional Description The LVI trip point selection bits, LVISEL[1:0], select the trip point voltage, VTRIPF, to be configured for 5V or 3.3V operation. The actual trip points are shown in Section 23. Electrical Specifications. Setting LVI interrupt enable bit, LVIIE, enables LVI interrupts whenever the LVIOUT bit toggles (from logic 0 to logic 1, or from logic 1 to logic 0). NOTE: After a power-on reset (POR) the user must configure the LVISEL[1:0} bits for 3.3V or 5V operation before enabling the LVI module (by clearing the LVIPWRD bit in CONFIG1 register). NOTE: If the user requires 3.3V mode and enables the LVI module after configuring the LVISEL[1;0] bits to 3.3V operation mode while the VDD supply is not above the VTRIPF for 3.3V mode, the MCU will immediately go into reset. The LVI in this case will hold the MCU in reset until either VDD goes above the rising 3.3V trip point, VTRIPR, which will release reset or VDD decreases to approximately 0V which will re-trigger the power-on reset. LVISTOP, LVIPWRD, LVIRSTD, and LVISEL[1:0] are in the configuration registers. See Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG) for details of the LVI’s configuration bits. Once an LVI reset occurs, the MCU remains in reset until VDD rises above a voltage, VTRIPR, which causes the MCU to exit reset. See 9.4.2.5 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset for details of the interaction between the SIM and the LVI. The output of the comparator controls the state of the LVIOUT flag in the LVI status register (LVISR). The LVIIE, LVIIF, and LVIIAK bits in the LVISR control LVI interrupt functions. An LVI reset also drives the RST pin low to provide low-voltage protection to external peripheral devices. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 379 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 21.4.1 Interrupt LVI Operation In applications that can operate at VDD levels below the VTRIPF level, software can monitor VDD by polling the LVIOUT bit, or by setting the LVI interrupt enable bit, LVIIE, to enable interrupt requests. In the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1), the LVIPWRD bit must be at logic 0 to enable the LVI module, and the LVIRSTD bit must be at logic 1 to disable LVI resets. The LVI interrupt flag, LVIIF, is set whenever the LVIOUT bit changes state (toggles). When LVIF is set, a CPU interrupt request is generated if the LVIIE is also set. In the LVI interrupt service subroutine, LVIIF bit can be cleared by writing a logic 1 to the LVI interrupt acknowledge bit, LVIIAK. 21.4.2 Forced Reset Operation In applications that require VDD to remain above the VTRIPF level, enabling LVI resets allows the LVI module to reset the MCU when VDD falls below the VTRIPF level. In the configuration register 1 (CONFIG1), the LVIPWRD and LVIRSTD bits must be at logic 0 to enable the LVI module and to enable LVI resets. If LVIIE is set to enable LVI interrupts when LVIRSTD is cleared, LVI reset has a higher priority over LVI interrupt. In this case, when VDD falls below the VTRIPF level, an LVI reset will occur, and the LVIIE bit will be cleared. 21.4.3 Voltage Hysteresis Protection Once the LVI has triggered (by having VDD fall below VTRIPF), the LVI will maintain a reset condition until VDD rises above the rising trip point voltage, VTRIPR. This prevents a condition in which the MCU is continually entering and exiting reset if VDD is approximately equal to VTRIPF. VTRIPR is greater than VTRIPF by the hysteresis voltage, VHYS. Technical Data 380 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) MOTOROLA Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) LVI Status Register 21.4.4 LVI Trip Selection The trip point selection bits, LVISEL[1:0], in the CONFIG2 register select whether the LVI is configured for 5V or 3.3 V operation. (See Section 5. Configuration Registers (CONFIG).) NOTE: The MCU is guaranteed to operate at a minimum supply voltage. The trip point (VTRIPF [5 V] or VTRIPF [3.3 V]) may be lower than this. (See Section 23. Electrical Specifications for the actual trip point voltages.) 21.5 LVI Status Register The LVI status register (LVISR) controls LVI interrupt functions and indicates if the VDD voltage was detected below the VTRIPF level. Address: $FE0F Bit 7 Read: 6 LVIOUT 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 LVIIF 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 LVIIE Write: Reset: LVIIAK 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Table 21-1. LVI Status Register (LVISR) LVIOUT — LVI Output Bit This read-only flag becomes set when the VDD voltage falls below the VTRIPF trip voltage (see Table 21-2). Reset clears the LVIOUT bit. Table 21-2. LVIOUT Bit Indication VDD LVIOUT VDD > VTRIPR 0 VDD < VTRIPF 1 VTRIPF < VDD < VTRIPR Previous value MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) 381 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) LVIIE — LVI Interrupt Enable Bit This read/write bit enables the LVIIF bit to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the LVIIE bit. 1 = LVIIF can generate CPU interrupt requests 0 = LVIIF cannot generate CPU interrupt requests LVIIF — LVI Interrupt Flag This clearable, read-only flag is set whenever the LVIOUT bit toggles. Reset clears the LVIIF bit. 1 = LVIOUT has toggled 0 = LVIOUT has not toggled LVIIAK — LVI Interrupt Acknowledge Bit Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the LVI interrupt flag, LVIIF. LVIIAK always reads as logic 0. 1 = Clears LVIIF bit 0 = No effect 21.6 Low-Power Modes The STOP and WAIT instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 21.6.1 Wait Mode If enabled, the LVI module remains active in wait mode. If enabled to generate resets or interrupts, the LVI module can generate a reset or an interrupt and bring the MCU out of wait mode. 21.6.2 Stop Mode If enabled in stop mode (LVISTOP = 1), the LVI module remains active in stop mode. If enabled to generate resets or interrupts, the LVI module can generate a reset or an interrupt and bring the MCU out of stop mode. NOTE: If enabled to generate both resets and interrupts, there will be no LVI interrupts, as resets have a higher priority. Technical Data 382 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 22. Break Module (BRK) 22.1 Contents 22.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383 22.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 22.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384 22.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386 22.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 22.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386 22.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 22.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .386 22.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386 22.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 22.6 Break Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .387 22.6.1 Break Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387 22.6.2 Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .388 22.6.3 SIM Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388 22.6.4 SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390 22.2 Introduction This section describes the break module. The break module can generate a break interrupt that stops normal program flow at a defined address to enter a background program. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Break Module (BRK) 383 Break Module (BRK) 22.3 Features Features of the break module include: • Accessible input/output (I/O) registers during the break interrupt • CPU-generated break interrupts • Software-generated break interrupts • COP disabling during break interrupts 22.4 Functional Description When the internal address bus matches the value written in the break address registers, the break module issues a breakpoint signal to the CPU. The CPU then loads the instruction register with a software interrupt instruction (SWI) after completion of the current CPU instruction. The program counter vectors to $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode). The following events can cause a break interrupt to occur: • A CPU-generated address (the address in the program counter) matches the contents of the break address registers. • Software writes a logic 1 to the BRKA bit in the break status and control register. When a CPU-generated address matches the contents of the break address registers, the break interrupt begins after the CPU completes its current instruction. A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the break interrupt and returns the MCU to normal operation. Figure 22-1 shows the structure of the break module. Technical Data 384 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Break Module (BRK) MOTOROLA Break Module (BRK) Functional Description IAB15–IAB8 BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH 8-BIT COMPARATOR IAB15–IAB0 BREAK CONTROL 8-BIT COMPARATOR BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW IAB7–IAB0 Figure 22-1. Break Module Block Diagram Addr. Register Name Read: SIM Break Status Register $FE00 Write: (SBSR) Reset: $FE03 Read: SIM Break Flag Control Register Write: (SBFCR) Reset: $FE0C $FE0D Read: Break Address Register High Write: (BRKH) Reset: Read: Break Address Register Low Write: (BRKL) Reset: Read: Break Status and Control $FE0E Register Write: (BRKSCR) Reset: Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW. Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 R R R R R R 1 SBSW Note Bit 0 R 0 BCFE R R R R R R R Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BRKE BRKA 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented R = Reserved Figure 22-2. Break Module I/O Register Summary MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Break Module (BRK) 385 Break Module (BRK) 22.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables software to clear status bits during the break state. 22.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts The CPU starts a break interrupt by: • Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction • Loading the program counter with $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and $FEFD in monitor mode) The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in progress. If the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately. 22.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts A break interrupt stops the timer counters. 22.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VTST is present on the RST pin. 22.5 Low-Power Modes The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes. 22.5.1 Wait Mode If enabled, the break module is active in wait mode. In the break routine, the user can subtract one from the return address on the stack if SBSW is set (see Section 9. System Integration Module (SIM)). Clear the SBSW bit by writing logic 0 to it. Technical Data 386 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Break Module (BRK) MOTOROLA Break Module (BRK) Break Module Registers 22.5.2 Stop Mode A break interrupt causes exit from stop mode and sets the SBSW bit in the break status register. 22.6 Break Module Registers These registers control and monitor operation of the break module: • Break status and control register (BRKSCR) • Break address register high (BRKH) • Break address register low (BRKL) • SIM break status register (SBSR) • SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) 22.6.1 Break Status and Control Register The break status and control register (BRKSCR) contains break module enable and status bits. Address: $FE0E Bit 7 6 BRKE BRKA 0 0 Read: 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Write: Reset: = Unimplemented Figure 22-3. Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR) BRKE — Break Enable Bit This read/write bit enables breaks on break address register matches. Clear BRKE by writing a logic 0 to bit 7. Reset clears the BRKE bit. 1 = Breaks enabled on 16-bit address match 0 = Breaks disabled on 16-bit address match MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Break Module (BRK) 387 Break Module (BRK) BRKA — Break Active Bit This read/write status and control bit is set when a break address match occurs. Writing a logic 1 to BRKA generates a break interrupt. Clear BRKA by writing a logic 0 to it before exiting the break routine. Reset clears the BRKA bit. 1 = (When read) Break address match 0 = (When read) No break address match 22.6.2 Break Address Registers The break address registers (BRKH and BRKL) contain the high and low bytes of the desired breakpoint address. Reset clears the break address registers. Address: $FE0C Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 22-4. Break Address Register High (BRKH) Address: $FE0D Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Read: Write: Reset: Figure 22-5. Break Address Register Low (BRKL) 22.6.3 SIM Break Status Register The SIM break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break caused an exit from wait mode. The flag is useful in applications requiring a return to wait mode after exiting from a break interrupt. Technical Data 388 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Break Module (BRK) MOTOROLA Break Module (BRK) Break Module Registers Address: $FE00 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 R R R R R R Read: 1 Bit 0 SBSW R Write: Note Reset: 0 Note: Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW. R = Reserved Figure 22-6. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) SBSW — Break Wait Bit This status bit is set when a break interrupt causes an exit from wait mode or stop mode. Clear SBSW by writing a logic 0 to it. Reset clears SBSW. 1 = Stop mode or wait mode was exited by break interrupt 0 = Stop mode or wait mode was not exited by break interrupt SBSW can be read within the break interrupt routine. The user can modify the return address on the stack by subtracting 1 from it. The following code is an example. ; This code works if the H register has been pushed onto the stack in the break ; service routine software. This code should be executed at the end of the break ; service routine software. HIBYTE EQU 5 LOBYTE EQU 6 ; If not SBSW, do RTI BRCLR SBSW,SBSR, RETURN ; See if wait mode or stop mode was exited by ; break. TST LOBYTE,SP ;If RETURNLO is not zero, BNE DOLO ;then just decrement low byte. DEC HIBYTE,SP ;Else deal with high byte, too. DOLO DEC LOBYTE,SP ;Point to WAIT/STOP opcode. RETURN PULH RTI ;Restore H register. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Break Module (BRK) 389 Break Module (BRK) 22.6.4 SIM Break Flag Control Register The SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) contains a bit that enables software to clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state. Address: $FE03 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 BCFE R R R R R R R Read: Write: Reset: 0 R = Reserved Figure 22-7. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set. 1 = Status bits clearable during break 0 = Status bits not clearable during break Technical Data 390 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Break Module (BRK) MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 23. Electrical Specifications 23.1 Contents 23.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392 23.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .392 23.4 Functional Operating Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 23.5 Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393 23.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394 23.7 3.3V DC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396 23.8 5.0V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 23.9 3.3V Control Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397 23.10 5.0V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 23.11 3.3V Oscillator Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 23.12 5.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399 23.13 3.3V ADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 23.14 Timer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 23.15 CGM Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401 23.16 5.0V SPI Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402 23.17 3.3V SPI Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403 23.18 FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Electrical Specifications 391 Electrical Specifications 23.2 Introduction This section contains electrical and timing specifications. 23.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings Maximum ratings are the extreme limits to which the MCU can be exposed without permanently damaging it. NOTE: This device is not guaranteed to operate properly at the maximum ratings. Refer to 23.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics for guaranteed operating conditions. Table 23-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings(1) Characteristic Symbol Value Unit Supply voltage VDD –0.3 to +6.0 V Input voltage All pins (except IRQ) IRQ pin VIN VSS –0.3 to VDD +0.3 VSS –0.3 to 8.5 V I ±25 mA Maximum current out of VSS IMVSS 100 mA Maximum current into VDD IMVDD 100 mA Storage temperature TSTG –55 to +150 °C Maximum current per pin excluding VDD and VSS Notes: 1. Voltages referenced to VSS. NOTE: This device contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage due to high static voltages or electric fields; however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltage higher than maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. For proper operation, it is recommended that VIN and VOUT be constrained to the range VSS ≤ (VIN or VOUT) ≤ VDD. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused inputs are connected to an appropriate logic voltage level (for example, either VSS or VDD.) Technical Data 392 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications Functional Operating Range 23.4 Functional Operating Range Table 23-2. Operating Range Characteristic Operating temperature range Operating voltage range Symbol Value Unit TA – 40 to +85 °C VDD 3.3V ± 10% 5.0V ± 10% V 23.5 Thermal Characteristics Table 23-3. Thermal Characteristics Characteristic Symbol Value Unit Thermal resistance 52-pin LQFP 64-pin LQFP 64-pin QFP θJA 85 80 70 °C/W I/O pin power dissipation PI/O User determined W Power dissipation(1) PD PD = (IDD × VDD) + PI/O = K/(TJ + 273 °C) W Constant(2) K Average junction temperature TJ PD x (TA + 273 °C) + PD2 × θJA W/°C TA + (PD × θJA) °C Notes: 1. Power dissipation is a function of temperature. 2. K constant unique to the device. K can be determined for a known TA and measured PD. With this value of K, PD and TJ can be determined for any value of TA. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Electrical Specifications 393 Electrical Specifications 23.6 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics Table 23-4. 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics Characteristic(1) Symbol Min Typ(2) Max Unit Output high voltage (ILOAD = –2.0 mA) All ports VOH VDD –0.8 — — V Output low voltage (ILOAD = 1.6mA) All ports (ILOAD = 8.0 mA) PTB2–PTB5 (ILOAD = 15.0 mA) PTB0/TxD–PTB1 VOL — — 0.4 V Input high voltage All ports, RST, IRQ, OSC1 VIH 0.7 × VDD — VDD V Input low voltage All ports, RST, IRQ, OSC1 VIL VSS — 0.3 × VDD V IDD — — — — — — — — 18 15 12 10 mA mA mA mA — — — — — — — — 350 50 30 1 µA µA µA µA VDD supply current Run(3), fOP = 8 MHz with all modules on with ADC on with ADC off Wait(4), fOP = 8 MHz (all modules off) Stop, fOP = 8 kHz (5) 25°C (with OSC, RTC, LCD(6), LVI on) 25°C (with OSC, RTC, LCD(6) on) 25°C (with OSC, RTC on) 25°C (all modules off) Digital I/O ports Hi-Z leakage current All ports, RST IIL — — ± 10 µA Input current IRQ IIN — — ±1 µA Capacitance Ports (as input or output) COUT CIN — — — — 12 8 pF POR re-arm voltage(7) VPOR 0 — 100 mV POR rise-time ramp rate(8) RPOR 0.035 — — V/ms Monitor mode entry voltage (at IRQ pin) VTST 1.5 × VDD — 8 V Pullup resistors(9) PTA0–PTA3, PTD4–PTD7 configured as KBI0–KBI7 RST, IRQ RPU1 RPU2 — — 28 28 — — kΩ kΩ Low-voltage inhibit, trip falling voltage VTRIPF 4.00 4.32 4.70 V Low-voltage inhibit, trip rising voltage VTRIPR 4.00 4.32 4.70 V Technical Data 394 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications 5.0V DC Electrical Characteristics Notes: 1. VDD = 4.5 to 5.5 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted. 2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25 °C only. 3. Run (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects run IDD. 4. Wait IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD. 5. The 8kHz clock is from a 32kHz clock input at OSC1, for the driving the RTC. 6. LCD driver configured for high current mode. 7. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed. 8. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum VDD is reached. 9. RPU1 and RPU2 are measured at VDD = 5.0V MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Electrical Specifications 395 Electrical Specifications 23.7 3.3V DC Electrical Characteristics Table 23-5. 3.3V DC Electrical Characteristics Characteristic(1) Symbol Min Typ(2) Max Unit Output high voltage (ILOAD = –1.0 mA) All ports VOH VDD –0.4 — — V Output low voltage (ILOAD = 0.8mA) All ports (ILOAD = 4.0 mA) PTB2–PTB5 (ILOAD = 10.0 mA) PTB0/TxD–PTB1 VOL — — 0.4 V Input high voltage All ports, RST, IRQ, OSC1 VIH 0.7 × VDD — VDD V Input low voltage All ports, RST, IRQ, OSC1 VIL VSS — 0.3 × VDD V IDD — — — — — — — — 8 6 5 3.5 mA mA mA mA — — — — — — — — 280 38 25 1 µA µA µA µA VDD supply current Run(3), fOP = 4 MHz with all modules on with ADC on with ADC off Wait(4), fOP = 4 MHz (all modules off) Stop, fOP = 8 kHz (5) 25°C (with OSC, RTC, LCD(6), LVI on) 25°C (with OSC, RTC, LCD(6) on) 25°C (with OSC, RTC on) 25°C (all modules off) Digital I/O ports Hi-Z leakage current All ports, RST IIL — — ± 10 µA Input current IRQ IIN — — ±1 µA Capacitance Ports (as input or output) COUT CIN — — — — 12 8 pF POR re-arm voltage(7) VPOR 0 — 100 mV POR rise-time ramp rate(8) RPOR 0.02 — — V/ms VHI 1.5 × VDD — 2 × VDD V RPU1 RPU2 — — 26 28 — — kΩ kΩ Low-voltage inhibit, trip falling voltage VTRIPF 2.40 2.57 2.88 V Low-voltage inhibit, trip rising voltage VTRIPR 2.46 2.63 2.97 V Monitor mode entry voltage (at IRQ pin) Pullup resistors(9) PTA0–PTA3, PTD4–PTD7 configured as KBI0–KBI7 RST, IRQ Technical Data 396 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications 5.0V Control Timing Notes: 1. VDD = 3.0 to 3.6 Vdc, VSS = 0 Vdc, TA = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted. 2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25 °C only. 3. Run (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects run IDD. 4. Wait IDD measured using external square wave clock source. All inputs 0.2 V from rail. No dc loads. Less than 100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2. All ports configured as inputs. OSC2 capacitance linearly affects wait IDD. 5. The 8kHz clock is from a 32kHz clock input at OSC1, for the driving the RTC. 6. LCD driver configured for high current mode. 7. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed. 8. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR reset is released, RST must be driven low externally until minimum VDD is reached. 9. RPU1 and RPU2 are measured at VDD = 3.3V. 23.8 5.0V Control Timing Table 23-6. 5.0V Control Timing Characteristic(1) Symbol Min Max Unit Internal operating frequency(2) fOP — 8 MHz RST input pulse width low(3) tIRL 750 — ns Notes: 1. VSS = 0 Vdc; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise noted. 2. Some modules may require a minimum frequency greater than dc for proper operation; see appropriate table for this information. 3. Minimum pulse width reset is guaranteed to be recognized. It is possible for a smaller pulse width to cause a reset. 23.9 3.3V Control Timing Table 23-7. 3.3V Control Timing Characteristic(1) Symbol Min Max Unit Internal operating frequency(2) fOP — 4 MHz RST input pulse width low(3) tIRL 1.5 — µs Notes: 1. VSS = 0 Vdc; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise noted. 2. Some modules may require a minimum frequency greater than dc for proper operation; see appropriate table for this information. 3. Minimum pulse width reset is guaranteed to be recognized. It is possible for a smaller pulse width to cause a reset. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Electrical Specifications 397 Electrical Specifications 23.10 5.0V Oscillator Characteristics Table 23-8. 5.0V Oscillator Specifications Characteristic Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Internal oscillator clock frequency fICLK 46k 47k(1) 48k Hz External reference clock to OSC1(2) fOSC dc — 20M Hz Crystal reference frequency(3) fXCLK 32.768k 4.9152M Hz Crystal load capacitance(4) CL — — — Crystal fixed capacitance C1 — 2 × CL (25p) — F Crystal tuning capacitance C2 — 2 × CL (25p) — F Feedback bias resistor RB — 10M — Ω Series resistor(5) RS — 100k — Ω Notes: 1. Typical value reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25 °C only. 2. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%. 3. Fundamental mode crystals only. 4. Consult crystal manufacturer’s data. 5. Not Required for high frequency crystals. 23.11 3.3V Oscillator Characteristics Table 23-9. 3.3V Oscillator Specifications Characteristic Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Internal oscillator clock frequency fICLK 42.8k 43.4k(1) 44k Hz External reference clock to OSC1(2) fOSC dc — 16M Hz Crystal reference frequency(3) fXCLK 32.768k 4.9152M Hz Crystal load capacitance(4) CL — — — Crystal fixed capacitance C1 — 2 × CL (25p) — F Crystal tuning capacitance C2 — 2 × CL (25p) — F Feedback bias resistor RB — 10M — Ω Series resistor(5) RS — 100k — Ω Notes: 1. Typical value reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25 °C only. 2. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%. 3. Fundamental mode crystals only. 4. Consult crystal manufacturer’s data. 5. Not Required for high frequency crystals. Technical Data 398 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications 5.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics 23.12 5.0V ADC Electrical Characteristics Table 23-10. ADC 5.0V Electrical Characteristics Characteristic Symbol Min Max Unit Supply voltage VDDA 4.5 5.5 V VDDA is an dedicated pin and should be tied to VDD on the PCB with proper decoupling. Input range VADIN 0 VDDA V VADIN ≤ VDDA Resolution BAD 10 10 bits Absolute accuracy AAD — ± 1.5 LSB ADC internal clock fADIC 32 k 2M Hz Conversion range RAD VREFL VREFH V ADC voltage reference high VREFH — VDDA + 0.1 V ADC voltage reference low VREFL VSSA – 0.1 — V Conversion time tADC 16 17 tADIC cycles Sample time tADS 5 — tADIC cycles Monotonically MAD Zero input reading ZADI 000 001 HEX VADIN = VREFL Full-scale reading FADI 3FC 3FF HEX VADIN = VREFH Input capacitance CADI — 20 pF Input impedance RADI 20M — Ω VREFH/VREFL IVREF — 1.6 mA Includes quantization. ±0.5 LSB = ±1 ADC count. tADIC = 1/fADIC VSSA is tied to VSS internally. Guaranteed MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Notes Not tested. Not tested. Technical Data Electrical Specifications 399 Electrical Specifications 23.13 3.3V ADC Electrical Characteristics Table 23-11. ADC 3.3V Electrical Characteristics Characteristic Symbol Min Max Unit Supply voltage VDDA 3.0 3.6 V VDDA is an dedicated pin and should be tied to VDD on the PCB with proper decoupling. Input range VADIN 0 VDDA V VADIN ≤ VDDA Resolution BAD 10 10 bits Absolute accuracy AAD — ± 1.5 LSB ADC internal clock fADIC 32 k 2M Hz Conversion range RAD VREFL VREFH V ADC voltage reference high VREFH — VDDA + 0.1 V ADC voltage reference low VREFL VSSA – 0.1 — V Conversion time tADC 16 17 tADIC cycles Sample time tADS 5 — tADIC cycles Monotonically MAD Zero input reading ZADI 000 001 HEX VADIN = VREFL Full-scale reading FADI 3FC 3FF HEX VADIN = VREFH Input capacitance CADI — 20 pF Not tested. Input impedance RADI 20M — Ω Measured at 5V VREFH/VREFL IVREF — 1.6 mA Includes quantization. ±0.5 LSB = ±1 ADC count. tADIC = 1/fADIC VSSA is tied to VSS internally. Guaranteed Technical Data 400 Notes Not tested. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications Timer Interface Module Characteristics 23.14 Timer Interface Module Characteristics Characteristic Input capture pulse width Symbol Min Max Unit tTIH, tTIL 1 — tCYC 23.15 CGM Electrical Specifications Characteristic Symbol Min Typ Max Unit Reference frequency fRDV 30 32.768 100 kHz Range nominal multiplies fNOM — 38.4 — kHz VCO center-of-range frequency fVRS 38.4k — 40.0M Hz VCO range linear range multiplier L 1 — 255 VCO power-of-two-range multiplier 2E 1 — 4 VCO multiply factor N 1 — 4095 VCO prescale multiplier 2P 1 — 8 Reference divider factor R 1 1 15 VCO operating frequency fVCLK 38.4k — 40.0M Hz Manual acquisition time tLOCK — — 50 ms Automatic lock time tLOCK — — 50 ms — fRCLK × 0.025% × 2P N/4 Hz PLL jitter(1) fJ 0 Notes: 1. Deviation of average bus frequency over 2ms. N = VCO multiplier. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Electrical Specifications 401 Electrical Specifications 23.16 5.0V SPI Characteristics Diagram Number(1) Characteristic(2) Symbol Min Max Unit Operating frequency Master Slave fOP(M) fOP(S) fOP/128 dc fOP/2 fOP MHz MHz 1 Cycle time Master Slave tCYC(M) tCYC(S) 2 1 128 — tCYC tCYC 2 Enable lead time tLead(S) 1 — tCYC 3 Enable lag time tLag(S) 1 — tCYC 4 Clock (SPSCK) high time Master Slave tSCKH(M) tSCKH(S) tCYC –25 1/2 tCYC –25 64 tCYC — ns ns 5 Clock (SPSCK) low time Master Slave tSCKL(M) tSCKL(S) tCYC –25 1/2 tCYC –25 64 tCYC — ns ns 6 Data setup time (inputs) Master Slave tSU(M) tSU(S) 30 30 — — ns ns 7 Data hold time (inputs) Master Slave tH(M) tH(S) 30 30 — — ns ns 8 Access time, slave(3) CPHA = 0 CPHA = 1 tA(CP0) tA(CP1) 0 0 40 40 ns ns 9 Disable time, slave(4) tDIS(S) — 40 ns 10 Data valid time, after enable edge Master Slave(5) tV(M) tV(S) — — 50 50 ns ns 11 Data hold time, outputs, after enable edge Master Slave tHO(M) tHO(S) 0 0 — — ns ns Notes: 1. Numbers refer to dimensions in Figure 23-1 and Figure 23-2. 2. All timing is shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless noted; 100 pF load on all SPI pins. 3. Time to data active from high-impedance state 4. Hold time to high-impedance state 5. With 100 pF on all SPI pins Technical Data 402 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications 3.3V SPI Characteristics 23.17 3.3V SPI Characteristics Diagram Number(1) Characteristic(2) Symbol Min Max Unit Operating frequency Master Slave fOP(M) fOP(S) fOP/128 dc fOP/2 fOP MHz MHz 1 Cycle time Master Slave tCYC(M) tCYC(S) 2 1 128 — tCYC tCYC 2 Enable lead time tLead(s) 1 — tCYC 3 Enable lag time tLag(s) 1 — tCYC 4 Clock (SPSCK) high time Master Slave tSCKH(M) tSCKH(S) tCYC –35 1/2 tCYC –35 64 tCYC — ns ns 5 Clock (SPSCK) low time Master Slave tSCKL(M) tSCKL(S) tCYC –35 1/2 tCYC –35 64 tCYC — ns ns 6 Data setup time (inputs) Master Slave tSU(M) tSU(S) 40 40 — — ns ns 7 Data hold time (inputs) Master Slave tH(M) tH(S) 40 40 — — ns ns 8 Access time, slave(3) CPHA = 0 CPHA = 1 tA(CP0) tA(CP1) 0 0 50 50 ns ns 9 Disable time, slave(4) tDIS(S) — 50 ns 10 Data valid time, after enable edge Master Slave(5) tV(M) tV(S) — — 60 60 ns ns 11 Data hold time, outputs, after enable edge Master Slave tHO(M) tHO(S) 0 0 — — ns ns Notes: 1. Numbers refer to dimensions in Figure 23-1 and Figure 23-2. 2. All timing is shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless noted; 100 pF load on all SPI pins. 3. Time to data active from high-impedance state 4. Hold time to high-impedance state 5. With 100 pF on all SPI pins MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Electrical Specifications 403 Electrical Specifications SS INPUT SS PIN OF MASTER HELD HIGH 1 SPSCK OUTPUT CPOL = 0 NOTE SPSCK OUTPUT CPOL = 1 NOTE 5 4 5 4 6 MISO INPUT MSB IN BITS 6–1 11 MOSI OUTPUT MASTER MSB OUT 7 LSB IN 10 11 BITS 6–1 MASTER LSB OUT Note: This first clock edge is generated internally, but is not seen at the SPSCK pin. a) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 0) SS INPUT SS PIN OF MASTER HELD HIGH 1 SPSCK OUTPUT CPOL = 0 5 NOTE 4 SPSCK OUTPUT CPOL = 1 5 NOTE 4 6 MISO INPUT MSB IN 10 MOSI OUTPUT BITS 6–1 11 MASTER MSB OUT 7 LSB IN 10 BITS 6–1 MASTER LSB OUT Note: This last clock edge is generated internally, but is not seen at the SPSCK pin. b) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 1) Figure 23-1. SPI Master Timing Technical Data 404 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Electrical Specifications 3.3V SPI Characteristics SS INPUT 3 1 SPSCK INPUT CPOL = 0 5 4 2 SPSCK INPUT CPOL = 1 5 4 9 8 MISO INPUT SLAVE MSB OUT 6 MOSI OUTPUT BITS 6–1 7 NOTE 11 11 10 MSB IN SLAVE LSB OUT BITS 6–1 LSB IN Note: Not defined but normally MSB of character just received a) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 0) SS INPUT 1 SPSCK INPUT CPOL = 0 5 4 2 3 SPSCK INPUT CPOL = 1 8 MISO OUTPUT 5 4 10 NOTE MOSI INPUT 9 SLAVE MSB OUT 6 7 BITS 6–1 11 10 MSB IN SLAVE LSB OUT BITS 6–1 LSB IN Note: Not defined but normally LSB of character previously transmitted b) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 1) Figure 23-2. SPI Slave Timing MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Electrical Specifications 405 Electrical Specifications 23.18 FLASH Memory Characteristics Table 23-12. FLASH Memory Electrical Characteristics Characteristic Data retention voltage Symbol Min. Max. Unit VRDR 1.3 — V Number of rows per page 2 Rows Number of bytes per page 128 Bytes Read bus clock frequency fRead(1) 32k 8M Hz Page erase time tErase(2) 1 — ms Mass erase time tMErase(3) 4 — ms PGM/ERASE to HVEN setup time tnvs 10 — µs High-voltage hold time tnvh 5 — µs High-voltage hold time (mass erase) tnvhl 100 — µs Program hold time tpgs 5 — µs Program time tProg 30 40 µs Address/data setup time tads — 30 ns Address/data hold time tadh — 30 ns Recovery time trcv(4) 1 — µs Cumulative HV period thv(5) — 25 ms Row erase endurance(6) — 10k — Cycles Row program endurance(7) — 10k — Cycles Data retention time(8) — 10 — Years Notes: 1. fRead is defined as the frequency range for which the FLASH memory can be read. 2. If the page erase time is longer than tErase (Min.), there is no erase-disturb, but it reduces the endurance of the FLASH memory. 3. If the mass erase time is longer than tMErase (Min.), there is no erase-disturb, but is reduces the endurance of the FLASH memory. 4. It is defined as the time it needs before the FLASH can be read after turning off the high voltage charge pump, by clearing HVEN to logic 0. 5. thv is the cumulative high voltage programming time to the same row before next erase, and the same address can not be programmed twice before next erase. 6. The minimum row endurance value specifies each row of the FLASH memory is guaranteed to work for at least this many erase/program cycles. 7. The minimum row endurance value specifies each row of the FLASH memory is guaranteed to work for at least this many erase/program cycle. 8. The FLASH is guaranteed to retain data over the entire operating temperature range for at least the minimum time specified. Technical Data 406 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Electrical Specifications MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 24. Mechanical Specifications 24.1 Contents 24.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407 24.3 52-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408 24.4 64-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409 24.5 64-Pin Quad Flat Pack (QFP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410 24.2 Introduction This section gives the dimensions for: • 52-pin low-profile quad flat pack (case no. 848D) • 64-pin low-profile quad flat pack (case no. 840F) • 64-pin quad flat pack (case no. 840B) The following figures show the latest package drawings at the time of this publication. To make sure that you have the latest package specifications, contact one of the following: • Local Motorola Sales Office • World Wide Web at http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/ Follow the World Wide Web on-line instructions to retrieve the current mechanical specifications. MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Mechanical Specifications 407 Mechanical Specifications 24.3 52-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) 4X 4X 13 TIPS 0.20 (0.008) H L–M N 0.20 (0.008) T L–M N –X– X=L, M, N 52 40 1 CL 39 AB 3X G VIEW Y –L– –M– AB B B1 13 V VIEW Y BASE METAL F PLATING V1 27 14 J 26 U –N– A1 0.13 (0.005) M D T L–M S N S S1 SECTION AB–AB A ROTATED 90° CLOCKWISE S 4X C θ2 0.10 (0.004) T –H– –T– SEATING PLANE 4X θ3 VIEW AA 0.05 (0.002) S W θ1 C2 2X R θ R1 0.25 (0.010) GAGE PLANE K C1 E VIEW AA Z NOTES: 1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI Y14.5M, 1982. 2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER. 3. DATUM PLANE –H– IS LOCATED AT BOTTOM OF LEAD AND IS COINCIDENT WITH THE LEAD WHERE THE LEAD EXITS THE PLASTIC BODY AT THE BOTTOM OF THE PARTING LINE. 4. DATUMS –L–, –M– AND –N– TO BE DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE –H–. 5. DIMENSIONS S AND V TO BE DETERMINED AT SEATING PLANE –T–. 6. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE PROTRUSION IS 0.25 (0.010) PER SIDE. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO INCLUDE MOLD MISMATCH AND ARE DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE –H–. 7. DIMENSION D DOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR PROTRUSION. DAMBAR PROTRUSION SHALL NOT CAUSE THE LEAD WIDTH TO EXCEED 0.46 (0.018). MINIMUM SPACE BETWEEN PROTRUSION AND ADJACENT LEAD OR PROTRUSION 0.07 (0.003). DIM A A1 B B1 C C1 C2 D E F G J K R1 S S1 U V V1 W Z θ θ1 θ2 θ3 MILLIMETERS MIN MAX 10.00 BSC 5.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 5.00 BSC ––– 1.70 0.05 0.20 1.30 1.50 0.20 0.40 0.75 0.45 0.22 0.35 0.65 BSC 0.07 0.20 0.50 REF 0.08 0.20 12.00 BSC 6.00 BSC 0.09 0.16 12.00 BSC 6.00 BSC 0.20 REF 1.00 REF 0° 7° ––– 0° 12° REF 12° REF INCHES MIN MAX 0.394 BSC 0.197 BSC 0.394 BSC 0.197 BSC ––– 0.067 0.002 0.008 0.051 0.059 0.008 0.016 0.018 0.030 0.009 0.014 0.026 BSC 0.003 0.008 0.020 REF 0.003 0.008 0.472 BSC 0.236 BSC 0.004 0.006 0.472 BSC 0.236 BSC 0.008 REF 0.039 REF 0° 7° ––– 0° 12° REF 12° REF Figure 24-1. 52-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (Case No. 848D) Technical Data 408 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Mechanical Specifications MOTOROLA Mechanical Specifications 64-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) 24.4 64-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (LQFP) 4X 4X 16 TIPS 0.2 H A–B D 0.2 C A–B D A2 0.05 S 49 64 (S) 1 48 θ1 A 0.25 B θ E E1 E1/2 VIEW Y 16 E/2 VIEW AA NOTES: 1. DIMENSIONS AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI Y14.5M, 1982. 2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER. 3. DATUM PLANE DATUM H IS LOCATED AT BOTTOM OF LEAD AND IS COINCIDENT WITH THE LEAD WHERE THE LEAD EXITS THE PLASTIC BODY AT THE BOTTOM OF THE PARTING LINE. 4. DATUMS A, B AND D TO BE DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE DATUM C. 5. DIMENSIONS D AND E TO BE DETERMINED AT SEATING PLANE DATUM C. 6. DIMENSIONS D1 AND E1 DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE PROTRUSION IS 0.25 PER SIDE. 7. DIMENSION bDOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR PROTRUSION. DAMBAR PROTRUSION SHALL NOT CAUSE THE b DIMENSION TO EXCEED 0.35. MINIMUM SPACE BETWEEN PROTRUSION AND ADJACENT LEAD OR PROTRUSION 0.07. 32 D D1/2 D/2 D1 D 4X A (θ 2) 0.08 C C L (L) 33 17 H GAGE PLANE (L2) A1 3X 2X R R1 4X SEATING PLANE (θ 3) VIEW AA BASE METAL b1 X X=A, B OR D c c1 CL AB e/2 AB 60X VIEW Y e PLATING b 0.08 M C A–B D DIM A A1 A2 b b1 c c1 D D1 e E E1 L L1 L2 R1 S θ θ1 θ2 θ3 MILLIMETERS MIN MAX — 1.60 0.05 0.15 1.35 1.45 0.17 0.27 0.17 0.23 0.09 0.20 0.09 0.16 12.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 0.50 BSC 12.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 0.45 0.75 1.00 REF 0.50 REF 0.10 0.20 0.20 REF 0° 7° — 0° 12 REF 12 REF SECTION AB–AB ROTATED 90° CLOCKWISE Figure 24-2. 64-Pin Low-Profile Quad Flat Pack (Case No. 840F) MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Mechanical Specifications 409 Mechanical Specifications 24.5 64-Pin Quad Flat Pack (QFP) L 48 33 DETAIL A S D S H A–B V 0.20 (0.008) M B P B M L B 0.20 (0.008) –B– C A–B –A– 0.05 (0.002) A–B S D 32 S 49 –A–, –B–, –D– DETAIL A 64 17 F 1 16 –D– A 0.20 (0.008) C A–B S D S 0.05 (0.002) A–B S 0.20 (0.008) M H A–B S D S M J N E M C M H 0.02 (0.008) DATUM PLANE M C A–B S D S SECTION B–B 0.01 (0.004) G U T R –H– DETAILC –H– –C– SEATING PLANE BASE METAL D DATUM PLANE Q K W X DETAIL C NOTES: 1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI Y14.5M, 1982. 2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER. 3. DATUM PLANE –H– IS LOCATED AT BOTTOM OF LEAD AND IS COINCIDENT WITH THE LEAD WHERE THE LEAD EXITS THE PLASTIC BODY AT THE BOTTOM OF THE PARTING LINE. 4. DATUMS –A–, –B– AND –D– TO BE DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE –H–. 5. DIMENSIONS S AND V TO BE DETERMINED AT SEATING PLANE –C–. 6. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE PROTRUSION IS 0.25 (0.010) PER SIDE. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO INCLUDE MOLD MISMATCH AND ARE DETERMINED AT DATUM PLANE –H–. 7. DIMENSION D DOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE DAMBAR PROTRUSION SHALL BE 0.08 (0.003) PER SIDE. TOTAL IN EXCESS OF THE D DIMENSION AT MAXIMUM MATERIAL CONDITION. DAMBAR CANNOT BE LOCATED ON THE LOWER RADIUS OR THE FOOT. DIM A B C D E F G H J K L M N P Q R S T U V W X MILLIMETERS INCHES MIN MAX MIN MAX 13.90 14.10 0.547 0.555 13.90 14.10 0.547 0.555 2.15 2.45 0.085 0.096 0.30 0.45 0.012 0.018 2.00 2.40 0.079 0.094 0.30 0.40 0.012 0.016 0.80 BSC 0.031 BSC — 0.25 — 0.010 0.13 0.23 0.005 0.009 0.65 0.95 0.026 0.037 12.00 REF 0.472 REF 5° 10° 5° 10° 0.13 0.17 0.005 0.007 0.40 BSC 0.016 BSC 0° 7° 0° 7° 0.13 0.30 0.005 0.012 16.95 17.45 0.667 0.687 0.13 — 0.005 — 0° — 0° — 16.95 17.45 0.667 0.687 0.35 0.45 0.014 0.018 1.6 REF 0.063 REF Figure 24-3. 64-Pin Quad Flat Pack (Case No. 840B) Technical Data 410 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Mechanical Specifications MOTOROLA Technical Data — MC68HC908LJ12 Section 25. Ordering Information 25.1 Contents 25.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 25.3 MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411 25.2 Introduction This section contains ordering numbers for the MC68HC908LJ12. 25.3 MC Order Numbers Table 25-1. MC Order Numbers Package Operating Temperature Range MC68HC908LJ12CFB 52-pin LQFP –40 °C to +85 °C MC68HC908LJ12CPB 64-pin LQFP –40 °C to +85 °C MC68HC908LJ12CFU 64-pin QFP –40 °C to +85 °C MC Order Number MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 MOTOROLA Technical Data Ordering Information 411 Ordering Information Technical Data 412 MC68HC908LJ12 — Rev. 2.0 Ordering Information MOTOROLA HOW TO REACH US: USA/EUROPE/LOCATIONS NOT LISTED: Motorola Literature Distribution; P.O. Box 5405, Denver, Colorado 80217 1-303-675-2140 or 1-800-441-2447 JAPAN: Motorola Japan Ltd.; SPS, Technical Information Center, 3-20-1, Minami-Azabu Minato-ku, Tokyo 106-8573 Japan 81-3-3440-3569 ASIA/PACIFIC: Motorola Semiconductors H.K. Ltd.; Silicon Harbour Centre, 2 Dai King Street, Tai Po Industrial Estate, Tai Po, N.T., Hong Kong 852-26668334 TECHNICAL INFORMATION CENTER: 1-800-521-6274 Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software implementers to use Motorola products. There are no express or implied copyright licenses granted hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or integrated circuits based on the information in this document. Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Motorola makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any HOME PAGE: http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters which may be provided in Motorola data sheets and/or specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating parameters, including “Typicals” must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Motorola does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Motorola product could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Motorola products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Motorola and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part. Motorola and the Stylized M Logo are registered in the U.S. Patent and Trademark Office. digital dna is a trademark of Motorola, Inc. All other product or service names are the property of their respective owners. Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer. © Motorola, Inc. 2002 MC68HC908LJ12/D
MC68HC908LJ12CFU 价格&库存

很抱歉,暂时无法提供与“MC68HC908LJ12CFU”相匹配的价格&库存,您可以联系我们找货

免费人工找货